Ask the Scholar
Document scope · 1 page
Scholar
Ask about this object, its catalog metadata, its source description, or the page inventory.
For page-specific OCR and visual context, open one of the page chats.
Scholar Source Context
Document identity
localId
349143313
label
CIL [Center for Independent Living] State of the Art Conference '75
core
doc
dtoType
document
citationUrl
pageCount
1
Source metadata
id
349143313
contentType
document
title
CIL [Center for Independent Living] State of the Art Conference '75
citationUrl
collections
Lex Frieden Collection: Records on Disability Rights
Records Relating to Disability Rights
imageCount
1
hasImages
yes
source
import
hasTranscription
no
Source extras
naId
349143313
levelOfDescription
fileUnit
recordType
description
ocrSource
nara-archive
Single page context
seq
1
pageIndex
0
type
document
mediaId
221d92aa72247d3b
ocrText
Originally Processed With FOIA(s):
FOIA Number:
S
S
FOIA
MARKER
This is not a textual record. This is used as an
administrative marker by the George Bush Presidential
Library Staff.
Record Group/Collection:
Donated Historical Materials
Collection/Office of Origin: Frieden, Lex, Collection
Series:
Related Materials
Subseries:
Conferences
OA/ID Number:
52070
Folder ID Number:
52070-005
Folder Title:
CIL [Center for Independent Living] State of the Art Conference '75
Stack:
Row:
Section:
Shelf:
Position:
Cil
Center for Independent Living, Inc.
2539 TELEGRAPH AVENUE
BERKELEY, CALIFORNIA 94704
(415) 841-4776
Lex Frieden
Texas Institute for Rehabilitation & Research
1333 Moursund Ave.
Houston, Texas 77025
Dear Lex,
It gives me great pleasure to send you the report on
CIL's State of the Art Conference one year ago. Due to
the limited budget, we have decided to distribute broadly
only a selection of the papers prepared for the conference.
Please note, however, that all of the papers are available
from CIL.
I would also like to take this opportunity to thank
you for participating in the conference. It is our hope
that this was just the first of many opportunities for
those deeply involved in the Independent Living Movement
to meet and exchange ideas and information.
Best regards,
Sincerely,
Phil Phil Draper Druper
Executive Director
PD/jl
A Services, Training and Educational Organization of People with Disabilities
Cill
Center for Independent Living, Inc.
2539 TELEGRAPH AVENUE
BERKELEY, CALIFORNIA 94704
(415) 841-4776
September 1976
Dear reader,
How do you capture the state of the art of a dynamic, growing movement
occurring simultaneously throughout the nation? One answer is to hold
a conference, invite the leaders and the doers and publish a report.
The first conference on the Independent Living Movement was held in
October 1975 in Berkeley California, It was sponsored by CIL under a
grant from RSA. Attached is a report on the conference. The report
reflects the embryonic nature of the movement, the tremendous diversity
of issues, problems and approaches and the dreams, efforts and accomplish-
ments of those who have been an active part of it. More than anything else the report
dramatizes the importance of close, continuing communication between
centers of activity and the need for many more opportunities
to meet and exchange information and ideas.
The role of CIL's conference was that of a catalyst - to bring together
consumers and professionals from all parts of the country and to
initiate a dialogue leading toward a common understanding of the issues
and problems, and a consensus of approach. The conference also served as
the impetus for the continued development of consumer-based organizations
similiar to CIL that can effectively attack the societal barriers that
prohibit the independence and productivity of people with severe disabilities.
It is hoped that future conferences will continue this process and will
result in a State of the Art of the movement in its maturity.
Sincerely
Phil Draper
Philip Draper
Executive Director
A Services, Training and Educational Organization of People with Disabilities
REPORT
ON THE STATE
OF THE
ART CONFERENCE
CENTER FOR
INDEPENDENT LIVING
OCTOBER 21-23, 1975
Enclosed is a selection of the papers presented at the conference. If you would like
to receive copies of the other papers prepared, please contact CIL, 2539 Telegraph
Ave., Berkeley, California 94704. There is a charge of $1 per paper to cover handling
and postage.
Participants
Papers
Jack Actenberg
Crips Lib - An Overview of Legal
Professor at Law
Issues
University of San Fernando Valley
College of Law
8353 Sepulveda Blvd.
Sepulveda, California 91343
Ralph E. Baird
Progressive Inclusion - An Approach
Administrative Assistant
to Mainstreaming
Special Education
Pupil Personnel Services
Tacoma Public Schools
Tacoma, Washington
Monroe Berkowitz
Programs and Expenditures For The
Professor of Economics
Severely Disabled
Bureau of Economic Research
Rutgers University
165 College Ave.
New Brunswick, New Jersey 08903
Sheldon Berrol, M.D.
Chief, Head Injury Rehabilitation Unit
Medical Aspects of Disability With a
Santa Clara Valley Medical Center
View to Independent Living (co-author
751 South Bascom
Edna Brean)
San Jose, Calif.
Edna Brean, R.N.
(see above)
Medical Services and Training
Center for Independent Living
Frederick C. Collignon
Berkeley Planning Associates
2320 Channing Way
Berkeley, California
Barbara Duncan
Legislation, Research and Programs
Managing Editor
Concerning Housing for Handicapped
International Rehabilitation Review
People in Belgium, Canada, the
122 East 23rd St.
Federal Republic of Germany, Finland,
New York, N.Y. 10010
France, Hong Kong, the Netherlands,
Norway and Sweden
Frederick A. Fay, Ph.D.
The Federal Outlook
Director of Research
Tufts New England R&T Center
171 Harrison Ave.
Boston, Ma. 02111
Allen Ferguson, Jr.
Project Coordinator,
State-of-the-Art Project
Center for Independent Living
Labor-Management Relations Examiner
National Labor Relations
Board Region 21
849 S. Broadway
6th Floor,
Los Angeles, Calif 90014
Lex Frieden
Independent Living Arrangements for
Texas Institute for Rehabilitation
Severely Physically Disabled Persons
and Research
1333 Moursund Ave.
Houston, Texas 77025
Don Galloway
Project Director
Research and Demonstration Project
Center for Independent Living
Donald E. Galvin
The Role of the State VR Agency
Director, Vocational Rehabilitation
Service
Box 1016
Lansing, Michigan 48904
Frank D. Gentile
A Model Sheltered Workshop
Vice President
Human Resources Center
Albertson, Long Island, N.Y. 11507
Dominic Harveston
Manager, CIL-Center for Health
Studies Joint Degree Program
Center for Independent Living
Francis H. Lauder
Office for Handicapped Individuals
Marty Switzer Memorial Bldg.
Washington, D.C. 20201
Peter Leech, M.S.W.
An On-Site Training Program for
Clinical Coordinator, Counseling
Professionals Working with People
Center for Independent Living
Who Have Severe Disabilities
Joan Leon
Special Assistant
Center for Independent Living
Dr. Herbert H. Leibowitz
Research and Demonstration Specialist
Social and Rehabilitation Service
50 Fulton St.
San Francisco, California
Wallace Motloch, C.O.
Systems Approach and the Physically
Chief Orthotist,
Unable
Rehabilitation Engineering Center
Children's Hospital at Stanford
Palo Alto, California
Jeff Moyer
Manager, Client Services
Center for Independent Living
Thomas C. O'Brien
Transportation For The Mobility
1975 Chairman, Transportation
Handicapped
American Coalition of Citizens
With Disabilities
15 Wellesley Rd.
Danvers, Massachusetts 01923
Daniel A. Poling, II
The Three R's of Disabled
Editor-in-Chief
Consumerism
Poling Magazine
122 East 23rd St.
New York, N.Y. 10010
Richard J. Randles
Private Industry and the Vocational
Federal Systems Division
Rehabilitation Process
IBM Corporation
Gaithersburg, Maryland
Ed Roberts
Director
State Department of Rehabilitation
722 Capitol Mall
Sacramento, California 95814
Phillip Hatlin
A New Kid in Town
Director
Living Skills Center for the
Visually Handicapped
2444 Road 20, Apt. C 105
San Pablo, California 94806
John Hessler
Assistant Director
Department of Rehabilitation
722 Capitol Mall
Sacramento, California 95814
Judy Heumann
Deputy Director
Center for Independent Living
Ralph Hodgkis
Center for Concerned Engineering
1707 Q Street N.W.
Washington, D.C. 20009
Douglas Inkster
Center for Independent Living In New
Director
York - a Residential Center for the
Center for Independent Living-
Elderly Blind
New York
Altschul Pavilion
310 East 15th St.
New York, N.Y. 10003
Neil Jacobson
Sexuality and Independent Living Skills
Instructor/Administrator
Computer Programmer Training
Center for Independent Living
Debbie Kaplan
Legal Services by the Disabled for the
Director
Disabled
Disabled Citizens Advocacy Group
P.O. Box 19367
Washington, D.C. 20036
Hal Kirschbaum
Mgr. Development
CIL
Kent Kloepping, Ed.D.
The Disabled Students Programs in the
Special Services Office
College and University Setting
College of Education
University of Arizona
Joseph Kohn
Independent Living and The State
Executive Director
Agency For The Blind - The State of the
New Jersey State Commission f/t
Art
Blind and Visually Impaired
1100 Raymond Boulevard
Newark, New Jersey 07102
Irving J. Kruger
Chief, Vocational
Rehabilitation Services
New Jersey State
Commission f/t Blind
and Visually Impaired
1100 Raymond Boulevard
Newark, New Jersey 07102
Barry Ryan
Research Evaluator
Research and Demonstration Project
Center for Independent Living
Miriam Stubbs
Program Division
Office of Rehabilitation Services
Department of H.E.W.
Washington, D.C. 20201
Karen Topp
Rehabilitation Counselor
State Department of Rehabilitation
Oakland, California
Kathleen Ursin
The Impact of Litigation on De-
Director of Education
Institutionalization: A Movement
The National Center for Law and the
Toward Independent Living for the
Handicapped, Inc.
Mentally Disabled
1235 North Eddy Street
South Bend, Indiana 44617
Carolyn L. Vash, Ph.D.
The Psychology of Disability
Chief Deputy Director
State Department of Rehabilitation
107 S. Broadway, Room 7106
Los Angeles, Ca 90012
Dale Williamson
Office of Rehabilitation Services
50 Fulton Street
San Francisco, California
Hale Zukas
History of CIL
Coordinator, Community Affairs
Center for Independent Living
THE PSYCHOLOGY OF DISABILITY
Carolyn L. Vash, Ph.D.
Introduction
I begin this paper with what may seem a strange and irrelevant confession. I
believed in reincarnation until I was 16. I thought everyone did. I got straightened
out one day when my mother, my attendant, and I were looking at a magazine car-
toon which prompted my attendant to say, "Humph! Whoever drew that must believe
in that-there re-incarnation." I said, "Doesn't everybody?" Mother said, "Carolyn,
where did you get such an idea?" I said, "Gee, I don't know, am I wrong?" She
assured me I was. I gave up the belief without a whimper. I did check with a couple
of friends to see if they believed in it. They had never heard of it. I decided it was my
mistake and put it away. That was in 1951.
In 1975 and the dawning of the Age of Aquarius, almost everyone in the West knows
what it is and many believe. One of these is a friend of mine; a rehabilitation ad-
ministrator who, in a quiet moment one day, began to question her own motivations
for doing what she was doing. She subsequently resigned her job, cast off her
material possessions, and took a trip to the far East. Her studies there and since led
her to a strong belief in the principle of reincarnation.
An important element of this belief is that one chooses one's body, one's parents,
one's total life situation for the purpose of working out karma. Thus, one chooses to
live in a disabled condition for some reason relating to spiritual development. It is
not a regrettable accident. My friend told me that one result of embracing this belief
is that now when she meets a person who is mentally retarded or severely disabled
she no longer experiences pangs of pity as she once did. She doesn't think of her-
self as fortunate (and therefore superior) to an unfortunate (and therefore inferior)
person. She relates to him/her as a peer, a colleague, and finds herself asking,
albeit quietly to herself, "Ho there, what are you working out this time? I wonder if
you are at a higher level of development than I for having come to such a test."
I cannot say that I believe in reincarnation. A physician colleague of mine who does
is convinced that I was born knowing the truth and, though I let myself be
dissuaded, will continue to be influenced by it. I do know that since my friend
shared her observation with me, my own perceptions, beliefs, opinions, attitudes
and feelings about what it means to be disabled have changed. The issues I think
are important, the programs I view as successful, the policy decisions I believe
should be made reflect less a desire to correct inequities in the material world of
bodies and economics, and more a desire to remove interferences in the spiritual -
or karmic, if you will - development of people who have disabilities.
Although I am a psychologist by trade, this paper will draw far more from my own
experience with disability than from scholarly and professional pursuits. The reason
is simple; that's where I've learned the most. Every theory I read, every experience
shared with me by a patient or friend, is tested in the laboratory of my own feelings,
senses, intuitions and thoughts - and either becomes part of my world view or fades
because it somehow doesn't fit. By illustration; I will attempt to lay out the issues
which I regard as most crucial in the area labeled "the psychology of disability."
Then, I will describe some efforts which are being made to deal with these issues.
Finally, I will share with you some thoughts about what should be done to be more
helpful to people struggling to reach whatever it is life holds for us all.
The Psychology of Disability . What It Does and Doesn't Mean:
Part of me is reluctant to even acknowledge the validity of the notion, "the
psychology of disability," because it seems to have led to gross and unhelpful
exaggerations of the psychological differences between folks with disabilities and
folks without. That part of me would like to just tuck it away and say, look, human
beings are human beings. Whatever differences we have in our physical bodies or
sensory capacities or intellectual abilities or anything else, we are more alike than
we are different. Let's focus on our commonalities because they, not our dif-
ferences, constitute the preponderance of our humanhood. For example, disabled
people are said to experience a sense of loss over the functional abilities an illness
or injury destroyed. Other people experience a sense of loss over something they
once had and is now gone. The stimulus is different, but the sense of loss, the fear
that you can't survive or be happy without "it" are the same - as much as any two
people can be said to experience the same emotion. The psychology of disability is
really nothing different from the psychology of being human. When we understand
the nature of the basic Stimulus-Organism-Response relationships which are the
building blocks of scientific psychology, there will surely be no residual that has to
be studied separately to understand why disabled folks behave as they do.
Obviously, this is a "political" response, not unlike the popular reaction against Dr.
Jensen's investigations into ethnicity and intellect. It is an extremist view, and the
only reason I include it here is to emphatically illustrate a point. The psychology of
disability, in my opinion, is the study of how human organisms respond to a set of
stimulus conditions which are associated with disability. It is the study of normative
responses from (psychologically) normal organisms to unusual stimuli.
Some of these unusual stimuli are biological, such as being paralyzed. Some are
environmental, such as inaccessible entrances. Some are social, such as having a
saleslady ask your companion, not you, what size you wear. Some are economic,
such as not being able to get a job. Some are obvious, such as a restroom door that
you can't get through. Some are subtle, such as people not using the word "cripple"
when you are around. Some are pleasant, such as being allowed to board an air-
plane first. Some are unpleasant, such as not being allowed to board at all. As I
write, I realize I could fill pages with such examples, which in itself illustrates the
unusual stimulus situation the person with a disability is in - a continual flow of
perceptions and experiences which cannot be shared with and validated by the vast
majority of people around one. Thus, isolation and the lack of a sense of shared
ideas and feelings are added to the list of unusual stimulus conditions. And so it
goes.
Viewed in this light, the psychology of disability looms large, important, and bifur-
cated as an applied science. One branch is a rather typical applied behavioral
science - embodied in a group of professionals who attempt to apply the findings
of research and clinical experience to help people with disabilities cope with, adapt
to, adjust to these unusual stimuli. The other branch is embodied in an activist
movement - a group of people who have determined that it is the world that needs
"treatment" not just the person with the disability.
This is a relatively new development. It emerged slowly after World War II, when
medical science found ways to save wounded soldiers who would return,
significantly disabled, to a society that felt it owed them something. But, feeling you
owe a debt and figuring out how to pay it are two different things, and little
measurable progress was made toward including the disabled in society. The Watts
riots in 1965 pointed the way. Some Blacks in South Central Los Angeles engaged
in crazy, self-destructive behavior for six days and somehow, one of the results of it
was that Blacks all over the country, other racial minorities, women, people with
disabilities, and multitudes of other groups who had accepted powerlessness and
half-filled cups all of their lives began to scream. They all began to realize that
society, even an indebted society, is not going to "fix" it for you. The guy with the
problem has to come up with the solution. And they discovered the Constitution.
Everybody had known all along that Blacks were regularly deprived of their con-
stitutional rights, but whoever thought people with disabilities were? The "ex-
pectation explosion" began, and "consciousness raising" attempted to ensure that
everyone's expectations were as high as they should be.
A very few years ago almost the total emphasis in rehabilitation was on modifying
the 'patient' so he could fit into the world as it was. (S)he was modified by medicine,
surgery, physical therapy, occupational therapy, psychotherapy, vocational coun-
seling, social counseling, prosthetic and orthotic devices, education, training and
much, much more. Family homes were remodeled, sometimes at public expense, but
to expect all housing to be built 'accessible" would have been viewed as an
idealistic delusion - about as likely as having a Black mayor in Los Angeles. "If a
round peg doesn't fit in a square hole, you square the peg, you don't ream out the
hole". We've come a long way. The "other half" of the psychology of disability has
become the politics of disability - and that, in my opinion, is as it should be. It
doesn't take Freud to figure out that it's not very good for a person, psychologically
speaking, to be deprived of his constitutional rights. If the applied psychology of
disability is to be a helpful discipline, it must tend to the business of changing such
stimulus conditions as well as the individual and his responses.
Devaluation
Following close behind outright oppression in psychologically damaging con-
sequences is devaluation; being regarded as a lesser being, inferior, not very
capable, not very useful, possibly burdensome, unesthetic and, generally, "one-
down." People with disabilities consistently experience devaluation in the eyes of
the people who comprise the general society, as well as other disabled people. This
is true regardless of the nature of the disability - whether it impairs physical, sen-
sory, intellectual or emotional functioning. The phenomenon was illustrated
beautifully at the Statewide Conference on Rehabilitation held in Sacramento,
California in October of 1974. Dr. William Rader, psychiatrist, psychodramatist and
public performer par excellence, began an arousing display of the tragic, even
deadly, effects of communication misfires between "helper" and "helpee" with a
simple routine. He addressed the group alternately standing and sitting in a
wheelchair; all the while challenging them to deny that their perceptions of his com-
petence fluctuated as he stood and sat, stood and sat. There was much discussion
afterward and without exception, everyone I talked with, from able-bodied to very
severely disabled, acknowledged that their views of his competence HAD changed,
had alternated dizzyingly as he stood and sat, that he had appeared more com-
petent, more credible, more worthy of attention when he stood. It was an emotionally
draining experience for many. It was a confrontation of prejudice they had ignored
or denied for a long time - and they were forced to look at it nose-to-nose and
eyeball-to-eyeball. Why this impact from recognizing that all of us, able-bodied and
disabled alike, devaluate people with disabilities? Why is it so frightening that we
have to hide from it? The hypothetical observer from another planet would almost
certainly see it for the universal phenomenon it is. Can it be changed? Probably not,
unless it is first acknowledged and examined in every aspect.
The first line of inquiry is, "Is it biologically based?" Does the human species in-
stinctively shun damaged organisms because their perpetuation could threaten the
survival of the species? We are all familiar with the anthropological folklore that
primitive tribes leave injured or aged members to die because efforts to save them
would endanger larger numbers. Is it possible that biological mechanisms which
once operated for species protection have not "caught up" with an affluent and
technological society which has rendered them anachronistic? I acknowledge my
own prejudice here. It is my firm conviction that such mechanisms, if, indeed, they
are operative, are anachronistic. As a severely disabled person who is dependent
upon both technology and the goodwill of other human beings to aid me, I cannot
allow myself to believe otherwise.
The second line of inquiry is psycho-social, but in content it is similar. People tend
to shun, be prejudiced against, devaluate individuals who are different. This is more
true if the difference occurs at the low end of the distribution; that is, if the in-
dividual has less of something than most people have. But people who are too
beautiful or too brilliant or too rich or even too kind come in for their share of
suspicion and punishment as well. This phenomenon may also have biological sub-
strates, since it appears to have been "learned" by almost every culture on earth.
Can people learn to tolerate a wider range of differences? How?
The third line on inquiry is politico-economic. In an affluent, technological society,
saving lives and improving the quality of life for those saved but left damaged is not
going to threaten the survival of the species. It can, however, reduce the sum total
of goods available for the rest. The disabled, and especially the severely disabled,
are viewed as a group of "takers" who don't put much back into the system - the
family system, the community system, the social system.
If we are taking only materialistic values into account, this may be a valid notion. If
severely disabled people lack the inner resources or miss the strokes of fortune
which lead them to a job which pays enough to support their high-cost needs, then
the issue is not whether the public pays, but how. Should it be managed through a
tax supported welfare system or should it be "subsidized" through an employer
who, in turn, passes the cost on to the general public in increased prices for goods
and services? In terms of the long-run impact on the purses of the people, there may
not be much difference. In terms of the psychological well-being of the severely
disabled people affected the difference may be very great.
If one looks beyond materialistic values to spiritual values, the issue becomes
meaningless. If one has faith, or at least adopts the belief that the purpose of life is
spiritual development rather than materialistic acquisition, then sharing of goods
with those unable to produce their own is not inconsistent with "enlightened self-
interest." The reason for this is an associated faith that we are all parts of the same
universal spirit. Selfishness and unselfishness become paradoxically the same. Just
as one must "selfishly" pursue one's own development (and sometimes deny those
who urge prior consideration of their wishes) if one is to become a truly beneficial
influence for others, so must one also "unselfishly" pursue the removal of hin-
drances to other individuals' development because to do otherwise is ultimately to
impair one's own. There is no reason to believe that people with severe disabilities
put less back into this system than anyone else.
The Summary of the Comprehensive Needs Report done by the Urban Institute
makes a few references to psychological services. Those services most often
requested by respondents were: vocational services, transportation and physical
therapy. The report does make the point that, "the person's view of himself is often
diminished by his handicap." In other words, he devaluates himself. But
psychological services were not among those services most sought after by the
respondents.
Yet this is a psychologically educated age. We are all aware of the potential
destructiveness, to self and others, of impaired or undeveloped self-esteem. We un-
derstand that many psychiatric disorders are largely outgrowths of this. Newspaper
accounts of individuals who commit "senseless crimes" relate histories of lack of
self-respect and early efforts to prove that they "were somebody." Books like "I'm
O.K., You're O.K. proliferate and sell millions of copies. We are this sophisticated,
and yet the respondents didn't ask for help in dealing with their feelings of
devaluation. And as we will see later, the providers typically offer only the most cur-
sory efforts to help in this way. Why?
First, the sophistication is intellectual. When it comes down to "me", the ex-
pectations rush backwards a few decades and the individual is both inwardly and
outwardly directed to handle this adjustment process him/herself. To need help is to
be unacceptably weak, so the need is denied. The social sanctions against getting
psychological - or, God forbid - psychiatric help interfere with asking even when
the need is recognized.
Second, it is not easy to relate help provided in this area to savings of public
dollars. Physical restoration can demonstrably reduce life-long medical costs which
the public pays for. Vocational rehabilitation can reduce welfare cost and get some
tax money coming into the system as well. If physical restoration and vocational
rehabilitation can do that, who is going to worry about how the person feels about
him/herself? Nobody else is very happy these days anyway.
Apart from any humanistic, quality-of-life concerns, it is very likely that sufficient at-
tention to "soft data" of rehabilitation - such as the potential effects of
psychological services - could further reduce medical, welfare and other related
costs to a degree barely conceived of today. To evaluate such factors, we would
gather data from the first moments post-onset through the entire course of the
disability, which might last the rest of the individual's life.
People who feel badly about themselves generate needs which must be served. Un-
fortunately, those needs are often left unmet until after the person is in such deep
psychological trouble that its effects are being felt by others as well.
Acceptance of Disability
In earlier days of the rehabilitation movement, there was a great deal of talk about
the importance of "accepting one's disability." This sometimes meant the absence
of the defense mechanism "denial." At other times it simply meant
acknowledgement of one's loss without feeling rotten about it. Acceptance was
good. However, in no case was the person supposed to like his disability. That
would be a more serious neurosis than denial. Profits reaped were labeled "secon-
dary gain" and secondary gain was a no-no. To benefit from the disability was con-
sidered unwholesome at best, immoral at worst. This required the person to know
exactly where the line between acceptance and enjoyment lay, and to be eternally
vigilant not to cross over. Acceptance was biting the bullet and smiling at the same
time - and about equally easy.
About the time I entered the field of rehabilitation in 1958, it was becoming un-
fashionable to talk about accepting disability. The staff and the literature explained
to anyone gauche enough to use such language that it did not make sense to ex-
pect a person to accept a disability; that the professionals of a prior era had laid a
bum trip on disabled people. No one should be enjoined to accept something that
means settling for second-rate hopes and goals. "Adapting to" and "coping with"
became the preferred terminology.
Actually, it was this thinking that led in part to the advocacy revolution. Some
realistic souls saw that you could counsel a disabled person until you were both
blue in the face, but at the end of it, if (s)he couldn't get from point A to point B
because there were stairs and no accessible buses in between, life was not going to
be much fun because the world was not a very reasonable place to live. Thus, there
was a switch of emphasis from modification of the person to modification of the
world: removing the stairs and the discriminatory hiring practices instead of coun-
seling him to stop liking upstairs restaurants and training him to do the few jobs he
would be allowed to do.
I agreed with this until about 1967. At that time, I experienced divorce after a ten-
year marriage and for the first time in my life was alone, independent, and scared
stiff. I decided to invest a couple hundred dollars in ten psychotherapy sessions to
see if I could get my head together. One of the first things the man said to me was,
"The trouble with you is you haven't accepted your disability." "Oh brother," I
thought, "I should never have come to a psychologist who hasn't had experience
with disabled people. He doesn't know how inappropriate that remark is
even if it
were true. I obviously have accepted my disability. I am working in a responsible
position, making enough money to pay for my own attendant, am openly and
unabashedly on the dating market and doing reasonably well. I have lots of friends,
social and recreational activities. I paint, write poetry, and work 80 hours a week.
How can he say I haven't accepted my disability? Paintings of anguish and poems
with suicidal themes are what sell these days, and what's wrong with being
dedicated? Actually, I'm in psychotherapy mainly for training purposes, since I'd
like to have a small private practice some day," True, I wasn't exactly happy and
couldn't figure out why. It took a few months to realize that one reason was, I hadn't
accepted my disability.
When I did, it wasn't at all like the staff and the literature had envisioned it - set-
tling for second-rate goals and dreams. It wasn't even de-fusing the disappointment
that I would never again hear whistles when I walked, or dance, or ride in a horse
show, or walk alone in the rain, or go to the bathroom by myself. It sure as hell
wasn't the much touted process of discovering substitute gratifications for the ones
I had lost.
It was more like those things not only didn't matter any more, they wouldn't have
mattered even if I could still have done them. I didn't need to be able to do them -
or to mourn their loss - in order to maintain some image of myself. I felt I un-
derstood the relinquishments that come with age. Joys of an earlier era are con-
tinuously "put away". Substitutions needn't be sought; new joys simply emerge, ap-
propriate to the new era. I found myself no longer afraid of aging. Acceptance of
disability was simply acceptance of myself - and there were parts of me that were
harder to accept than my disability by far. I didn't have the language then, but from
the personal studies I've done since, acceptance of disability was exactly the
process the Western interpreters of Eastern mystics speak of as centering, ridding
oneself of Ego, and casting off attachments so they become, at most, preferences.
The fact that a few of these attachments were ego-images and activities interfered
with by disability was just one happenstance of a much larger process.
Summary of the Issues
Rather than attempt a comprehensive survey of psychological issues related to
various aspects of disability - such as the effects of paralysis and/or sensory
losses on the expression of sexuality, the effects of deafness on interpersonal
relations, and other highly specific concerns that could not be covered exhaustively
- I have decided to focus upon just those basic phenomena described in the
foregoing: the processes of devaluation and acceptance. It may be too sweeping a
statement, but I believe they constitute the underlying cause and inherent solution
to most of the specific psychological issues which might be discussed. What are we
doing and what can we do to reduce devaluation? What are we doing and what can
we do to increase acceptance?
Current Practice
I will touch upon what is happening - or not happening - in five areas: 1) com-
munity hospitals; 2) rehabilitation hospitals or rehabilitation units in community
hospitals; 3) the state-federal vocational rehabilitation agencies - including
facilities from which they procure services; 4) independent living programs; and 5)
the private sector of psychological clinics and practitioners. I will state my apologia
now that what I know about is what my present and previous jobs have made me
aware of. I have not had the opportunity to research and discover additional
programs which may be going on.
Community Hospitals
A few community hospitals have limited psychological service programs; usually
one or more staff or on-call psychologists, psychiatrists or social workers are
available to talk with patients who want or appear to need such help.
Often it is for the dying patient or the patient who is a ward management problem.
Hospitals which treat many patients with conditions thought to have considerable
psychological overlay, such as low back problems, may have larger programs in-
cluding both clinical and research components.
However, for the patient who is just plain scared because he senses that his brand-
new catastrophic illness or injury is going to have some life-style jolting im-
plications, I know of no programmatic efforts. The only ones I have heard discussed
were by groups of severely disabled persons who proposed to go to hospitals on a
volunteer basis to talk with newly injured patients. There is controversy here;
whether and how hard to hit the person with the facts of a poor prognosis for even-
tual recovery - as the inexperienced patient would define it. Some say people need
time to assimilate this reality; that to shove it down their throats when they are still
systemically disturbed is not only unhelpful but cruel. Others insist that although it
may be painful, it is not necessarily harmful; the earlier reality is faced, the earlier
can the psychological as well as the physical repair processes begin. My instincts
tell me there is no single answer. It could be helpful to some and harmful to others.
Given a few years of experience working and just being with people who are in the
acute stage of recovery from catastrophic illness or injury, I might be prepared to
distinguish who is which. I certainly cannot now.
Rehabilitation Hospitals or Units
Most rehabilitation hospitals or units have at least a fledgling psychological service
component and some have grown quite large, with a dozen or more psychologists
on staff. One of the largest is the Psychology Department at Rancho Los Amigos
Hospital. The problem is, despite its size, it isn't big enough. The majority of staff
time goes into evaluation, leaving little time for treatment. It is not patients who want
evaluations, it is other staff; for purposes of planning patients' rehabilitation
programs or coping with day-to-day problems like "refusal to cooperate". The
patients get only fragmentary help in a situation which most people - before it hap-
pens - are totally convinced they could not handle.
Psychologists from other rehabilitation hospitals report and lament the same ex-
perience. When I worked as a psychologist in a rehabilitation hospital it occurred to
me that my role was to reduce staff anxiety. Somehow, having test data made us feel
we had a better handle on something. If I gave a patient a WAIS and an MMPI and
could say with assurance that he was normally smart and wasn't crazy; he was just
a little upset over being paralyzed all of a sudden and suspected his wife had moved
in with his best friend while he was in the hospital and he had never done any
work except manual labor and didn't see how he could get her and the kids back
unless he could support them and he probably couldn't satisfy her anyway so
perhaps he was being selfish to want her back
the
anxiety
of
the
staff
was
relieved. But somehow no one ever said, "Wow! What a heavy trip! I'll do without my
evaluations. You should spend your time just talking with people, seeing if you can
guide them through this incredible trip, because it seems a lot more important!"
I squeezed in as much "just talking", counseling, psychotherapy - - whatever you
want to call it - as I could. We all did. But we never mutinied and said, "This is
ridiculous! We're serving the wrong people. True, it's a heavy trip for them, too,
going through this time after time. But the other guys need it worse. Let's re-order
our priorities." We just went on assuming that our evaluations were so important
they had to get done, and prayed for more staff.
I suspect the marginal status of practitioners of the psychotherapeutic arts has
much to do with explaining this situation. One of the reasons for marginal status is
low visibility of effort. One way to enhance status is to get visible. Test protocols
and reports containing findings, predictions and recommendations are a visible
product. Everyone can see that you're working. How do you prove you're a
necessary member of the team if you just talk to people? Even the chaplain, with
centuries of tradition behind him, is seldom regarded as crucial in this role.
A second reason for marginal status is low visibility of success criteria. Physicians
have x-rays and blood tests to tell them and the world whether their efforts
"worked". Physical therapists, lacking the physicians' hardware, at least have easy-
to-describe behaviors like "puts on own pants yes or no" to deal with. Many ap-
plied behavioral science fields are beginning to realize that if they are to survive,
they will learn to play the game of "accountability" as well as everyone else. Every
effort is being made to remove descriptions of therapy benefits from the abstract
(e.g., improved insight) to concrete behavior (e.g., no longer beats wife). Un-
fortunately, the psychologists' status isn't helped by this as much as it might be.
The reason is that the benefits of his efforts are not expected at immediate or even
intermediate range, but at long range - which further compounds the problem of
low visibility of success and is a third reason for the marginal status of the
psychologist. If (s)he serves well as therapist, counselor, teacher, guide or guru,
then the individual may be better prepared to deal with exigencies of his/her altered
life weeks, months or years after (s)he has left the hospital. That is the hope and the
intent. But the hospital staff, including the administrators who hold the purse
strings, will never witness the "pay-off".
A fourth determiner of status is the extent to which a health profession deals in mat-
ters of survival versus "quality of life". When a psychologist correctly predicts, "If
you put so-and-so in a full body cast, he'll cut his way out of it and leave the
hospital," you can be sure they'll check with him/her the next few times they're con-
sidering using a full body cast. In that case, psychological factors have an impact
on physical rehabilitation, the repair of his body - and that's close to a survival
issue. When the same psychologist correctly predicts, "His wife really loves him but
he's going to drive her away by continually testing her unless he gets some help,"
no one gets very alarmed. That only concerns his psyche, a quality of life issue. And
if hospital staff acknowledge the need to deal with psychological problems before
releasing the individual, they would not get Medi-Cal reimbursement for an ex-
tended stay.
It becomes fairly obvious why psychologists in rehabilitation hospitals do
evaluations instead of treatment when there is not time for both. They have products
which are immediate, visible - both as to effort and outcome - and are believed to
impact issues closer to survival than quality of life. "You sure won't be any help to
anybody if they close down your department." It's a matter of survival, and that's im-
portant.
State-Federal Vocational Rehabilitation Agencies
All of the VR agencies have psychological programs. There are certain basic func-
tions, such as the certification of mental retardation, which are assigned to
psychologists. Beyond these minima, the agencies vary. At the meetings of the
Council of State Administrators of Vocational Rehabilitation (CSAVR) I always talk
with two or three administrators about the subject. Only once have I found an ad-
ministrator who was satisfied with the type, quantity and quality of psychological in-
puts (s)he was getting. Several of us who are disatisfied with our own programs,
along with interested psychologists from the federal central office and the American
Psychological Association, are proposing a nationwide workshop - which will in-
clude consumers - to develop alternate models for more effective psychological
support systems for the VR agencies.
In most states, the emphasis is, again, on evaluation. There is very little case service
funding priority for therapy; it is seen as prolonged, costly, and difficult-to-justify.
Most administrators see a need for better mental health facilities in their states
through experience with their clients, but are loath to provide such services with VR
funds even when they appear essential to vocational goal attainment.
I believe that a significant proportion of "28 closures" (clients closed out not em-
ployed, agency failures) are a direct outgrowth of weakness in the psychological
programming. The following observations led to that hypothesis. For three years I
served as a member of the rehabilitation Appeals Board in California. This is a five-
member body, appointed by the Governor, whose duty it is to review Departmental
decisions which are being appealed by clients, former clients and client-applicants.
The Board makes recommendations which can be construed as upholding the
decision of the Department or failing to do so. During the time I served on the
Board, only once did it clearly fail to uphold the Department's decisions. Believing
that no organization could err so seldom, we reviewed the cases we had heard to try
to understand. We arrived at the following tentative conclusion: the specific
decisions being appealed were usually correct decisions, but they came too late
and often after a series of errors which they could not rectify. Thus, the client wasn't
ready for the decision; (s)he'd been led to expect something different. In a few
cases, a client probably should not have been judged 'feasible' at the outset without
psychological or psychiatric concurrence. There were many cases in which we
thought the counselor, ideally, should have recognized any number of red flags in
the early case data to warn him/her: "There are psychodynamic factors involved
here that may sabotage the rehabilitation plan" or, "This person needs a trained
psychotherapist, don't get in over your head." There were other problems, too, but
the prevalent precursor to an appeal appeared to be counselors' lack of
psychodiagnostic acumen and follow-through skills coupled with inadequate
resources for expert help.
As a result of this analysis I took the issue one step further. The supervisor of a VR
branch office and I conducted an exhaustive case review of a year's total output of
"28 closures" seeking to confirm or disconfirm these impressions. Out of 33 cases,
we found four with no evidence of counselor error involved. These were recognized
high risk cases in which the counselor had given his/her all, failed, and there was
no fault to be found. The other 29 cases showed evidence of counselor error in one
to four different areas; vocational (20 instances), psychological (16 instances),
relationship (nine instances), and medical (three instances). Thus, the hypothesis
was partially confirmed. Errors in the psychological area were not the most frequent,
but they ran a close second with the third lagging far behind. Rehabilitation coun-
selors cannot be expected to be expert practitioners in all of the many disciplines
they are called upon to orchestrate on behalf of their clients. Nevertheless, it is clear
that greater psychological expertise needs to be introduced into the system. As
hinted above, California is beginning to make changes designed to respond to this
need.
The California agency has a full-time vocational psychologist in each of its 26
district offices. Previously, that person's role was almost exclusively the ad-
ministration and interpretation of vocational assessment instruments to guide coun-
selor and client in the search for a suitable vocational goal. This was not a very
fulfilling job, and it left significant unmet needs for the counselor. A new policy has
been formulated. The functions of these psychologists have been expanded to in-
clude consultation with and training of counselors in the application of a wide
range of psychological principles, knowledge, skills and techniques. Excess testing
demands are to be contracted out to practititioners in the community SO they will
not, de facto, weaken the consultation and training program. The vocational
psychologists still do not do therapy. Most are unlicensed and the time consumption
would be too great. However, they are expected to know the community resources
thoroughly so they can refer the client to the most competent treatment available for
the types of problems he presents.
The VR agencies contract for work evaluation, work adjustment and related worker
preparation services from private sector facilities such as workshops. Because psy-
chologists are expensive and funds are always tight, almost none of these facilities
include psychologists on staff. One exception is the Work Preparation Center at
Rancho Los Amigos Hospital. Several clinical psychologists conduct and supervise
group and individual counseling/psychotherapy as well as rather sophisticated
behavior modification programs centered upon work behavior. Two very different
examples should illustrate the range of possibilities that this richness of
psychological staffing can offer.
1) An experimental program was implemented for brain-injured men who were so
affected by stimuli in the environment that they could barely sustain half
minimum-wage production levels. A token economy was introduced and distrac-
ting stimuli were eliminated, step by step, until the environment was sufficiently
distraction-free so that several of the men were able to work at minimum-wage
productivity in the main shop.
2) A group counseling program for "singles" was offered jointly to workshop
clients, who had a variety of physical and mental disabilities, and nearby Cerritos
College students, who had no discernible disabilities. The hope was to get a few
able-bodied students involved to mitigate the feelings of many clients that their
"singles" problems were due to their disabilities. The response on the part of the
students was so great that there had to be a limit on the number who could par-
ticipate. Those students learned far more from the clients than the clients learned
from them. They learned a little about tragedy, alot about coping, and the most
about human commonalities. The disabled folks put a great deal back into that
system.
Independent Living Programs
One of the most helpful approaches to appear on the psychological services scene
is peer counseling - whether it relates to independent living needs of people with
disabilities or being black, brown, yellow or red in a predominantly white society, or
being a woman in "a man's world." Peer, rather than professional, counseling is
being used in many places now, sometimes because of a lack of professional man-
power, and increasingly often because it is the treatment of choice. Psychologically
normal people adjusting to unusual situations often need tutorial more than
therapeutic services - an experienced person to teach them how to traverse dif-
ficult terrain. Hot lines, group sharing, and a host of other peer counseling
techniques are being used by self-help organizations of disabled people, including
independent living programs, student groups, and organizations devoted primarily
to social/recreational or political action goals.
The independent living programs are definitely not in the business of doing
psychological evaluations. They are attempting to meet the needs for help, and
largely through peer counseling. Some of the peers are actually highly trained,
professional counselors from the spectrum of professional disciplines (e.g.,
psychology, social work, psychiatry, the ministry, marriage-family-child counseling,
rehabilitation counseling). Others are crash-trained lay counselors. Still others do
their counseling without benefit of any specific training. If the nature or extent of
problems calls for it, the independent living programs provide referral services to
professionals in the community.
The problem with peer counseling devolves upon selection and training as methods
of assuring reasonable standards of competence. Not everyone, just because (s)he
has experienced disability, is capable of being helpful to another. Some would-be
helpers lack the qualities which are important in a helping relationship, such as the
classics of warmth, genuineness and empathy. Others have developed un-
wholesome attitudes and responses to disability themselves and for this reason
would not be helpful influences. Thus, even when peer counselors volunteer to work
without pay they must still be screened and selected with care equivalent to that
devoted to hiring salaried employees.
Similarly, it is a rare occurrence to find a natural counselor who is consistently ef-
fective with diverse people without benefit of training. Some kind of training must be
provided for otherwise untrained peer counselors. Happily, there is much available
to draw from. In the past decade, scores of excellent books and programs have
come out detailing methods for preparing paraprofessional counselors to form
helping relationships, or helping friendships, with people having many kinds of
trouble. Some have so impressed me with their simplicity yet completeness of con-
cept that I believe they would be good continuing education experiences for highly,
and perhaps too theoretically, trained professionals.
The Private Sector of Psychological Clinics and Practitioners
There are very few practitioners, either in clinics or private practice who are aware
of what we are here calling the psychology of disability. One of the reasons is
economic. To date, not very many disabled people have been able to afford
psychotherapy in the private sector. Thus, there was little demand to learn.
Legislators and insurance carriers are beginning to manifest acknowledgement that
these services should be covered by insurance, not out of pocket, so the demand
may grow. With respect to traditional talking therapy, there may not be a crucial
problem. If the therapist is good with people, (s)he should be good with a person
who happens to have a disability.
However, some of the newer treatment approaches being used by psychotherapists
are finally mending the mind-body split that has impeded both the medical and
psychological healing arts for so long. Many of these cannot be used with disabled,
especially severely disabled people, without thoughtful deliberation aimed at
modifying the techniques. Some of these techniques are bioenergetics, body-
awareness and sensory awakening techniques, aerobic and anaerobic exercises,
and techniques drawn from ancient disciplines such as yoga, pressure-point
therapy and the martial arts. Some, such as Rolfing may require medical advice as
to contraindications before being used with people who have physical disabilities.
Still others present no particular problems of application, such as biofeedback and
a vast array of meditation techniques, but should simply be tried more systematically
because they appear to offer remarkable opportunities for personal growth that are
especially relevant to people with restricted mobility or sensory capacities.
Thoughts on the Future
I would like to see a pervasive shift in values; an attitudinal re-orientation both
within the rehabilitation movement and without. The core of this change would be
far more attention paid to the inner aspects of rehabilitation - the rehabilitation of
the spirit, psyche or soul and perhaps a little less to the outer aspects - the
rehabilitation of the arms, legs and pocketbook.
Focusing on the rehabilitation hospital, I would like to see psychological services at
the hub, and medical, social, and vocational out at the ends of the spokes where I
think they belong. The body repairs and vocational re-establishment are important
ancillaries to the real business of rehabilitation, which goes on in the head, heart
and gut, not the extremities. If the person knows (s)he's at least as okay as (s)he
ever was and maybe a little bit better for having endured the test, (s)he'll make sure
(s)he gets his/her body in the best shape possible - the better to carry on a life
(s)he has reason to look forward to. If (s)he understands to the roots of his/her being
that (s)he is only different today from what (s)he was yesterday, not less, (s)he'll
make sure (s)he gets his/her pocketbook in the best shape possible for the same
reason.
Professional rehabilitators are plagued by unmotivated, uncooperative patients and
clients for one major reason. They are trying to build a rehabilitated fortress on the
shifting sands of self-hatred. They don't reckon with it because they figure the self-
hatred makes sense. There is only one group of people who can get the message
across that it doesn't: people who have been through the experience and emerged
on the other side unscathed and joyful — and feeling their joy would be less com-
plete if any element of their experience were changed.
Focusing on the VR agencies, the needs for change are much the same. I am begin-
ning to question whether vocational psychologists are needed at all. The
rehabilitation counselor is, or should be, the vocational expert. Why do we need
vocational experts for the vocational experts? The complementary skill and ex-
pertise needed is clinical acumen, non-vocational psychologists who can bring
them something different from what they should already have. The VR agencies
need to worry less about marshalling every resource to ensure '26's' and a little
more about helping clients get their inner **** together — because if this happens,
the 26's may very well take care of themselves.
With respect to the independent living programs, I have just one topic for comment.
I have observed an area of potential danger for indigenous counselors. Having
reached a certain level in our own development, and looking back with the prover-
bial magnifying retrospectoscope at pain and struggling that seem to have been
needless, there emerges a desire to short circuit the process for others. In general
principle, there is nothing wrong with that. But discriminations should be made as
to when short-circuiting may relieve the person of needless suffering, and when it
may cut necessary groundwork out from under a later stage of development. Maybe
we had to go through it. Maybe they do, too. Training offered to peer counselors
should include such considerations.
Services are available to disabled people who cannot use standard body techniques
unless they are modified. Further, a disabled client or patient should not have to pay
the same fee while a therapist experiments and tries to figure out how a technique
can be adapted. More critical, both public and private insurance programs must
pay. It will do no good for therapists to be waiting with modified treatment ap-
proaches if no one can afford to consume them.
Cutting across all, research must be done. I don't expect to be believed just
because I say that taxpayers are paying in untold ways because society has not
given credence to the importance of helping disabled people combat, conquer and
transcend the devaluation that is forced upon them. The Rehabilitation Act could
point the way it grows more sophisticated, realistic and sensible each time it is re-
written and it guides the field. When it is next re-written it should mandate the
needed research and, until the results are in, insist that the psychological substrates
of vocational rehabilitation at least be attended to.
Finally, there are some things that need to be done in the 'other half' of the applied
psychology of disability - advocacy to change certain destructive stimulus con-
ditions. One of the foremost is to interfere with the way people with disabilities are
represented in the fictional mass media, and not represented at all in ad-
vertisements of commercial products. The public's beliefs and feelings about
groups of people with whom they have little contact is largely shaped by how they
see them portrayed on the screen. When disabled people are typically portrayed as
twisted or chronically depressed and unable to think about anything but their
disabilities, it's no wonder salesladies ask our able-bodied companions what size
we wear. How does a girl who uses a wheelchair grow up assuming, like other girls,
that she will take care of a house someday when she never sees one of 'her group'
waxing the floor or frying chicken? The answers you get when you make inquiries
incite rage. "The people only want to see beautiful people!" "We can't use crip-
ples, it would turn people off from our products!" I doubt it. A floor wax that could
be successfully applied by someone using a wheelchair ought to sell like hotcakes.
I think we have to get as assertive as the Blacks have in demanding that we be
represented realistically in fiction and appear in commercials. We constitute at least
as large- a segment of the population.
Carolyn L. Vash, Ph.D.
Chief Deputy Director
State Department of
Rehabilitation
107 S. Broadway, Room 7106
Los Angeles, Ca. 90012
CIL HISTORY
Hale Zukas
The Center for Independent Living, Inc., came into existence as a formal entity in
March 1972, but its origins extend considerably further back in time and place; on
occasion fortuitous circumstance has also played a role.
The roots of CIL can be traced to the Cowell Residence Program at the University
of California, Berkeley. In 1962, Ed Roberts, a post-polio respiratory quadriplegic,
became-one of the first severely disabled persons to be admitted to the University.
Since he had to spend most of the time in an iron lung, it was decided that the only
feasible living arrangement would be a room at the Student Health Service-Cowell
Hospital on campus. By 1966, two traumatic quadriplegics had also moved into
Cowell; three years later there were 12 severely disabled students in the Cowell
Residence Program, which had by then been formally established and was being
supported by the California Department of Rehabilitation.
In 1969, the atmosphere at Cowell was a peculiar combination of disparate
elements. On one hand, the CRP provided a quite sheltered living situation; indeed,
in its hospital location (albeit in a separate wing) it bore some resemblance to the
custodial institutions to which disabled people are so often relegated. The residents
of the Cowell Program, for the most part, confined their movements to the campus
as there was considerable apprehension about traveling out into the community. In
part this was because the electric wheelchairs then available were unreliable or had
very limited range. Even if their chairs had been adequate to the task, however, the
surrounding community was largely inaccessible to them. There were no curb
ramps in Berkeley, for example, until a four-block section of the main shopping
street south of campus was reconstructed in 1969-70; ramps were incorporated in
this project at the urging of the Cowell residents.
This insularity also had its positive aspects, however. In the Cowell Program,
residents were in close, continuing contact with other people having similar
problems and concerns. A sense of unity and self-confidence gradually developed,
largely as a result of the free flow of communication and sharing of experience. The
residents' political consciousness grew as they became aware of the degree to
which control over their lives had been taken over by medical and rehabilitation
professionals. They thus came to realize that the concerns about self-determination
raised by the black and student movements had considerable relevance to their own
lives as disabled people. This consciousness-raising process was accelerated in
1969 when the rehabilitation counselor assigned to the Cowell Program tried, with
the support of all but one of the professionals associated with the program, to have
two of its residents evicted because she deemed their educational goals unfeasible
and their life styles improper. United as never before, the Cowell residents defeated
the counselor in this effort.
As time went on, the residents found the bureaucratic and in loco parentis restric-
tions under which they had to live at Cowell a source of increasing aggravation. Ad-
ditionally, by 1969, some residents were nearing the end of their academic careers
and consequently would have to leave Cowell. The need for some kind of alternative
to the CRP was thus becoming more and more apparent. In order to address this
need in a systematic manner, most of the Cowell residents in the Fall of 1969
organized their own class, called "Strategies of Independent Living," under the
University's group studies program. Initially the major emphasis of the class was on
developing a proposal for a communal living arrangement which would be similar in
some respects to the Cowell Program but which would be controlled by residents
themselves and open to non-students as well as students. After a few weeks of work
on the proposal, however, it became apparent that establishing and operating such
a facility would be very costly and that funding would be extremely difficult to find.
In the meantime, Ed Roberts had learned of the Special Services program operating
out of the federal Office of Education. Under this program various kinds of aid were
available to disadvantaged students to enable them to successfully pursue college
studies. In the establishing legislation Congress had expressed its intention that ten
percent of the appropriation for the program be allocated to services for physically
disabled students. It was reported that the Office of Education would be very recep-
tive to a proposal for a program of services to disabled students on the Berkeley
campus. Consequently, the students in the class put aside the establishment of a
communal living arrangement and turned their attention to developing a program of
supportive services which would enable severely disabled students to live in-
dependently and function more effectively as students.
Defining the services which should make up such a program was a relatively simple
and straightforward process. The students drew on their own experience and
figured out what services they would need in order to live independently in the com-
munity. They would need a pool of people available to help them in getting up,
dressing, bowel and bladder care, preparing meals, and the many other activities of
daily living that anyone leading an active life must perform. They would need fast,
reliable wheelchair repair, for without a wheelchair in operating condition they were
little better off than if they were bedridden. They would need assistance in obtaining
the financial benefits and services to which they are entitled from other agencies, so
they would have the resources needed to lead independent lives. Accordingly, an
attendant referral service and provision for emergency attendant care, a wheelchair
repair service, and an advocacy component were incorporated into the proposed
program along with a component devoted to helping disabled students deal with
University-related matters, such as pre-enrollment, getting classes moved to ac-
cessible locations, and making special arrangements for examinations when
necessary:
The fact that the idea for a services program, on the one hand, came about largely
for expedient reasons (namely, the exigencies of funding) and, on the other hand,
was a logical outgrowth of the students' past experience might lead one to overlook
its enormous significance for disabled people, not only in Berkeley but throughout
the country. The approach envisioned in the proposed Physically Disabled
Students' Program (PDSP) was a radical departure from past practice in the medical
and rehabilitation fields. In contrast to the fragmentation which characterized the
existing services, the PDSP would take a holistic, integrated approach by providing
a comprehensive array of services in recognition of the fact that disabled people are
likely to have a variety of needs, and functional independence will be hard to
achieve unless all those needs are met. Self-evident though this may seem in hind-
sight, such an approach had, to our knowledge, never been tried before.
Over the years, the Cowell residents had evolved what might be called a
philosophy of disability out of their collective experience. In the proposal for the
PDSP, the guiding principles of this philosophy were clearly articulated for perhaps
the first time. They were the following:
1. Those who know best the needs of disabled people and how to meet those needs
are the disabled people themselves.
2. The needs of the disabled can be met most effectively by comprehensive
programs which provide a variety of services.
3. Disabled people should be integrated as fully as possible into their community.
Most of those active in the development of the PDSP were spinal cord injured, and
they were naturally primarily concerned with services that would meet their own
needs. But there was also an awareness on the part of some of those involved that
broadening the program to serve people with a wide range of disabilities, including
the blind, could be beneficial to all concerned. In addition, it was hoped that
establishing a working relationship between disability groups which had
traditionally had little to do with one another would lead to a coalition which could
exert increased influence in the political arena. It was consequently decided that
there would be blind representation on the PDSP staff.
Funded in July 1970, the PDSP began full operation two months later with a full- and
part-time staff of nine, of whom five, including the director, were severely disabled
or blind. During its first year, the PDSP provided a clear demonstration of the
validity of the premises on which it had been founded. Disabled students began
moving from Cowell out into the community; the drop-out rate was almost nil com-
pared to that among disabled students at other institutions of higher learning; and
there was a sharp reduction in medical problems. The effectiveness of different
disability groups working together was also shown. Not only did the extent to which
their problems and needs coincided become apparent, but services originally
tailored to the needs of orthopedically disabled were adapted to the needs of the
blind. For example, the attendant referral service was expanded to also provide
readers for the blind.
That the PDSP was providing needed services unavailable anywhere else was in-
dicated by the steadily growing volume of requests for assistance it received. At
first, these requests came from students, but as word of its unique services spread
through the surrounding community, more and more disabled non-students began
to call upon the PDSP for help. The PDSP rarely if ever turned people away on the
grounds that they were non-students. By the Spring of 1971, the time devoted to
community people had begun to seriously affect the PDSP's ability to meet the
needs of the students whom it was established to serve. Out of this dilemma arose
the idea of establishing another program parallel to the PDSP to serve disabled and
blind people in the surrounding community. Thus the seeds of the Center for In-
dependent Living were planted.
At the instigation of the PDSP administration, a group of interested disabled people,
including both students and non-students, met in May 1971 to begin discussing how
to put together a community-based services program. Over the next year, this group
put in many hours of work toward this end, meeting an average of once a week.
From the beginning there was a firm commitment not only to the three principles
outlined on page three, but also to the principle that CIL would be an organization
of and for all disability groups, more specifically, a coalition of the orthopedically
disabled and the blind. These two groups had traditionally gone their separate
ways, and in this pioneering attempt to work together, it was only to be expected
that strains would occasionally develop in their relationship. By its very nature, a
coalition is a gathering of groups with different interests which come together to
pursue some larger objective. Making any true coalition work thus requires a con-
scious effort. Those involved in organizing the CIL made this effort; the resultant
benefits accruing to both the disabled and blind have shown that it was eminently
worthwhile.
For example, wheelchair curb ramps in Berkeley have been placed so the blind will
continue to have the detectable curbs they need in order to know when they are
about to cross a street.
It was after the idea of coalition between the disabled and blind spread beyond
CIL to groups active in the political arena, however, that it produced its biggest
dividends. For the first time the disabled came to be recognized as a force to be
reckoned with in the California legislature. Their efforts were in no small part
responsible for the fact that SSI benefit levels in California are just about the
highest in the country.
The groundwork laid by the PDSP was of inestimable value in defining the general
approach and methodology the CIL would follow. The task entailed in establishing
the CIL, however, differed in several important respects from that which faced the
founders of PDSP. For one thing, the populations to be served by the two programs
were quite different. The disabled students at the University were a relatively small
and homogeneous group, residing for the most part within a limited geographical
area, and readily identifiable. The target population envisioned for the CIL, on the
other hand, was considerably larger and very heterogeneous, spread over a com-
paratively large area, and in large part very hard to identify, let alone reach. Those
involved in the development of CIL were well aware that they were not represen-
tative of the disabled population of the community at large. They were thus very
conscious of the need for community input into the design of services and, once
those services were in operation, into their evaluation.
Secondly, obtaining funding for the CIL was more difficult than for the PDSP; other
than the in-kind support provided by the PDSP, its only resources during this period
were occasional contributions from some of those active in the organization,
proceeds from a few benefit poker games, and a $250 donation from the local Rotary
Club.
In July 1972, three months after its incorporation, the CIL received a one-year
$50,000 grant from the federal Rehabilitation Services Administration to enable it to
get on its feet organizationally and to do a systematic job of research and planning
for a comprehensive community-based services program for the disabled and blind.
During most of the grant period, the major emphasis of the CIL was on developing a
proposal for such a program costing, in its various forms, from $250,000 to $400,000
per year. As the expiration of the grant drew near and prospects of new funding
continued to prove fruitless, the CIL staff lowered its sights considerably, and the
prime objective became, not expansion, but simple survival. In the last week of June
1973, the CIL was informed that a renewal of the planning grant, its last hope, would
not be forthcoming. At this point the CIL was in serious danger of going under. In an
attempt to avert this eventuality, a few CIL staff members, along with Ed Roberts and
John Hessler, Director of the PDSP, met with University Vice-Chancellor Robert
Kerley to ask for his help. Through Kerley's personal intercession $15,000 was made
available through the University's Community Projects Office to keep the CIL afloat
for another four months. In August the City of Berkeley allocated $15,000 to the CIL
to cover a year's overhead costs, principally rent and utilities. Even though these
two grants by no means assured the CIL's future, there was a strong feeling among
the staff that there had been enough of planning and it was time to get down to the
business at hand and start delivering direct services, without regard to what the
future might hold. In September 1972, the CIL established its own attendant referral
service, giving limited help with locating housing, and providing transportation with
a donated Volkswagen van.
The University money stopped in mid-November 1973, and the CIL became essen-
tially dormant. Understandably, demoralization among the staff was widespread. In
late December, however, word was received with great rejoicing that the San Fran-
cisco Foundation had approved the CIL's application for $30,000. Regular
operations were resumed with the start of the new year. In March 1974, the long
search for a facility to replace the two-bedroom South campus apartment which had
been the CIL's base of operations since August 1972, culminated in a move to a
much larger and more centrally located quarters in the downtown area. At about the
same time, the CIL was allocated approximately $35,000 on a six-month basis from
Alameda County revenue-sharing funds. With the reasonable expectation that each
of the current grants would be renewed, a relatively firm base of financial support
had been established which assured that CIL would be able to maintain at least a
modest level of activity over the next several years.
While it would have been desirable to obtain funding for the CIL in one com-
prehensive package, experience had thus shown that the only feasible strategy was
to fund CIL on a piecemeal basis through an accumulation of relatively small
grants. The CIL has continued to pursue such a funding strategy in the intervening
period with considerable success, and several new programs have been established
as funding has become available. The multiplicity of funding sources and the ac-
companying rapid expansion makes it difficult to chart, except in very general
terms, the direction CIL should take in its future development. One thing has not
changed, however: the CIL's overall objective is still eminently well described by its
name.
CIL's service program is geared to increase the disabled person's potential for
independence. The following is an outline of current CIL services and programs.
1. Attendant referral counselors interview, screen and place prospective attendants
with disabled people who need help with such tasks as bathing, dressing, and
housekeeping. Counselors also give advice on hiring, training, and firing at-
tendants.
2. Advocacy counselors provide information to clients on how and where to apply
for local, state and federal financial and medical aid programs. Counselors inform
clients of regulations, benefits and rights under such programs. They also assist in
fair hearings whenever necessary.
3. The job development specialist teaches job-seeking skills, maintains contacts
with potential employers, and helps disabled and blind people find employment.
4. The independent living skills counselor evaluates a client's mobility, indoors and
outside, examines the architectural layout of his home, and suggests special adap-
tive aids, equipment, and techniques which make daily living tasks easier. The
counselor also evaluates the client's need for programs to increase muscle
strength, joint mobility, etc.
5. Peer counselors combine professional counseling skills with personal experience
gained from living with a disability. Counseling services currently offered include
individual and family counseling, groups for mates and parents of disabled people,
as well as consciousness-raising groups for the disabled themselves.
6. The health maintenance program stresses personal responsibility for body
awareness and individual health. Through home visits and informal office sessions
the program helps disabled people understand bowel, bladder, skin, and respiratory
problems and treatments. Counselors suggest medical equipment, promote satisfac-
tory communication between patients and medical professionals, and train prospec-
tive attendants and families in care techniques for the disabled.
7. The housing department keeps listings of accessible houses and apartments,
helps disabled people find places to live, and is available for consultation regarding
house modifications.
8. The blind services department conducts individual and group counseling, client
advocacy, mobility instruction and recreational activities specifically for the blind
and partially sighted.
9. CIL's demand-response transportation service is available to the aged, blind, and
disabled of the East Bay. It provides cross-town mobility for any reason to people
who have no access to public or private transportation. All vehicles are fully equip-
ped with mobile radios, hydraulic lifts, and securement for wheelchairs. Service is
available from 8:00 am to midnight, Monday through Friday, and the vans are
available for charter on weekends.
10. CIL-s wheelchair repair shop is the largest in Northern California. It provides
while-you-wait service for both manual and electric wheelchairs, 9:00 am to 5:00 pm
weekdays and noon to 5:00 pm weekends. Emergency evening service is also
available.
11. The automotive and machine shop mechanics conduct classes for staff and
clients in vehicle maintenance and general machine shop practice as well as being
responsible for servicing all CIL vehicles.
12. The community affairs department is attacking the physical, economic, and
social problems of the disabled on the federal, state, and local levels. On the local
level this has meant close cooperative work with city agencies leading to the in-
stallation of curb ramps and removal of architectural barriers.
13. The communications department publishes The Independent, a quarterly
magazine with a national circulation. The relevance of The Independent's subject
matter to the disabled everywhere is reflected by the increase in circulation from
1000 in the Bay Area to over 7000 nationally.
14. The Research and Demonstration Project, as one of six delivery system demon-
stration projects funded by the Rehabilitation Services Administration and coor-
dinated with the National Comprehensive Needs Study of the Severely Disabled, is a
demonstration of the advantages of a peer counseling approach to delivery of ser-
vices to the severely disabled: The project works with a few, hard-to-serve clients
providing CIL-type services on a small scale. Research staff carefully document
procedures and results so that the project can produce guidelines and serve as a
model for future disabled services agencies nationwide.
Training
1. The Computer Training Project trains people with severe disabilities in computer
programming and places them in jobs with the help of an advisory committee of
representatives from major corporations. The instructors, disabled themselves, and
the CIL services staff work with the students to prepare them for the working world.
2. Through the California Department of Rehabilitation, CIL employs disabled and
blind people as On-the-Job Trainees to learn skills ranging from wheelchair repair
to peer counseling. Some trainees are guaranteed jobs at CIL after their training,
and others go on to positions in business and government.
3. Using specially developed materials, CIL trains rehabilitation counselors, police,
and fire department personnel to better understand disabled people. One part of the
project is a five day course for rehabilitation counselors in which each counselor
spends five days in a wheelchair or blindfolded.
4. CIL, in conjunction with the Center for Health Studies/Antioch College, offers
M.A. and B.A. degrees in Health Services Administration and Psychology with em-
phasis on counseling and services for the disabled. This degree program is the only
one in the United States focusing on the psychology of disability using the peer
counseling approach as practiced at CIL.
Business Enterprise Program
Funding from private foundations and government makes it possible for CIL to
provide services free-of-charge except for transportation (30¢ a ride) and
wheelchair and van repair (paid by Medi-Cal, private insurance companies, or in-
dividuals). As a first step toward financial self-sufficiency, CIL has established a
business enterprise program.
1. The wheelchair repair shop derives income from sale of parts and services and is
currently self-supporting. The shop is a dealership for major brands of durable
medical products, and its mail order department sells van tie-downs, Davis forks,
and other equipment.
2. CIL's machine shop is in the business of making cars and vans accessible to the
disabled by installing hand controls, lift gates, ramps, and tie-downs.
3. CIL is studying the state-of-the-art of wheelchair design in order to develop and
eventually market a wheelchair with exceptional durability and performance.
4. The California Department of Rehabilitation contracts for CIL services such as
mobility instruction and living skills counseling.
Hale Zukas
Center for Independent Living, Inc.
2539 Telegraph Avenue
Berkeley, California 94704
(415) 841-4776
THE ROLE OF THE STATE VR AGENCY
Donald E. Galvin
Introductory Statement
The state-federal vocational rehabilitation partnership is the oldest and most mature
of all programs designed to make an impact upon dependence resulting from
disability. Federal legislation concerned with rehabilitation had, since 1920, reflec-
ted a steadily-broadening concept. Beginning as a modest extension of vocational
education, vocational rehabilitation agencies have gradually assumed responsibility
for a greater array of services to a wider range and severity of disabling conditions.
The concern for expanding and improving services to the severely handicapped is a
pervasive theme throughout the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 and the 1974 Amend-
ments. Several specific references to the severely handicapped appear in Section 2,
The Declaration of Purpose. For example, the Act reads, "The purpose of this Act is
to provide a statutory basis for the RSA and to authorize programs to: (1) develop
and implement comprehensive and continuing State Plans for meeting the current
and future needs for providing vocational rehabilitation services to handicapped in-
dividuals and to provide such services for the benefit of such individuals, serving
first those with the most severe handicaps so that they may prepare for and engage
in gainful employment; (3) conduct a study to develop methods of providing
rehabilitation services to meet the current and future needs of handicapped in-
dividuals for whom a vocational goal is not possible or feasible so that they may im-
prove their ability to live with greater independence and self-sufficiency; (5)
develop new and innovative methods of applying the most advanced medical
technology, scientific advancement, and psychological and social knowledge to
solve rehabilitation problems and develop new and innovative methods of providing
rehabilitation services to handicapped individuals through research, special
projects, and demonstrations; (11) evaluate existing approaches to architectural and
transportation barriers confronting handicapped individuals, develop new such ap-
proaches, enforce statutory and regulatory standards and requirements regarding
barrier free construction of public facilities and study and develop solutions to
existing architectural and transportation barriers impending handicapped in-
dividuals."
Thus, with the passage of Public Law 92-112, the state-federal partnership has com-
mitted itself to expand and improve services to individuals with severe handicaps.
State vocational rehabilitation agencies are now free from many of the legal barriers
which have, in the past, discouraged counselors from accepting clients whose
feasibility was questionable due to the severity of the handicap. The new freedom
and the accompanying opportunity present a number of problems and challenges to
vocational rehabilitation agencies. It will be necessary to plan for the provision of
vocational rehabilitation services in the light of broad community needs and the
ability of public and private vocational rehabilitation agencies to share common
responsibilities. As important as this has been in the past, rehabilitation agencies
now, and in the future, must be more effective in providing statewide and community
leadership, in identifying the needs of the severely handicapped, and in providing
effective services which result in enhanced independence and freedom for the
severely handicapped.
I. Some Administrative Considerations
A. The State Plan
In keeping with the requirements of the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 and the
1974 Amendments, each state agency must include in its 1975 Program and
Financial Plan to the Rehabilitation Service Administration a formal
statement containing the plans, policies, and methods to be followed in
carrying out the State Plan, including a description of the methods to be used
to expand and improve services to handicapped individuals with the most
severe handicaps. The Plan must also confirm that in the event that services
cannot be provided to all who are in need of services, first consideration will
be given to serving those with the most severe handicaps.
B. Program Planning
Rational planning and program. development requires an estimate of the
population in need, an appraisal of the variety of services required, the cost
of such services, a determination of program effectiveness in achieving
stated goals, the impact on related programs, and the identification of service
delivery mechanisms which have proven most successful.
C. Program and Project Evaluation
The state agencies are required to initiate program and project evaluation to
assess effectiveness in achieving the goals stated in the planning
documents. State agencies are to assess population in need data as well as
measure, analyze, and report the results of providing services to the disabled
in general and to the severely handicapped in particular. States need to
evaluate the effectiveness and efficiency of services in terms of benefits to
clients and program costs.
D. Public Education
In 1968, the Report of the National Citizens Advisory Committee on
Vocational Rehabilitation stated, "Public awareness of modern rehabilitation
programs, and their capacity to deal effectively with the problems of
disability, lags far behind technical advances in restoring disabled people to
active lives
the average citizen knows so little of today's rehabilitation
programs that he is completely unprepared when disability strikes him or his
family." While some progress has been made in the last seven years, far too
many citizens, in general the disabled and helping professionals, still lack
the kind of information which will allow them to take advantage of the ser-
vices which do exist.
This general lack of information and misunderstanding has many unfortunate
consequences. The disabled too often must rely upon another agency to
make contact with the state VR agency; often inappropriate referrals are
made because the sending agent knows little about the state agency
eligibility criteria, services priorities, and objectives. Job placement is hin-
dered as most employers know little about rehabilitation or are misinformed
about the skills and abilities of the disabled person.
It is an administrative responsibility to broadly enunciate the new policy
statement in terms of priority to the severely handicapped through the media,
interagency meetings, professional conferences, cooperative agreements,
and publications. Public education can best be achieved through the coor-
dinated efforts of public and private agencies, other service providers and
consumers of services.
E. Legislative Relations
It is incumbent upon the state agency to develop a strategy which can con-
vey realistic goals and objectives to legislative bodies. The state agencies
need to arm themselves with data and evidence on cost and effectiveness in
serving the severely disabled.
The state VR agency must also play a leadership role in effecting civil rights,
employment, and Workmen's Compensation legislation which benefit the
handicapped. The state agencies should also take a more aggressive and
positive advocacy position in such areas as architectural barriers, availability
and accessibility to housing, mass transportation systems, and recreational
services.
F. Consumer Participation
A major theme in the vocational rehabilitation hearings before Congress in-
volved consumer participation, i.e., the involvement of clients and client ad-
vocates in developing state agency policies, programs, and in the case ser-
vice decisions which affect the lives of the handicapped. It is this concern
which underlies the requirement in the new law for an individually-written
rehabilitation program of service.
The renewed pride among the handicapped which has led them con-
structively and responsibly to seek and achieve a greater measure of their
civil rights is a significant and promising development. This new self-reliance
is reflected in the fight for and subsequent victories in some states in
achieving barrier free design laws. Further, through the specific efforts of the
handicapped, the whole question of civil rights for the handicapped is now
before legislative bodies in several states.
In addition, through the efforts of the handicapped, there has been some
"consciousness raising" among service providers, employers, public of-
ficials, and the general public. As an extension of their "self-declaration," we
find handicapped persons participating much more with both public and
voluntary agencies in devising those policies which will affect the lives of the
handicapped. The handicapped are taking a healthy, participative role as
consumers on various advisory councils, boards and commissions, and in
providing testimony before legislative groups. Persons who at one time were
served by rehabilitation agencies are becoming more evident as board mem-
bers, policy-makers, consultants to, and staff of, the same rehabilitation
agencies. The state VR agency can avail itself of the input and reaction of
consumers, client advocate groups and service providers through including
such representatives on advisory councils, boards and commissions, through
public hearings dealing with issues of program policies and priorities, and
through periodic review sessions between the VR administrative leadership
and consumers on topical matters.
We should also note the more symbolic importance of the involvement of the
client in the original development and all revisions of their rehabilitation plan
of service. The written plan of service is to include the views of the client
toward the plan and services received. In some states, the client or guardian
will be asked to co-sign the plan of service. The new Act also provides for an-
nual re-evaluations of those clients closed not rehabilitated, those not ac-
cepted because of severe handicap, and those closed in sheltered
workshops and homebound programs. Client fair hearings and administrative
reviews are also to be made available so as to deal with client
dissatisfactions and resolve disputed issues.
G. Staff Professional Development
Much of what will appear later addresses itself to the need to enhance the
quality of rehabilitation services through enriching the skills and knowledge
of the rehabilitation counselor.
Unfortunately, many rehabilitation counselors are not prepared, by academic
training, work experience, or personal interest to serve the severely han-
dicapped. It is probably fair to say that a sizable proportion of those coun-
selors hired by state VR agencies during the last decade have concentrated
their efforts upon serving the mentally ill and those with behavioral disorders
including alcoholics, drug abusers, and public offenders. These counselors
have limited training or experience and, in some cases, lack the attitudinal
make up to effectively serve the severely physically handicapped. There is
clearly a need to "reorient" many counselors by way of extensive staff
development.
Efforts should be made to convey medical information and the physical
rehabilitation aspects of vocational rehabilitation; to place greater emphasis
upon vocational evaluation techniques and the vocational implications of
disabilities; to strengthen the role of the counselor as a vocational expert for
the disabled; to conduct joint training with private health agencies, advocacy
and consumer groups; and to develop formal training contracts with physical
medicine and/or university affiliated medical centers for long-term and
systematic training.
Attitudinal training of counselors which would help them to be more sensitive
to the needs of the disabled and more relaxed and responsive in meeting
their needs should not be overlooked.
A sound professional development program should also make use of modern
media approaches to training and should emphasize a performance or com-
petency based approach which will provide the rehabilitation counselor with
the skills, knowledge and attitudes he or she will need to provide effective
services to the severely handicapped. Some other components of a modern
and comprehensive professional development program include the
following:
1. A systematic approach to the determination of training needs.
2. A plan for continuing education within the larger framework of career
development for all classes of employees within the agency.
3. A performance-based training evaluation system.
II. Some Service Delivery Considerations
Over the years, recipients and providers of service alike have commented upon
long delays, duplication of effort and general inefficiency in the delivery of
rehabilitation services. These concerns appear rather routinely in any evaluation
of our human service delivery system. However, the prevalence of such dysfunc-
tion makes the consequences no more acceptable.
Our ambitions for the vocational rehabilitation service delivery system are in-
deed impressive. Ideally, we want to provide effective, comprehensive, and in-
dividualized services which are at the same time well coordinated, economical
and expeditious - all within a responsible and accountable system which
respects client rights and provides priority to those most in need.
Federal regulations and the principles of good professional practice dictate an
individualized plan of service for each client; however, economies of scale are
deliberately sacrificed in such an approach for a conscious effort is made not to
force a "group solution" upon individual clients. Complicating the problem is
the fact that most services required by VR clients are not under the direct control
of the state vocational rehabilitation agency. For example, the professional
providers of diagnostic information, for the most part physicians and
psychologists, are independent practitioners. While many such practitioners
have extended special considerations to public and private agencies in an effort
to accelerate the delivery of service, the fact remains these health care
professionals are in limited supply and the demand for services often results in
long waiting periods. Furthermore, the organizations and agencies providing
evaluative, adjustment and training services, i.e., sheltered workshops, com-
munity colleges, trade schools and universities usually have waiting lists and/or
periodic rather than continuous enrollment policies.
State VR agencies must extend even greater effort to identify and eliminate sour-
ces of delay, inefficiency, and neglect. Some suggestions follow.
A. Outreach and Referral Efforts
It would seem that the nature of the referrals to the state VR agencies and the
service population are largely determined by the nature of the state agency's
outreach efforts and referral development program. In essence, a sup-
ply/demand function may be in operation (as opposed to the more usual
demand/supply function); that is, if the state VR agency places a counselor in
a previously-unserved school or hospital, a caseload is soon generated. If a
deaf specialist is placed in a district office, assuming that the individual is
aggressive and resourceful, there will soon develop a caseload of unan-
ticipated dimension. This phenomenon has repeated itself over and over
whether the client be a disabled welfare recipient, a drug abuser, a public of-
fender, or severely physically handicapped.
The "targets of opportunity" in terms of serving the more severely han-
dicapped who seek greater independence include (but are not limited to) the
following:
1. Social Security Programs
2. Physical Medicine Units of General Hospitals
3. University Hospital Physical Medicine Departments
4. State Mental Hospitals
5. Convalescent and Nursing Homes
6. Work Activity Centers
7. Health Organizations, i.e., Epilepsy, Heart, Cancer, Cerebral Palsy, Men-
tal Retardation, etc.
8. Special Education Programs
9. State Schools for the Blind and Deaf
10. Special Purpose Medical Centers, i.e., Heart, Stroke, Neurology, Amputee
Clinics, Burn Centers
11. Advocacy Groups Such as Organizations for Disabled Veterans, the
Physically Handicapped, Deaf, and Mentally Retarded
12. Former Clients Who Were Unsuccessfully Served or Not Accepted for
Service Due to Severity of Handicap
13. Former Clients Who Were Closed From Service in Sheltered or
Homebound Employment.
In order to properly receive and serve the more severely handicapped, VR of-
fices and rehabilitation facilities must be completely accessible. While this
might appear unnecessary to state, the fact is that many such offices and
facilities present the same barriers which are so prevalent in the larger
society.
B. Eligibility Determination
The language of the new law, while clearly maintaining the employment ob-
jective, also invites greater risk taking on the part of the state agency. The
guidelines for the individual rehabilitation program direct that the counselor
is to make the decision that the client is not eligible only after the evaluation
of rehabilitation potential has demonstrated "beyond any reasonable doubt"
that the individual is not capable of employment.
C. Evaluation of Rehabilitation Potential
The 1973 Rehabilitation Act and the 1974 Amendments introduce the
following services. (1) Preliminary diagnostic studies to determine basic
eligibility in all cases to include an appraisal of the current general health
status of the individual. (2) A thorough diagnostic study which is provided as
needed for the purpose of determining the nature and scope of the services
needed by the individual. The thorough diagnostic study includes a com-
prehensive evaluation of pertinent medical, psychological, vocational,
educational, and other related factors which bear on the individual's han-
dicap to employment and rehabilitation needs. (3) Extended evaluation to
determine rehabilitation potential. Such evaluation is provided when there
exists a physical or mental disability which constitutes or results in a sub-
stantial handicap to employment but the counselor is unable to make im-
mediate determination that vocational rehabilitation services will benefit the
individual in terms of employability. Vocational rehabilitation services
necessary for the determination of rehabilitation potential, including those
provided within the thorough diagnostic study may be provided to a han-
dicapped individual for a period not to exceed 18 months.
While there is growing development of pre-vocational and work adjustment
services, there are insufficient resources in the face of the present and an-
ticipated demand for such services. Individuals with severe disability com-
plicated in many cases by problems of mobility and social isolation will
require extended and comprehensive evaluation services.
The provision of thorough diagnostic studies and extended evaluation ser-
vices can be expected to substantially increase the cost of services provided
and will likely require considerably more time to complete. The state
vocational rehabilitation agency will need to develop service arrangements,
purchase of service agreements and cooperative projects which serve to
utilize other funding mechanisms (Medicare, Workmen's Compensation,
Social Security, Title XX) while accelerating the service delivery process.
Hopefully, the experience gained through innovation and expansion grant
projects in serving the severely handicapped, including RIDAC
(Rehabilitation Initial Diagnostic and Assessment for Clients) projects, will
provide living examples of comprehensive and expeditious service
arrangements.
D. The Rehabilitation Counselor as a Vocational Expert for the Handicapped
The role of the vocational rehabilitation counselor has been the subject of
debate for decades with painful lack of consensus. The troubled identity of
the profession may in part be attributed to both this lack of consensus and
the multiple expectations held by important "actors" in the field. That is,
counselor educators, counselor trainees, and employers have varying ex-
pectations as they contemplate the role of the rehabilitation counselor. Fur-
ther, the nature of a rehabilitation counselor's work affiliation, i.e., state VR
agency, private psychiatric hospital, ghetto drug center, physical medicine
clinic, etc., materially affects the view the individual has of his/her "proper"
role.
It should be understood that the comments in this paper are addressed only
to the vocational rehabilitation counselor employed in the state VR agency.
In sum, the author argues that the unique contributions of the VR agency
counselor to the interdisciplinary social and health care system established
to serve the handicapped is that of vocational counseling expert. In the
galaxy of services/agencies which are available, in the array of physiatrists,
psychologists, nurses, social workers, occupational therapists, physical
therapists, and other specialities, it seems reasonable to assume that the VR
counselor's individual professional talent - and the most significant con-
tribution he or she makes to the team effort of rehabilitation - is their (1)
vocational counseling expertise and (2) their ability to coordinate a wide
range of community services which result in vocational success for their
clients.
To the degree that the VR counselor neglects this very challenging role while
emulating the role of one of the other team members, the counselor is
engaged in duplication of effort while perpetuating ignorance and inef-
fectiveness in terms of providing professional vocational assistance to the
handicapped. Too often, the VR counselor plays the role of "clinician,"
"psychotherapist," "social advocate," sometimes being sidetracked into
areas where they are unqualified while neglecting the very special and
thoroughly professional contribution that the vocational rehabilitation coun-
selor can make in collaboration with other professionals.
To some degree, this phenomenon may reflect the professional preparation
of the counselor in which great academic emphasis is placed upon
diagnostic procedures, the implications of pathology, and generic
therapeutic counseling with insufficient attention given to those com-
petencies required if one is to assist in sound career planning with, and on
behalf of, a physically handicapped person. The modern and effective VR
counselor needs to have knowledge of job analysis, job restructuring, labor
market information, the job economy, manpower programs, vocational
education, and techniques for job placement of the disabled.
Both spontaneous criticisms and formal survey research have made it clear
that what clients, family members, and referral agencies want and expect
from the state VR agency is expert vocational assistance in choosing,
preparing for, and finding a job which is rewarding and satisfying. Yet clients
and cooperating agencies have perenially expressed dissatisfaction with our
vocational services, specifically our job placement services. In the face of all
this, we still find debates among staff as to whether or not job placement is a
legitimate responsibility. We find the rationalization that "the truly
rehabilitated" will find their own jobs accompanied by persistent requests
that state agencies hire job placement specialists in the district offices who
would relieve counselors of this "odious task."
After years of this debate, one has to wonder if we are not suffering a not so
mild form of aversion neurosis. A simple approach-avoidance or negative
vicious cycle may be in operation. State-of-the-art deficiencies and academic
neglect result in inadequate counselor preparation in the vocational area in
general and job placement specifically. Possessing such deficiencies,
feeling in some cases uncomfortable with what may be felt to be a sub-
servient or subordinate role to employers (the beggar's role!), armed with all
the handy rationalizations as to why others, i.e., the clients, specialists, aides
and the Employment Service, should do placement, we should not be sur-
prised that we aren't very effective. Perhaps our counseling staff is not as ef-
fective at job placement as they could be because the universities and state
agencies haven't armed them with the skills necessary to do a successful
job. We have provided few successful techniques or models, and in many
cases, we have to overcome personality aversions to the task. Due to all
these factors, the counselor experiences much failure and frustration. Con-
stantly bombarded by such negative feedback, is it any wonder that coun-
selors look to other areas to find satisfaction while implicitly asking clients to
expose themselves to the frustration and disappointment of unsuccessful job
seeking?
In short, both the university counselor education programs and the state
agencies have a heavy responsiblity to provide the knowledge, skills and ad-
ministrative support systems which will allow counselors to be effective in
this critical aspect of their jobs. Not only will clients benefit directly but coun-
selors will become more confident and satisfied with themselves as they ex-
perience the sense of true achievement which can come in helping a
severely handicapped person attain success in work.
E. Job. Placement Services
Due to the multiple roles played by the VR counselor, the broad
Congressional mandate, the comprehensive nature of VR services, and the
dimensions of client need, it is sometimes difficult to retain the primacy of the
overriding program objective, i.e., placement of the handicapped into em-
ployment. Counselors, supervisors, and administrators in their concern with
the service delivery process, the day-to-day activities of staff, the press of
meetings, and paperwork, sometimes lose sight of the objective which gives
meaning to all these activities and efforts.
There can be no doubt that the placement of handicapped persons, par-
ticularly the severely handicapped in these near depression times, is
problematic. The client's residual limitations, frequent absence of substantial
work skills and work experience, the counselor's lack of skills and
techniques in job placement, employer fears and prejudices, architectural
and transportation barriers, and a host of other factors complicate successful
and permanent job placement. As a result, the disabled make up much of our
country's "underemployed," those who are most vulnerable to economic ad-
justments. Evidence exists which suggest that many disabled persons are
placed into jobs paying less than minimum wages, having few fringe
benefits, and subject to periodic layoffs. Administrators within VR agencies
must be sensitive to the number and proportion of clients who are "closed-
rehabilitated" into sheltered employment, homebound work and as
homemakers. Counselor professional standards, vigilant casework super-
vision, and administrative integrity should assure that such client outcomes
represent appropriate, quality services consistent with client needs and func-
tional capacities.
State VR agencies must seek assistance from, and cooperate with, univer-
sities, private consultants, insurance companies, employer associations,
labor unions, and others to better prepare their staff to fulfill their obligations
as a vocational expert for the disabled. Specific training in vocational ap-
titude testing, work adjustment counseling, vocational evaluation techniques,
labor market analysis, job engineering, manpower programs, etc., should be
provided.
Casework supervisors should receive advanced training so that they might
more effectively serve as vocational consultants to counselors. In reviewing
casework, casework consultants must assure that clients have indeed
received vocational counseling and guidance which is meaningful and
relevant to their needs.
If counselors are to provide more effective job placement assistance, the
state agency must reaffirm the importance of securing meaningful, well-
paying employment for clients and must provide the counselor with a
workable placement system. Some of the elements of a comprehensive
placement system include:
1. The employment of employer relations and/or job development
specialists in the state administrative offices.
2. A written plan from each district office specifying job placement ob-
jectives, relevant activities, inservice training needs, and consultation
required to achieve improvement in all placement efforts.
3. The development of a client skill bank, job order bank, and major em-
ployer accounts in every district office.
4. The development and implementation in the district offices of com-
prehensive monitoring and evaluation procedures.
5. The utilization of Job Seeking Skills Clinics.
6. Provision of statewide inservice training and technical consultation as
regards job placement.
7. Conducting local seminars throughout the state to inform employers of
the services available to employers from the state VR agency, the
rehabilitation provisions of Workmen's Compensation laws, affirmative
action provisions in the new Rehabilitation Act, etc.
8. Special efforts to promote the hiring of the handicapped within all levels
of government services.
9. Public education and advocacy in support and enforcement of Sections
503 and 504 of the VR Act of 1973.
10. The aggressive pursuit of legislation which fosters employment of the
handicapped.
II. Continuing Concerns and Policy Issues
A. Program Integrity
Provision of services to more severely handicapped persons will make great
demands upon all state vocational rehabilitation agencies. Counselors will
be challenged as never before as they will be expected to serve many clients
who formerly may have been considered ineligible for service due to the
severity of their disability. Earlier, we commented upon the absolute
necessity to enrich the counselor education programs and substantially
augment career development efforts. More important, however, than these ef-
forts to support counselors and assist them to acquire the skills they will
require for effective performance of their duties is the absolute necessity that
state and federal administrators and elected officials rethink the basic intent
and objective of the public vocational rehabilitation program.
While the issue of quality of services, case closure standards, and preoc-
cupation with single dimension, quantitative program measures have been
recorded in countless journal articles, conference presentations, and
program audit reviews, there is probably no more straightforward statement
of the issue than that found in the 1968 publication "Report of the National
Citizens Advisory Committee on Vocational Rehabilitation." Under a section
entitled "The Counselor Dilemma," the committee comments most critically
upon the prevalence of the so-called "numbers game." In the words of the
original report
We were distressed to learn that the vocational rehabilitation counselor
often finds himself in a condition of crisis today. Overwhelmed by large
caseloads, pressures for 'closures,' excessive administrative chores and
limited case service funds, the dedicated counselor is often forced to
'compromise his conscience,' his original concept of working closely
with handicapped clients frustrated by the harsh realities of the job.
Perhaps the most damaging force to the counselor's self-concept, and
increasingly to the image of the entire vocational rehabilitation program,
is the so-called 'numbers game.' The pressure, whether expressed or im-
plied, to demonstrate substantial increases in the number of people
rehabilitated is very real. The effect is to dispose the counselor to seek
out the 'easy' case, the person who can be made employable with a
minimum expenditure of agency time and money. As a result, the difficult
case - the severely disabled, multiply handicapped person who most
desperately needs help - is shunted aside as 'not feasible.' Quality of
service is thus sacrificed for expediency. In sum, the 'numbers game'
results in a perversion of both program objectives and counselor job.
satisfaction.
Testimony before Congress prior to the passage of the 1973 Rehabilitation
Act, the oversight hearings of 1973, and state and Congressional audits
during 1973-75 suggest that the situation is not materially altered from the
evidence which resulted in this 1968 statement. Perhaps the explanation lies
in the fact that state and federal administrators and legislators are faced with
a dilemma in which the "success" of the program has historically been
measured by the year-to-year "growth curve" of a single statistic, i.e., the
number rehabilitated.
From the Congressional hearing room to the counselor's office located
thousands of miles from Washington, D.C., the preoccupation has been
"more rehabs." Counselors, supervisors, and administrators have become
victims of the numbers game, the subtle trap which demeans and
demoralizes. As a consequence of this singular and narrow definition of
program "success," values, attitudes and behaviors were fostered which may
now be subject to criticism. In the reporting of program accomplishments, no
distinction was made between the severity of handicap and complicating
conditions found among clients served, extent of services rendered, or out-
come of service except whether the client was closed "rehabilitated" or not.
For example, questions are now being raised in program audits and
legislative reviews as to the appropriateness of clients admitted to the
program, the quality of services provided, and claims of rehabilitation at
closure. Reports of misbehavior, fraud, unjustified claims of success and lack
of substantial services provided demand that we give most serious attention
to the improvement of administrative practices, casework supervision, and
the quality of services rendered.
In this age of accountability, we must guard against the temptation to
become so quantitatively oriented and compelled to demonstrate our success
that we accept less than the very best we can provide in making a qualitative
difference in the lives of those we serve. Indeed, we must become more
specific about what it is we do
the impact of rehabilitation services. We
must work closely with program evaluators to devise better criteria so we can
reasonably report client accomplishments - but we must never lose sight of,
or forego, our professional obligations and standards. Perhaps this is the
greatest challenge we face in the next few years
to improve quality of ser-
vice, to be truly effective in what we do, and to report to the public in an un-
derstandable and valid manner in what ways the provision of rehabilitation
service made a difference in the lives of those served.
B. "Serve First Those With The Most Severe Handicap" -
Who Not To Serve?
An unsettling issue facing most state vocational rehabilitation agencies will
likely be how to satisfy the requirement in the Act that services not be denied
to anyone due to the nature of the disability while avoiding an excessive ex-
penditure of case service and time resources upon those with more mild or
moderate disabilities. More than one critic has observed that we must be
vigilant in recognizing that our service model has a certain insidious element
in which there is an advantage to providing services to those who may need
it least - the high potential, college qualified, mildly disabled.
As noted above, case service reviews and program audits have revealed in-
stances in which the services provided appeared incidental to the client's
needs and case results. There have also been instances in which great
imagination has been demonstrated in bringing into the system those whose
rehabilitation would be rather straightforward, predictable, and safe.
Research has also shown that often those most in need received the least in
service (avoidance of a "poor" investment) while those with considerable ad-
vantages received the most expensive and lengthy services (invest in the
winners).
Perhaps we need to be reminded of our first point of eligibility which states
that the disability "must constitute or result in a substantial handicap to em-
ployment." State VR agencies may need to adopt a policy of referring the
mildly disabled - those with a questionable vocational handicap - on to
general programs and community services. Such clients would be declared
not sufficiently disabled to qualify for state VR services but could and should
be referred on to other programs and services. The state VR agency would
perform a valuable information and referral service while avoiding substantial
time and case service commitments. We would not be expending valuable
resources intended for the unquestionably handicapped on those who have
only an incidental claim upon these resources.
C. How Are We To Be Evaluated?
While the "numbers game" has clearly been abused, we are not suggesting
that quantitative indicators are inherently malicious, unfair, or misrepresen-
tative. We have an important responsibility to be accountable to the han-
dicapped, the general public, and their elected representatives. Knowledge
of the number of referrals to the agency, the number accepted for service,
number of plans of service initiated, status at closure, percent of clients who
are severely handicapped, and the percent who are public assistance
recipients is essential to the control and management of the program and is
absolutely essential if one is to report the quantitative dimensions of program
accomplishment.
While such data assists in an assessment of the workload and deals in part
with questions of efficiency (time and costs), such data says little about
program effectiveness; that is, the quality of impact of the program. Measures
of effectiveness should reflect achievements or improvements in the func-
tional abilities of clients and problems resolved in such areas as mobility,
basic educational skills, work behavior, child care plans, transportation,
housing, etc. We need to specify problems or barriers upon intake and
document those reduced or removed through the provision of rehabilitation
services.
These achievements should also be recorded and reported for all persons
served - not only those closed rehabilitated. Hopefully, the counselor's con-
cern with the requirements of "paperwork" including case documentation
will be balanced by the recognition of the full range of benefits which clients
achieve in the course of their rehabilitation. Additional closure statuses
which reflect such accomplishments should eliminate the current "win/no
win" dichotomy in which all clients depart from the service system as either
"successes" or "failures."
Help may be on the way. The Rehabilitation Act calls for new program
evaluation standards which will make it possible to assess to some degree
the integrity of the state program on dimensions other than sheer numbers of
successful closures per year. For too long, we have relied upon an emotional
appeal and the ever-rising growth curve to justify our programs. Insufficient
attention was given to such elemental questions as "How many disabled
people are in each state? How many may be expected to benefit from
rehabilitation services? In what specific, demonstrable ways has the client
received benefits from his/her participation in the program? How lasting are
the benefits? What happens to those deemed non-feasible or unsuccessful?
In the absence of such basic information, administrators have often been for-
ced to explain and justify the program on the basis of limited evidence.
D. Comprehensive Rehabilitation Services for Independent Living: A New
Direction
A major social policy issue confronts Congress as they deliberate upon the
basic intent and direction of the federal-state rehabilitation program. Essen-
tially, the issue raises a question as to whether the program should restrict its
orientation and intent to the vocational realm, with employment as the sole
program objective, or be extended into comprehensive services leading to in-
creased independence and enriched quality of life for the handicapped. This
issue has been debated for at least 25 years. In 1954, RSA commissioner
Mary Switzer campaigned vigorously, but unsuccessfully, for "Activities of
Daily Living" services. On the other hand, as recently as 1973, former
President Nixon vetoed the original version of the Rehabilitation Act arguing
that the provision of Comprehensive Services (in terms of non-employment
related services) in the original, Congressionally-approved bill, constituted
"a distortion of the basic intent of the program." The compromised version of
the Act included a modest sum of money for a nation-wide study of such ser-
vices. As we contemplate new rehabilitation legislation during 1976 and 1977,
the results of the study will no doubt bring forth further debate on this essen-
tial and paramount issue. The final resolution of this question has the most
profound implications as eligibility criteria, range of services provided, ser-
vice delivery mechanisms, and basic program objectives will be directly af-
fected.
Essentially, the question is
what is to become of those who are not ac-
cepted for service or are unsuccessful in their vocational pursuit? This
question has plagued professionals in vocational rehabilitation, the disabled,
and other agencies since the inception of the public vocational rehabilitation
program in 1920. With recent growing concern, however, for the severely
handicapped, there is renewed interest that public and private rehabilitation
agencies accept extended responsibilities. In the Congressional hearings of
1972 and 1973, speaker after speaker expressed their concern for the welfare
of those persons - particularly the severely disabled - who could not be ac-
cepted for services by the state VR agency because their disability was SO
severe as to preclude employment.
While many if not more of the severely handicapped can in fact achieve com-
petitive, homebound, or sheltered employment, an appreciable number will
be unable to (or should not) accept employment. Many of these people are
confronted by mobility, social, and family needs. What is our society's
responsibility to these people? The issue is compounded by many factors.
Many VR administrators are understandably concerned that the public
program may be assigned a new and additional responsibility with little or no
increase in program resources. As a result, the vocationally-oriented service
program may be diluted while staff and case service funds are redirected to
comprehensive services. Some also worry that the present staff of state VR
agencies do not possess the skills and knowledge that will be required and
that inservice training time and resources which are needed to address other
pressing concerns, i.e., job placement, meeting the special needs of the
severely handicapped, etc., will, by necessity, now be directed to prepare
staff to better provide comprehensive, non-vocational services. Some have
argued that comprehensive services are traditionally and rightfully the
responsibility of the voluntary agency sector and that these agencies should
retain this responsibility although the state agency might serve to award
program and staffing grants for the establishment and provision of com-
prehensive services.
Given recent Congressional interest in the program, the beginning of
significant new directions in the 1973 Rehabilitation Act and Amendments,
and the forthcoming deliberations in anticipation of new rehabilitation
legislation, is it not an opportune time to consider substantial new direc-
tions? Perhaps this new law could stand as a Declaration of Independence
from some of the restrictive provisions which have limited the state agency's
full participation in serving persons with handicaps. Is it too radical to
propose that all handicapped persons have a right to rehabilitation services
regardless of age, disability, or feasibility for employment? That clients who
are too disabled for sheltered, homebound, or competitive employment, those
that should not work, and perhaps even those who do not want to work, are
not thereby denied access to rehabilitation services.
Such a bold step would remove the "feasibility" prognostication and relieve
the counselor of both the anguish felt upon denying service to a severely
handicapped person and the fear of the consequences of failure should the
client not achieve rehabilitation some time in the distant future. Counselors
would no longer be expected to project two, three, five years into the future
and predict the effectiveness of the services to be rendered, the client's
response to those services, labor market receptivity, etc. Following a simple
establishment of disability and a need for service, the counselor would
proceed to serve.
The present law stresses that ineligibility be established beyond a
reasonable doubt and encourages risk taking, but stops short of defining
rehabilitation services as a right. Adding new legitimate, specific, and
verifiable client objectives, independent living for example, to the present
employment objective would seem to be a logical extension and necessity as
a result of the expansion of services to the more severely handicapped. The
results of the present national study on comprehensive services to the
severely handicapped may provide a vision of the future.
One of government's first efforts to treat and rehabilitate the disabled OC-
curred in England in the 16th Century when that country, for reasons of
economic necessity, established hospitals for merchant seamen. Soon after
the American Revolution, Alexander Hamilton as Secretary of State
established the same service in our own country. Since 1920, the public
vocational rehabilitation program has been a curious mixture of humane con-
cern and felt economic necessity. One might argue that the state-federal VR
program has been primarily an economically-oriented program and to this
day, in the more sophisticated terms of "cost-benefit" analysis, the essential
justification for, and worth of, the program is viewed in light of its economic
return on investment. Perhaps during our Bicentennial Celebrations it would
be appropriate to ask ourselves whether our humanity as a nation has not
matured beyond the marketplace mentality which seems to say that a han-
dicapped person's entitlement to assistance from his/her government is in
direct proportion to their contribution to the Gross National Product. The an-
swer to such a question may ask much of us as a society; however, in the
words of social historian Alfred North Whitehead, "Vigorous societies harbor
a certain extravagance of objectives."
Donald E. Galvin
Director, Vocational
Rehabilitation Service
Box 1016
Lansing, Michigan 48904
PROGRESSIVE INCLUSION
An Approach to Mainstreaming
Ralph E. Baird
Background
The operation of programs for handicapped children in the public school setting is
a relatively new development in the history of education. Although today they are
common, in most cases, these programs have been and continue to be isolated from
programs for the majority of students, in philosophy if not always in physical
location, This has been both because the staff in the so-called regular programs
have felt inadequately prepared to deal with their special needs and because the
staff instructing the handicapped have been concerned that the children's needs
would not be properly met if the children were not instructed by staff with ap-
propriate training.
The school boards and community in general often did not feel comfortable in
having the "handicapped" near their children. Children, reflecting the attitudes of
the adults around them, also felt uncomfortable and often made fun of the han-
dicapped children in their neighborhood and at school, if they were at the same
location. This behavior often led to sheltering children from the community in
general; feelings of guilt on the parts of parents for having a handicapped child;
and the development of separate private schools or institutional placements for the
identified children. Many children with good academic skills often remained fairly
segregated as adults. Their job opportunities were often limited by the relatively
narrow scope of training available in the special schools and by preconceived ideas
about the limitations of the handicapped held by the general public.
Another serious deterent to the development of appropriate educational programs
for the handicapped has been the lack of research in earlier years into the best
ways to sequence learning for children with specific handicaps. The excuse often
given was that the small numbers involved did not warrant the expenditure of time
and money required. Another way to say the same thing is that the pay-off is greater
with the more capable child. These approaches are not sound, either from a fiscal or
from a human resources point of view.
It does cost more money to educate the handicapped person who will be totally
dependent on the public for his care. From a solely monetary point of view, it makes
sense to educate the handicapped for independent living.
A far more important reason to provide the best education possible to the han-
dicapped child is that of recognizing the worth of the individual and assisting
him/her in maximum development for inclusion in all aspects of life.
Tacoma Study Group
It is with the latter idea in mind that the Tacoma Schools sixteen years ago
established a study group to determine how a school district can best provide for
the education of children with handicaps. From the beginning of the study it was
regarded as imperative to affirm the right of all children to an appropriate education.
The préamble to the Washington State Constitution reads:
"It is the paramount duty of the State to make ample provisions for the
education of all children residing within its border without distinction or
preference on account of race, color, caste or sex."
Hence, it was regarded as a legal as well as a moral duty for the State of
Washington to be responsible for the education of all children. And the notion was
rejected that it is possible to educate and strengthen the handicapped child apart
from other children so that (s)he will be able to join general society at a later date.
Guidelines
The final report includes the following statements and guidelines for program
development:
Since the exceptional child shares more attributes with other children than he
retains uniquely, his education will have much in common with other education
As the exceptional child becomes the master of his exceptionality, his education
plan should draw increasingly more on the general resources of public education.
The education of exceptional children should be an integral part of the total
program of public education.
Programs for exceptional children should emphasize the similarities of exceptional
children to other children. The needs of these exceptional children should be
respected. It is important to understand the process of self-concept development in
this regard. The child must be helped to see himself as having more in common with
other children than he has unique attributes. The goal should involve continuous
education of the exceptional child toward living in a general unrestricted society.
Shared and unique services and facilities should be developed in harmony with this
principle.
A reciprocal learning relationship exists between exceptional children and other
children which can improve the quality of all education. Above all, each should
have the benefit of learning to understand and respect the other. Implied here is an
early beginning when children are relatively free from many learned negative
feelings regarding self and others. In this way one is helped to become more
human, living a more complete life because one understands, accepts and respects
more fully than before.
The exceptional child should have the opportunity of attending school as close to
home as possible. He should have the opportunity of being as close to other
children as possible, in his neighborhood, school and community.
Decentralized provisions for exceptional children should be made in the public
schools. As mentioned earlier, exceptional children need to live and learn with
others; separate facilities make this difficult.
How can integration best be achieved?
How can handicapped children best be educated together with other children? If
separate facilities in separate buildings are rejected, should handicapped children
be mainstreamed completely so that they are in so-called regular classrooms with
other children? The study staff decided that the total inclusion approach may be im-
practical for many handicapped children as well as many staff members.
Under One Roof, Progressive Inclusion
We found workable and flexible alternatives in which facilities and programs are
provided for handicapped children under the roof of the regular public schools. It
was felt that if programs and facilities were arranged in this manner, it would be
possible to include the handicapped child according to his/her own educational-
plan. It would be possible to include handicapped children in programs with non-
handicapped children on a progressive basis. Hence, we coined the term
"progressive inclusion." Each child is included in regular programs to the fullest
extent consistent with his or her physical or mental limitations, and an attempt is
made to increase the level of inclusion of each child as he or she grows older. All
children have some contact with the regular program.
Specific Program Aspects
Summary: Special services and facilities for blind, deaf, retarded, and physically
disabled students are offered. People from ages 3 to 21 are served. Parents are en-
couraged to become very much involved. Each school has a multi-disciplinary sup-
port team of professionals who work together (and often with the parents and the
child as well) to review each disabled child's progress and make decisions on in-
clusion. Individualized sequence learning is used so as to enable each child to
discover and use his or her abilities and interests as fully as possible. Efforts are
made to educate and involve the broader community.
At the elementary level, approximately 75% of the disabled children are based in a
therapy program, located at one of two regular elementary schools, with its own
rooms, teachers and support staff. This figure represents mainly the retarded and
the severely multiply handicapped. These students spend the majority of their time
in the therapy area, but also participate in regular programs on a routine basis. The
therapy areas are used to offer occupational, physical and speech therapy, as well
as other kinds of learning for the children who are based there. Academically
capable students, including most spinal cord injured students, are based in the
regular school program and use the therapy program according to their needs, e.g.,
for physical and speech therapy.
At the junior high level, at least 50% of disabled students are based in regular
programs; in high school the figure is higher. Special services and learning areas
are offered at the junior high and high school levels as well as at the elementary
school level. There are pre-vocational and independent living skills programs for
the retarded, including a kitchen and bathroom area for the latter program. For older
disabled students, there are also programs to teach mobility in the community and
career exploration with local employers. In addition, programs for non-disabled
students designed to enable them to better communicate with disabled students are
offered, for example a course in sign language at the high school level.
For blind students, most of whom participate in the regular programs, there are
teachers of the blind and mobility specialists. Braille typing and all-braille materials
are offered. Independent living skills are also taught, and there are special
programs in the arts designed to foster body awareness and elimination of "blin-
dism" (drama) and to expand one's sense of spatial relationships (sculpture).
For hearing impaired students, there is a "total communication program" in which
only as much manual communication as necessary is used. The school district
provides each hearing impaired student with a "binaural amplification" hearing aid
to maximize residual hearing. At one elementary school, a special teacher of the
hearing impaired and a regular teacher team teach a class.
Each school in the district has disabled children in attendance, many participating
fully in the regular programs. Whenever a new program is added, e.g., when new
state or federal funds become available for specific teaching uses, disabled
students are included.
Rather than having a set curriculum for all disabled students, or even for all
students with a particular disability, an individual learning plan is made for each
student by a team of professionals and paraprofessionals. (See below). Emphasis is
placed on task analysis and sequenced learning so that each student will be able to
learn, starting from where (s)he is and progressing at his or her own rate. The
general educational goals are the same for disabled students as for non-disabled
students. The development of a positive self-image is one such goal. While all good
educational programs have self-worth as one goal, the programs for handicapped
have it as a priority goal to be achieved early in the life of the student.
The desire of the Tacoma Schools is to start the educational program as early in the
child's life as is permissible by law and the resources available. This has generally
been at approximately three years of age for the more disabled, for their needs to
"catch up" require the greatest amount of time, and any delay makes only greater
problems. The children with lesser handicaps are generally included at age five. We
are currently working with parents and community agencies to begin working with
children under three to assure more appropriate early intervention. Our desire is to
increase this involvement in a planned intervention program. It is believed that the
awareness of the public of programs for the handicapped and their acceptance will
make it possible to identify children with problems earlier and bring support to the
extended programs that we hope to institute.
An essential component of our program is that of identification. We rely heavily on
the community for early identification. The medical community is a prime source of
referral. Early childhood programs with increasingly better trained staff members
are another major source of referral. Often a child and/or the family of a child served
in the program is the best source of referral. Children with lesser handicaps usually
are identified by the school staff.
This is done in a variety of ways. One way is general health screening. Another is
screening by the communication disorder specialist for speech and language dif-
ficulties. The most common way is by the well-trained classroom teacher through
planned observation of classroom and playground behavior. Suspected problems
can then be referred to appropriate specialists for futher evaluation. Some of those
commonly available in our district are nurses, occupational therapists, physical
therapists, mobility trainers and psychologists (with philosophy of child study rather
than simple test administration and interpretation).
Once identified the child has a program based on the specific information collected.
The emphasis is always on what portion of this program can be carried on within
the regular programming for children and what portion requires specialized help
from support staff and teachers trained in specialized areas. If specialized help is
needed the goal is always to provide that as near his home as is feasible so that
friendships developed at school can be extended in the time away from school.
Each school has a multi-disciplinary team, consisting of a psychologist, a social
worker, a counselor, the principal, a teacher, and a special education coordinator
who coordinates efforts to help each disabled student. Medical people, such as nur-
ses and an orthopedist, also become involved in the team when they are needed. A
conference is held twice per year for each disabled child, at which major decisions
about what programs (s)he should participate in are made. Parents are involved in
these conferences, as are older students. Since every student is involved to some
extent in regular programs, there is a realistic basis for making decisions about
his/her further inclusion in such programs.
Mutual respect for the skills of others is essential if a team effort on behalf of the
identified child is to be successful. While it is essential to be aware of the special
skills each discipline brings to the setting, there are areas of overlapping skills and
a plan should be developed for the most efficient use of staff in meeting the needs
of children.
Recruitment and Staff Development
Recruitment practices were changed so that every candidate for any position in our
school district was told about our approach to educating handicapped children. The
candidate was asked if this were something to which he could commit himself and
something with which (s)he could feel fairly comfortable. In other words, we worked
into our recruitment process a positive bias toward the school district position.
Hopefully, if that were successful then we would strengthen staff acceptance and
action regarding the acceptance of all children and the procedure
of progressive inclusion. In addition, we encouraged principals to work with their
staff members in explaining the concept and process. It did fall quite heavily on the
shoulders of those staff members dealing more intensely with handicapped children
to be missionaries of that action and to explain the concepts of inclusion and main-
streaming.
By cooperative agreement with various colleges and universities, as well as with
other school districts, a program of in-service classes has been given in recent
years to improve the skills of all staff members in serving children with learning
problems. This is the key to quality instruction always, but it is particularly essential
in a program of progressive inclusion. A variety of formats has been used to make
learning opportunities available in a useful form for staff members. For those
working on advance degrees, college credit programs have been developed in the
community so the class is available during the school year. Professional credit and
non-credit programs have also been developed using staff experts to teach. The in-
structional staff has come from all disciplines. Courses are developed primarily
because of identified staff interest but some are developed to introduce new ap-
proaches to old problems or to strengthen skills in identified staff deficit areas.
Leadership pressure must be exerted continuously, in the sense that all staff mem-
bers are expected to understand and to implement the adopted policy. Gentle but
sustained pressure by the administrative staff has been a significant enabler of
progressive inclusion.
Facilities
All new school buildings and additions to existing buildings within the school
district have been made accessible to the disabled. In addition, many of the older
buildings have been remodeled to be made accessible. No facilities addition or im-
provement is made without giving careful consideration to the problems of
progressive inclusion.
Community Awareness
A positive self-image does need support. While many of the support activities come
in the school setting, many of the activities for support are centered in shaping the
community attitudes toward the disabled. This community attitude must be a
positive one and in the Tacoma School District this has been developed by activities
such as program budget building for handicapped students with citizens' in-
volvement, recreational committees for the handicapped involving teachers,
citizens, pupils and administrators. Similar activities have been conducted in the
area of job identification, employment procedures, and work opportunity develop-
ment. The staff participates in many activities designed to enhance the development
of an independent living opportunity when the children complete their school
training.
Another planned procedure which creates a community awareness is making sure
that each community school has its share of the handicapped population. Of course
this means more administrative problems for the schools, less efficient use of tran-
sportation, perhaps less efficient use of supervisory personnel, but it is our firm
opinion that not only is this the humane thing to do, but that the positive attitudes
developed by both the disabled pupil and the community will lead to a more fulfilled
independent life style for the disabled.
In addition, literature and speaking engagements are used to create community
awareness as is direct work with local voluntary and service organizations. For fur-
ther information write to Tacoma Public Schools.
Conclusion
It should be obvious that the needs of the so-called handicapped are similar to the
needs of all people. Any plan for programs must keep this in mind. It is more a mat-
ter of how, when and where we fulfill these needs that distinguishes programs for
the disabled child from so-called regular programs. As indicated earlier, in our
district the stress is on early intervention; attendance at a school as near the child's
home as feasible; and as much participation in the regular classroom as ac-
ceptance and skills permit, but always with the support available to assure success
in school and in the community.
We know that all children do not have the potential for totally independent living but
each child should have the opportunity for as much independence as he can han-
dle. It is to this goal our programs must be directed. It is our feeling that a
philosophy of progressive inclusion best speaks to this issue.
People often ask if the payoff is worth the effort. As imperfect as our process is, the
answer has to be a loud and emphatic yes. When children with various handicaps
mingle freely with their peer group, when many are able to handle their setbacks
and some exceed our boldest expectations, we know that gains are being made.
Ralph E. Baird
Administrative Assistant,
Special Education
Tacoma Public Schools
Tacoma, Washington
INDEPENDENT LIVING FOR INDIVIDUALS
WITH "SEVERE DISABILITIES":
THE FEDERAL OUTLOOK
Frederick A. Fay, Ph.D.
The title needs three brief explanations. First, the words "individuals" is underlined.
While it is easy to lapse into the habit of labeling groups of citizens with the jargon
of the day, e.g. "the severely disabled," we are talking about individuals. These per-
sons, who happen to have functional limitations, are too frequently categorized and
stereotyped, particularly by federal program planners. Second, the words "the
severely disabled" are in quotes. Even when verbal shorthand seems to necessitate
such terms, the reference is unclear. One can say, for example, there are 34 million
handicapped in the U.S., 11 million of whom are "severely handicapped." But such
statements are based on many assumptions about who is or isn't included. Of the
eighty-five plus federal programs supposedly serving the target group(s) in
question, practically none use the same definition of "the disabled," much less "the
severely disabled." Third, the phrase "federal outlook" is equally ambiguous. Full
participation in society by all citizens will require positive action by all three bran-
ches of government. Persons with disabilities must first get good laws through
Congress, see that the laws are properly executed by the Administration, and, when
necessary, appeal legal issues all the way to the Supreme Court. Only through ef-
fective citizen participation in the legislative, executive, and judicial arenas, will
citizens with disabilities be able to secure their basic human, legal, and civil rights.
To adequately cover all federal legislation, programs, and legal rulings would
require volumes. This paper will briefly a.) summarize the scope of the federal
government's current role in serving severely handicapped individuals; b.) examine
possibilities for consumer involvement in the Vocational Rehabilitation program; c.)
make a brief statement on rehabilitation for independent living and finally; d.) make
an action recommendation for the White House Conference.
I. Legislative Branch
In a summary of "Legislation Affecting the Handicapped: 94th Congress" from
the National Paraplegia Foundation approximately 230 bills are listed. Subject
areas include:
Architectural Barriers (11 bills)
Blind (28 bills)
Deaf and Hard of Hearing (7 bills)
Developmental Disabilities (4 bills)
Disabilities (5 bills)
Education (8 bills)
Employment (14 bills)
Handicapped Veterans (42 bills)
Huntington's Disease (5 bills)
Income Tax (22 bills)
Mental Retardation (5 bills)
Miscellaneous (9 bills)
Recreation (2 bills)
Social Security (36 bills)
Transportation (20 bills)
White House Conference on the Handicapped (1 bill)
These range from Senate Concurrent Resolution 11, "to assure to all citizens, in-
cluding handicapped citizens, the right to live and work in a barrier-free en-
vironment," to Senate 662, "to amend the Urban Mass Transportation Act of 1964
to meet the needs of elderly and handicapped persons." Nearly every one of
these bills would facilitate "independent living" (broadly defined) by persons
with severe disabilities. Yet, if past Congressional performance is any indication,
very few of the mass of bills that are now under consideration will become law.
II. Executive Branch
Looking at federally administered programs it is difficult to decide what to in-
clude. In its Interim Report to Congress (1975) the Office for Handicapped In-
dividuals described the following programs:
Department of Health, Education, and Welfare
1. Public Health Service
National Institutes of Health
Alcohol, Drug Abuse, and Mental Health Administration
Health Services Administration
Bureau of Community Health Services
Indian Health Service
Bureau of Medical Services
2. U.S. Office of Education
Office of the Commissioner of Education
Bureau of Education for the Handicapped
Bureau of Occupational and Adult Education
3. Office of Human Development
Office of Child Development
Veterans Affairs Office
Volunteers Office
Architectural and Transportation Barriers Compliance Board
Administration on Aging
Office of Native American Programs
Rehabilitation Services Administration
Vocation Rehabilitation Program
Division of Developmental Disabilities
For this paper to be complete, each of these programs would have to be
examined to determine the extent to which it helped or hindered independent
living. And yet, from the number of persons now only surviving in various states
of dependency it is clear that the Administration has a long way to go.
III. Judicial Branch
Several summaries exist regarding efforts by disabled citizens to use the courts
to secure their full participation in society. John Homer in his 1974 article
"Rights of the Handicapped" and Jack Achtenberg in his paper "Crips Lib: An
Overview of Legal Issues" both document the increasing militancy and use of
litigation to resolve problems relating to housing, transportation, education
and the many other areas where civil and legal rights have been denied. And
yet, in the past, for lack of legal assistance, many issues have not reached the
courts.
Citizen Role
In reviewing the three branches of government a three part question arises. To what
extent are citizens with disabilities willing (1) to lobby for legislation to meet their
needs for independent living, (2) to hold public program administrators accountable
for effective execution of the laws, and (3) to use the courts when administrative ef-
forts fail to assure basic rights? In other words, will there be full participation of all
the governed in their government? This issue of "citizen participation" or "con-
sumer involvement" seems basic to any analysis of the federal scene.
In recent years there has been a growing realization that if our government is to be
truly "of, by, and for the people," then the people must make it happen. Ralph
Nader, Common Cause, and the American Coalition of Citizens with Disabilities
have become symbols of this growing movement. For handicapped individuals
ACCD represents probably the greatest hope for meaningful change at the federal
level. Only recently through ACCD have national organizations of the handicapped
like the Paralyzed Veterans of America, the American Council of the Blind, the
National Association of the Deaf, and the National Paraplegia Foundation begun to
work together on common issues.
Last fall the proposed Rehabilitation Act of 1974 Amendments were in danger.
ACCD member organizations literally wrote thousands of letters and made
thousands of phone calls to help get Congress to override the Ford veto. Among
other things the law established a consumer advisory council for the Architectural
and Transportation Barriers Compliance Board, and mandated a White House Con-
ference for Handicapped Individuals. Consumers have pushed for affirmative action
in staffing the offices created by the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 as amended. When
one looks around HEW's Office for Human Development in Washington the impact
is clear: Hank Viscardi and Jack Smith, heading up the White House Conference for
Handicapped Individuals, are both in wheelchairs. So are Andy Adams, Com-
missioner of Rehabilitation Services Administration, Jim Jeffers, Director of the Ar-
chitectural and Transportation Barriers Compliance Board, and Bill Bean, Acting
Director of the Office for Handicapped Individuals. Even here in California, Gover-
nor Brown responded to community involvement and had the wisdom to appoint Ed
Roberts as new head of the state's vocational rehabilitation agency.
Consumer Involvement in the Federal-State Vocational Rehabilitation Program
Taking vocational rehabilitation as an example of a federal-state program, who and
what are we talking about? Section 101(a) 18 of the Rehabilitation Act requires that
the State agency will take into account, in connection with matters of general policy
development arising in the administration of the State plan, the views of individuals
and groups who are:
(a) recipients of vocational rehabilitation services, or as appropriate, their parents,
guardians, or other representatives;
(b) providers of vocational rehabilitation services; and
(c) others active in the field of vocational rehabilitation.
What are some of the reasons for consumer involvement, as seen by the agency.
The following list is from Chapter 25 of the Rehabilitation Services Manual. That
Chapter, "Policy Development Consultation," cites these advantages in involving
"clients" and consumer organizations in policy formulation and administration:
increased awareness of client needs;
realistic insights as to how various aspects of the State vocational
rehabilitation program are functioning and how they might be improved;
establishment of better working relationships between the agency and
clients, providers and other individuals and organizations active in
rehabilitation in the State;
better information sharing and clearer understanding of the State agency's
mission, goals and objectives;
increased and more effective advocacy for the State agency's programs and
its program needs; and
establishment of a mechanism to permit, continuous external feedback from
all segments of the population on current and proposed operations and
plans.
To the consumer, increased involvement by his elected representative in the plan-
ning, delivery, and evaluation of rehabilitation services should, if properly im-
plemented, result in increased relevance of rehabilitation to the real needs of per-
sons with disabilities. But what does it mean for consumer involvement to be
properly implemented? Again the RSA Manual offers some possibilities:
Among the areas of program development and administration in which
clients, their representative organizations, providers and other individuals and
groups active in vocational rehabilitation should be assigned significant
roles and in which they should work closely with the State Director and his
representatives in presenting their views and recommendations are:
1. Program evaluations to identify strengths in services that would warrant
further emphasis, gaps in services, and general and specific ef-
fectiveness and efficiency of operations including the formulation of
methods and techniques for improving the delivery of vocational
rehabilitation services.
2. Program planning and program development - the planning of future
programs and the expansion of current programs to close gaps in service
or to improve the effectiveness of the program or programs.
3. Assistance in developing legislative proposals and budgets for submittal
to the State Legislature, both in their preparation and follow through in
hearings before the State legislative committees.
4. Assessment of the physical accessibility to the handicapped of all offices
and facilities operated, supported or used by the State agency and, as
required, formulating plans for making them accessible or more ac-
cessible.
5. Assistance in studies and surveys being conducted by the State agency
or its district and local offices, i.e., data gathering, client sampling, and
follow-up.
6. The interpretation of State agency policies and program services to their
constituencies and to the public at large.
7. Assistance in the State agency's in-service training and staff develop-
ment programs to aid staff in achieving greater understanding of client
problems and attitudes, providers' problems and in maintaining better
working relationships with organizations representing clients, providers
and other people engaged in vocational rehabilitation.
8. Assistance to the State agency in whatever role it may have in State and
local activities leading up to the White House Conference on Han-
dicapped Individuals, and assistance to the State agency in the im-
plementation of recommendations, having State relevance, resulting from
such activities and conferences.
9. Assistance to the State agency in tapping and securing full utilization of
the resources of other public agencies and of private agencies in
meeting the needs of the handicapped, particularly the severely disabled
whose economic, adjustment, medical, housing and other needs may be
the responsibility of these other agencies.
10. Assistance to the State agency in implementing the 1974 Amendments to
the Rehabilitation Act, requiring that the State agency and facilities in
receipt of assistance under Title I of the Rehabilitation Act "shall take af-
firmative action to employ and advance in employment qualified han-
dicapped individuals covered under, and on the same terms and con-
ditions as set forth in Section 503."
11. Assistance in the establishment of specialized facilities and programs to
be operated by consumer and other groups through funding by the State
agency, to meet the special needs of the severely disabled applicant or
client such as peer counseling, centers for independent living, halfway
houses and other transitional living arrangements, transportation and
post-employment services.
12. Proposing research to deal with unresolved problems in vocational
rehabilitation, and to help assess research proposals in terms of their ap-
plicability to the needs and priorities of a particular group of han-
dicapped people or to handicapped people in general.
But legislation, regulations and guidelines are worthless unless the "target
populations" keep the "implementers" honest. The RSA Manual declares that, with
respect to consumer involvement "each state agency will need to: assess im-
mediately the adequacy of its present practices in this area of activity; structure a
program which in scope, degree and continuity of client, provider and other person
participation meets the requirements of the Act and Regulations; describe this
program, process or processes in writing; and make this written description
available to the public."
The public, including organizations of the handicapped, must hold federal-state
vocational rehabilitation accountable for the effective implementation of Section
101(a) 18 of the Rehabilitation Act of 1973, which led to the regulations in Chapter
25, as quoted previously. And if the executive branch proves inadequate, there are
always the courts.
Consumer Involvement in Other Federal Programs
While VR was used to illustrate possible roles for consumers in relation to federal-
state programs, the principle of maximum meaningful participation applies equally
to other federal programs. Whether the issue is civil rights legislation, tran-
sportation regulations (e.g. FFA, UMTA, or ICC) or special education litigation,
Washington responds, to one degree or another, to political pressure. Individual
citizens with disabilities, by joining local, state, or national organizations that in
turn join the Coalition umbrella of ACCD, can have a voice in the decisions that af-
fect their lives. The biggest challenge facing such organizations as they com-
municate and cooperate on the common problems is that of setting realistic
priorities.
Many issues call for attention: architectural and communication barriers; national
health insurance; and many others. One problem that is common to all persons with
disabilities is discrimination. The impact of attitudinal barriers, be they in housing,
transportation, education, recreation or employment, would all be minimized by
strong, well-enforced civil rights legislation.
Rehabilitation for Independent Living
The following is quoted from an earlier briefing paper on the "Comprehensive
Needs Study of Individuals with Most Severe Handicaps":
Background
As early as 1958, following the landmark Vocational Rehabilitation Amendments of
1954, legislation had been proposed to extend the benefits of rehabilitation to per-
sons with the most severe handicaps, even when no vocational objective was ob-
vious. It was argued that the Vocational Rehabilitation approach (an individual plan
tailored to the needs of the specific individual, with case service funds for the pur-
chase of needed services from qualified vendors when not directly provided) had
much to offer for the most severely, non-vocational oriented, handicapped. Efforts to
authorize the State-Federal program to offer such services (Independent Living
Rehabilitation, if you will) resulted in bills passed by the 92nd and 93rd Congress.
Both these bills were vetoed and override efforts failed.
These proposed pieces of legislation had two major thrusts. The first was
authorization of a new formula grant program to provide services to individuals with
the most severe handicaps (IMSH) without vocational objectives. The second was to
move the vocational rehabilitation program in the direction of serving more severely
disabled persons with vocational potential. Hearings conducted during the
legislative process produced testimony to the effect that it was not certain just what
was known about provision of services to these IMSH and that there was possible
duplication of existing authorities which could provide the needed services. Thus, a
compromise was reached by the Congress and the Administration as reflected in
the provisions of Section 130 of the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 (P.L. 93-112). This
compromise directed the Secretary of HEW to conduct a Comprehensive Needs
Study of the most severely handicapped, reading as follows:
"Sec. 130 (a) The Secretary shall conduct a comprehensive study, including
research and demonstration projects of the feasibility of methods designed (1) to
prepare individuals with the most severe handicaps for entry into programs under
this Act who would not otherwise be eligible to enter such programs due to the
severity of their handicap, and (2) to assist individuals with the most severe han-
dicaps who, due to the severity of their handicaps or other factors such as their age,
cannot reasonably be expected to be rehabilitated for employment but for whom a
program of rehabilitation could improve their ability to live independently or func-
tion normally within their family and community. Such study shall encompass the
extent to which other programs administered by the Secretary do or might con-
tribute to the objectives set forth in clauses (1) and (2) of the preceding sentence
and the methods by which all such programs can be coordinated at Federal, State,
and local levels with those carried out under this Act to the end that individuals with
the most severe handicaps are assured of receiving the kinds of assistance
necessary for them to achieve such objectives.
(b) The Secretary shall report the findings of the study, research, and
demonstrations directed by subsection (a) of this section to the Congress and to the
President together with such recommendations for legislative or other action as he
may find desirable, not later than February 1, 1975."
The Rehabilitation Amendments of 1974 changed the report due date to June 30,
1975.
The authorization to carry out this Comprehensive Needs Study, (CNS), including
demonstration projects, provides the opportunity for documentation of the needs of
the severely disabled and of the place and role of rehabilitation in meeting those
needs.
Among the issues to be addressed is the mixed feelings in vocational rehabilitation
circles about moving in the direction of serving more of the severely handicapped
both from a vocational orientation and of entering a new phase for the State-Federal
program such as was anticipated on the proposed independent living rehabilitation
provisions.
There are those who argue that the vocational rehabilitation job is not being done
adequately due to a lack of sufficient resources and any new funds should be direc-
ted to these needs. Others argue that VR is not the place to put independent living
at all - that is, that ILR is more the province of health or social services and they
should be responsible for the IMSH population. Yet a majority of the State VR direc-
tors, (60%), responded to a National Rehabilitation Association survey in Aug. 1974
that independent living is appropriate for VR. This report is available from the NRA.
We should be aware of the strong position of congressional committees on the
issue. The Senate report to the 1973 Amendments stated:
"The Committee points out that its intent is to enable as many individuals to make
use of the basic vocational rehabilitation program as possible. Thus, in recognition
of the fact that individual conditions are not static and that training can be
progressive, the study should attempt to develop procedures, in addition to the in-
dividualized written rehabilitation program requirement in the bill, to ensure that a
vocational goal is not discarded for an individual with a severe handicap unless it
becomes absolutely clear that such a goal will never be possible."
"The Committee also continued to believe that many individuals now judged unable
to achieve a vocational goal can lead full and productive lives, given the full
promise of technology and knowledge currently available in this Nation. Fur-
thermore, the Committee reiterates that the goal of independent living is a
legitimate one for Federal recognition and support, and one which will benefit not
only the individual but his family, and society. It, therefore, urges the Secretary to
explore all possible methods of providing community-based services, and stresses
that such methods should include services to individuals who are currently
homebound. The Committee urges the Secretary to act rapidly to set up and pursue
this vital study."
The report issued by the House in conjunction with H.R. 8070 also stresses the
nature of the compromise:
"In S. 7, the vetoed bill, the Committee established a comprehensive rehabilitation
program for severely handicapped individuals who do not have readily identifiable
vocational goals. The Committee established this program originally because of the
recognition that there were many handicapped individuals throughout the nation
who were not being served by the basic program because of the severity of their
disabilities, and thus felt that to establish a special program for such individuals
would help make them self-sufficient, independent and ultimately capable of
receiving services under Title I (the basic program) of the Act. Title II was
vigorously opposed by the Administration, which contended that such a title would
detract from the original intentions of the Act. While the Committee disagreed with
the Administration's position, in the spirit of accommodation it deleted the title and
substituted for it a mandate that the Secretary conduct a special comprehensive
study, including research and demonstration projects, to determine the feasibility of
working with individuals who are so severely handicapped that they may not im-
mediately be able to go to work."
(Authors note: The substance of this section was to have been based on the Com-
prehensive Needs Study. Since that study has not been released by HEW, this sec-
tion has not been included.) One point is clear, however: in developing a program
for independent living, properly funded, consumer run, self-help organizations can
fill the present gaps in the disability service delivery system. For example, the Cen-
ter for Independent Living in Berkeley, California is staffed almost entirely by people
with severe disabilities. They set up and provide services themselves, since for
many of the severely handicapped the services required are not in the domain of
any given public agency - for example, instruction in home remodeling, assurance
of equipment repair, or an inventory of experienced attendants.
White House Conference for Handicapped Individuals
The Rehabilitation Act Amendments of 1974 (Section 302) authorize the President to
call a White House Conference On Handicapped Individuals to stimulate a national
assessment of problems, and to develop recommendation for the solutions to such
problems, facing individuals with handicaps. In authorizing this Conference the
Congress found that:
(1) the United States has achieved great and satisfying success in
making possible a better quality of life for a large and increasing percentage
of our population;
(2) the benefits and fundamental rights of this society are often denied
those individuals with mental and physical handicaps;
(3) there are seven million children and at least twenty-eight million
adults with mental or physical handicaps;
(4) it is of critical importance to this Nation that equality of opportunity,
equal. access to all aspects of society and equal rights guaranteed by the
Constitution of the United States be provided to all individuals with han-
dicaps;
(5) the primary responsibility for meeting the challenge and problems of
individuals with handicaps has often fallen on the individual or his family;
(6) it is essential that recommendations be made to assure that all in-
dividuals with handicaps are able to live their lives independently and with
dignity, and that the complete integration of all individuals with handicaps
into normal community living, working, and service patterns be held as the
final objective; and
(7) all levels of Government must necessarily share responsibility for
developing opportunities for individuals with handicaps; and it is therefore
the policy of the Congress that the Federal Government work jointly with the
States and their citizens to develop recommendations and plans for action in
solving the multifold problems facing individuals with handicaps.
The success or failure of the White House Conference itself will depend on the suc-
cess or failure of the fifty State Conferences that precede. And the success of both
depend in great part on the extent to which citizens with disabilities get involved.
The most immediate action for individuals and organizations to take is to write their
Governor, Senator and Representative and get involved in their State's Conference.
Summary
In the wake of Watergate, it has been said cynically that we have the best govern-
ment that money can buy. As far as independent living for individuals with "severe
disabilities," the federal government outlook will be as bright or as bleak as you and
I make it. Ultimately, the existence or extent of any federal program for independent
living will depend on the extent to which we convince the Congress, the Ad-
ministration, and the Courts to make the appropriate decisions and provide the
necessary resources.
Frederick A. Fay, Ph.D.
Director of Research
Tufts New England R&T Center
171 Harrison Ave.
Boston, Mass. 02111
LEGISLATION, RESEARCH AND PROGRAMS CONCERNING
HOUSING FOR HANDICAPPED PEOPLE IN BELGIUM,
CANADA, THE FEDERAL REPUBLIC OF GERMANY, FINLAND,
FRANCE, HONG KONG, THE NETHERLANDS,
NORWAY AND SWEDEN.
Barbara Duncan
Introduction
Rehabilitation International considers the problems of housing for handicapped people one
of its major concerns. In 1974, largely due to RI impetus, the United Nations held its first
Experts Meeting on the implications of architectural design for disabled people. "Barrier
Free Design," the official UN Report of that meeting, published by RI this year, strongly
supports the investigation of varied and dignified solutions to accommodations for disabled
people.
Much information in this paper is abstracted from that Report, which we have distributed
worldwide to architects, laymen and people involved in rehabilitation. (The Report is
available for $5.00 from Rehabilitation International, 122 East 23rd Street, New York, New
York, 10010, USA.)
In 1976 Rehabilitation International plans to hold a European Seminar on the various
experiments with supported living conditions. The seminar will be a forum for the exchange
of experiences of many countries and will attempt to determine if any solutions can be
universally recommended. From advance information, some of which is contained in the
following paper, it can be assumed that research and experience will demonstrate that no
one answer will suffice; that several alternatives should be available; that the disabled person
must have options suited to his individual requirements and wishes. As can be seen from
some of the following examples, the experiments meeting with the most success are based
on these assumptions.
It should be kept in mind that all of the following examples of experiments with supported
living arrangements take place within the established culture and social service structure of a
particular country. It should not, therefore, be assumed that the solutions evolved by one
country would be transferable to another.
There is a risk to life or to limb in the participation of the handicapped in open
society. While risks should not be foolishly ventured or needlessly imposed, the right to
risk is basic to the right to participate in the hope of achievement of a rich and
fulfilling life.
Each society should so construct its facilities as to avoid needless risks to the whole
population, the handicapped included, but not to segregate the handicapped under the
1
State of the Art / Duncan / 2
misguided impression that this is needed for them at the expense of their
independence.
Handicapped people may elect to be closely associated one with another in special
programs or in housing or other ways to achieve the benefits of special services. There
is an inevitable compromise with the results of segregation that may derive from such
activities and the impact of such segregation on maintaining social isolation and
prejudice. The compromise should be examined carefully in each case.
UNITED NATIONS EXPERTS
MEETING ON
BARRIER FREE DESIGN
CONCLUSIONS OF THE FIRST UNITED NATIONS EXPERTS MEETING ON
BARRIER FREE DESIGN, held June 4-8, 1974.
Housing
"The integration of handicapped persons within the population should be an identified goal
in private as well as public housing. In order to promote integration it is highly desirable
that disabled as well as non-disabled persons can pay visits to each other and have free
choice of their own living unit.
"In order to permit people to pay each other a visit, new living units are recommended to be
accessible. A living unit is considered to be accessible when a visitor in a wheelchair can
enter at least into the living room.
"In order to promote free choice, new living units are recommended to be adaptable. It is
noted that building codes in communities throughout the world, which provide a
mechanism for encouraging the implementation for adaptable housing within the private
sector.
"A living unit is considered to be adaptable, when it is accessible and can be modified with
comparatively little cost in a way consistent with permanent living requirements of
wheelchair users. If their requirements are met, the unit is fully livable to most of the other
categories of disabled and aged persons as well.
"The group recognized the importance of the problem of housing requirements of severely
disabled persons and suggested that attention should be given to the availability of fully
adapted living units for wheelchair users, for individual as well as congregate living. For
instance, units on ground floors and/or without barriers elsewhere in apartment buildings,
construction of which has been subsidized by public funds, may be reserved for them.
"In order to ensure privacy and to diminish environmental stress in congregate housing, it
was suggested that:
1. the living units should each have an independent entrance.
2. the complex should be situated in a residential area
3. the supporting facilities be made available also to other persons in the neighborhood."
State of the Art / Duncan / 3
BELGIUM
In Belgium, the National Housing Institute (Institut National du Logement), which is under
the jurisdiction of the Ministry for Family and Housing Affairs, has conducted a study on
the problems of housing for disabled persons. Federal grants are provided for the
construction and adaptation (of furniture and fixtures) of private housing for disabled
people.
The Parliament of Belgium passed on July 17, 1975 a law requiring that all future buildings
and major alterations to existing structures include the design needs of the handicapped.
The law further states that public buildings accessible to disabled people must display the
International Symbol of Access. Negotiations as to what norms and criteria will be applied
and further details of the legislation are taking place between the government and
organizations dealing with disability.
CANADA
There has been extensive research in the field of housing for the handicapped in Canada in
recent years, particularly by the Central Mortgage and Housing Corporation. As in many
countries, there is a marked trend to investigate other than institutional accommodations.
Under Section 15 of the National Housing Act, financial assistance, loans and mortgage
loans can be obtained for the establishment of residential group homes. The loans are
extended to non-profit corporations or approved voluntary bodies and current projects
include homes for children, mentally retarded people, the elderly and persons with cerebral
palsy. Depending upon age and needs, a handicapped individual may select either a
short-term home to serve as a halfway house between a hospital or rehabilitation center and
a permanent home, or a long-term group home. At times, a short-time situation provides
accommodations for individuals while architectural adaptations are being made to their own
residences.
The Central Mortgage and Housing Corporation stated in 1974 that their work is based on
the following premises: (1) Ambulatory persons with moderate disabilities should be
afforded a wide range of choice in the type and quality of residential accommodation, (2)
The moderately-disabled, including those confined to a wheelchair, should be free to choose
where they live in the community
and their housing should allow a maximum degree of
independence from personal assistance in performing everyday activities and (3) At least
some of the severely handicapped now confined to institutions should have the opportunity
to live in a non-institutional sheltered residential environment in their home communities.
The Corporation further points out that the personal and emotional vulnerability of a
disabled person requires that any public intervention or assistance must be carefully thought
out. Respect for the individual should be a primary concern and this means that no
stereotyped solutions should be considered. Research of the Corporation has led to the
conclusion that all housing for handicapped persons should be well located with respect to a
full range of community services and it has recommended that future Canadian projects
emulate the Fokus experiment. (See SWEDEN)
State of the Art / Duncan / 4
Supplement No. 5 of the National Building Code, entitled "Building Standards for the
Handicapped," is being revised and reconsidered by the Government in cooperation with
major voluntary organizations involved in rehabilitation. The Canadian Rehabilitation
Council for the Handicapped was appointed in 1974 to coordinate this work and other.
actions to eliminate architectural barriers. Supplement No. 5 is made law when adopted by
municipal governments and the Canadian Council is assisting community groups towards
this end. (The CRCD is an affiliate of Rehabilitation International and, as such, acts as a
liaison between the national and worldwide activities in this field.)
FEDERAL REPUBLIC OF GERMANY
In the Federal Republic of Germany, within the framework of social assistance, disabled
persons may be granted financial aid to improve their accommodations. An interministerial
working group has been set up for the preparation of guidelines and recommendations for
the gradual abolition of technical and structural obstacles in public and other buildings that
make access for disabled persons unnecessarily difficult.
The Deutsche Normenausschuss in Berlin has issued standards for the construction of public
buildings, public places and streets, as well as for apartments for the blind, severely
visually-impaired and wheelchair users. As of January 1975, the standards for apartments
had been officially passed and are being widely used as recommendations and applications
concerning federal funding of buildings.
The University of Marburg has established housing units for severely disabled students. The
units are integrated among those for able-bodied students and similar units are planned by
several other universities.
On December 17, 1974 the Federal Minister for Labor and Social Affairs officially opened
the construction of a model project in Bonn for housing disabled persons. The complex will
be equipped with a social, cultural and sporting center for the entire community as an
incentive and means for complete integration. This project is the first of several planned
centers for cities throughout the Federal Republic.
FINLAND
In Finland, the latest amendment of the Care of Disabled Persons Act includes provisions
for housing arrangements and for guidance of the family members of the disabled.
Building Statute 85a states that in construction of buildings containing premises to be used
by the public, attention should be paid to the fact that these should also be accessible to
persons whose physical or orientational ability is limited as a result of advanced age,
physical injury or sickness.
The Board of Social Welfare in conjunction with the Association of the Disabled is
conducting a research study on the needs of the severely disabled in the province of Kymi.
The study covers disabled people between the ages of 16-60 who have considerable
difficulties in activities of daily living, not including persons who are deaf, blind or mentally
retarded. The goal is to investigate the severely handicapped persons' needs for
rehabilitation, residential and transportation services. The method being employed is by
State of the Art / Duncan / 5
interview of the disabled person and his family. Material is treated statistically to assess
regional and local needs, in order to estimate the total need for services nationwide.
FRANCE
In France, the Ministry of Equipment and Housing envisages the reservation of a certain
percentage of adapted dwellings for the disabled on a priority basis within a special plan,
known as "le secteur HLM." Legislation in 1974 requires public buildings to be constructed
accessible to disabled people.
Studies have been undertaken to determine the comparative costs of building in accessibility
at the planning stage versus adaptations made following completion of construction. The
conclusions of an interministerial working group on Housing of the Physically Handicapped,
published in May 1973, state that (1) adaptation for the use by the physically disabled of
building approaches, building accesses and entrances involves no extra cost when these
adaptations have been considered at the planning stage, (2) the addition of a lift to a lodging
involves extra costs of up to 17.6% and (3) applying the minimum requirements of
accessibility to the internal arrangement of the lodging involves a variable extra cost,
depending upon the increase of the surfaces and the type of lodging.
Interest in experimenting with various solutions to the problems of housing handicapped
people is evidenced in the following extracts from a paper by the French National Liaison
Committee for Rehabilitation of the Handicapped:
"Rehabilitation of the disabled aims chiefly at a reinsertion into the community-a 'normal'
environment. What is to be set up? Adapted dwellings
almshouses
homes and
specialized hostels?
"There cannot be any definite reply since there is no standard solution: every disabled
person is an individual case. The disability is not the sole governing factor-environment,
position of the family, as well as psychological and intellectual factors must be taken into
account. A range of solutions should therefore be developed.
"Like any other citizen, the disabled person should be able to move to another dwelling
according to his family or vocational arrangements."
HONG KONG
An Ad Hoc Committee on Housing for Disabled People has been set up by the Joint Council
for the Physically and Mentally Disabled of Hong Kong, Rehabilitation International
affiliate organization. The Committee is in the process of collecting sample "case histories"
of disabled persons in need of re-housing or adaptation assistance for the development of a
position paper for submission to the Government. The Committee was established following
many complaints about the low priority disabled people were being accorded by the
Housing Authority.
The Joint Council has also taken action to ensure that current plans of the Hong Kong
Government to construct an underground railway system include the needs of the disabled.
Due to this, these needs are included in the transport survey of all factors to be considered
in the planning process and the Council is following up this action in conjunction with other
voluntary organizations.
State of the Art / Duncan / 6
NETHERLANDS
In the Netherlands, under the General (Exceptional) Medical Expenses Act and the Workers'
Disability Insurance Act, grants can be given towards the adaptation of accommodation.
Het Dorp, which means "the village," is reported to be the first village in the world designed
specially to provide for special housing and other needs of severely-handicapped individuals.
Located in the town of Arnhem near the German border, it was opened during 1966
following the acquisition of funds resulting from a television telethon. The village, operated
with the financial assistance of federal and local governments, currently houses some 400
disabled people from throughout the Netherlands. The founder of Het Dorp, Mr. A.
Klapwijk, further describes the operation of the village:
Each home has been built to meet the specific requirements of its inhabitants.
Some front doors, for instance, can be opened and closed by the radio impulse
wheelchairs. provided by a small transmitter which the inhabitants carry in their electric
For each row of ten houses, there is a covered street, so that mobility is guaranteed,
even in bad weather. Nine homes in each block are inhabited by the handicapped. The
tenth is for a non-uniformed trained helper. There is a community center for each
block as well, where inhabitants can gather
some of the villagers are married;
sometimes one, sometimes both members are handicapped. Couples live in double
homes, converted from larger single houses.
On each street in Het Dorp there are three blocks of ten homes. Since our land slopes
downward towards the Rhine Valley, we built a single level at the highest point, two
levels of homes further down and three levels at the bottom. Spacious lifts link all
levels. Homes on the lowest level have gardens, upper level homes have balconies. Both
indoor and outdoor streets and plazas have ordinary street names.
to the doors as everywhere in Arnhem.
mail is brought
Some inhabitants are employed outside the village, in Arnhem and reach their work by
special transport. Most villagers, however, work in Het Dorp's sheltered workshops
where their employment may be either clerical or hand labor. Het Dorp produces, for
instance, toys, clothing and ceramics and it prints and binds braille books and tapes
"talking books" for blind people. Inhabitants have priority for employment in Het
Dorp's own shops.
For cultural, social, recreational and religious activities, all of the community facilities
of Arnhem are available.
As Het Dorp began to be settled, we held elections for a "parliament" of Het Dorp
which meets every six weeks to consult on current problems. (And I can tell you that
our election contests took on an American color and liveliness which was certainly not
in keeping with
other Dutch communities.) Every 30 inhabitants, or three groups
of 10 homes, form a district and elect one representative to the Village Council. Two
Council members are chosen by the Council to hold full membership on the Executive
Board of the Het Dorp Foundation.
State of the Art / Duncan / 7
The Foundation follows the following principles in selecting villagers for Het Dorp: (1)
Het Dorp is open to the handicapped of all creeds, (2) HD is, in principle, intended for
the handicapped of all ages. In reality, however, handicapped youths are usually still in
stages of rehabilitation until their 18th or 20th year, and the handicapped older than
60 or 65 can preferably be placed in homes for the aged, (3) HD prefers to accept only
the handicapped who have achieved maximum rehabilitation before arrival
(4) HD
is not open to the mentally handicapped, since its community can in no way help
them. With respect to this criteria, first consideration is not the intelligence quotient of
the candidate, but rather his degree of social competence; whether he can provide a
positive contribution to the community and profit himself from the association, (5)
HD is not intended for those who are handicapped in the sensory organs only.
However, the limited sight or hearing of the candidate is not, in general, a deciding
factor so long as the other criteria for selection are fulfilled, (6) The seriousness of the
handicap is not a deciding factor for admission
since both general and individual
facilities are adapted and specifically designed
to achieve the most complete life
possible
The Selection Committee consists of experts from Het Dorp itself (a rehabilitation
doctor, public health expert, a social worker, a psychologist) but more largely of
authorities who are acquainted with the special problems of the candidates.
Het Dorp is adjacent-just across a secondary road-to the Johanna Stichting
Foundation rehabilitation center. Villagers receive there the necessary medical and
nearly all paramedical treatment, which is primarily physical therapy; x-ray, laboratory
and dental departments of the center are also open to villagers.
I am certain that all of you have noticed my enthusiasm for Het Dorp
I hope I have
not given you the impression that we have created a kind of heaven on earth. We have
not, thank goodness. It is a typically earthly community, with typically human
shortcomings. Nor is Het Dorp meant to be a panacea, the only solution for the
physically handicapped
it is intended to be a complement to the list of present
patterns. possibilities-a complement which will make it possible to abandon obsolete living
Currently 70 percent of housing in Holland is government assisted as opposed to 20 percent
in the United States, for example. The Ministry of Housing has reported that currently 2-1/2
percent of housing construction is adapted to the needs of disabled people.
The national standard for accessibility is now only a recommendation but, according to the
Ministry of Housing, plans are underway to make it mandatory.
Adapted housing already in existence (some 1000 units in Southern Holland) includes the
following alterations: In a group of townhouses, the separation wall between the two units
at one end is removed, creating on the groundfloor a two or three bedroom one-level house,
accessible to people in wheelchairs. The upper floors are then converted into two smaller
homes, generally for retired couples. From the combined rental income from the three units
(rather than 2) the builder reaps a larger return on his investment, so there is every incentive
to proceed with a certain number of these modified units.
State of the Art / Duncan / 8
A factor leading to comparatively simple adaptations of kitchens and bathrooms in the
Netherlands (as in Sweden) is the location of the fixtures. The plumbing and wiring are
outside the walls, rather than imbedded in plaster, resulting in greater flexibility for change.
In the resort town of Zandvoort, there is also a complex exclusively for severely
handicapped people. Housing approximately 200 people, the building is a star-shaped
structure radiating out from a central circular lounging area, with each wing containing
sleeping and dining quarters for the residents. The central area contains shops, restaurants
and a bar.
In the Netherlands, use of the public railway system is made difficult for disabled people by
the differences in levels of the doors to the railcars and the level of the approach platform to
the train. There is also a gap of approximately 50 centimeters between the platform and the
train. A portable ramp, developed by the Netherlands Society for Rehabilitation, member of
Rehabilitation International, has proved successful in overcoming these differences and is in
use at most major stations. Most of the railcar entrances have double doors blocked by a
center bar. On each train, however, the center bars are eliminated at one entrance to give
access to the wheelchair user. Dutch railways have a special telephone number enabling
assistance to be given at most stations, if applied for 48 hours in advance. Free rail travel is
provided for the escorts of handicapped people who cannot travel without assistance.
The Netherlands Society also directs the national activities of voluntary organizations in
making the environment more accessible and utilizes the services of nearly 100 consultants,
mainly handicapped people, to survey communities and to award the Symbol of Access to
those meeting the criteria.
NORWAY
In Norway, pursuant to the National Insurance Act, loans and/or grants are available for the
purchase of apartments and, in some cases, for the building of dwellings adapted to the needs
of disabled people. A condition is that by means of improved living conditions or by
relocation, the disabled individual may be ensured work which provides an income. The
Norwegian State Housing Bank has special rules for dwelling support for the disabled, both
in the building of new homes and in loans for the alteration of existing dwellings.
A proposal for new building regulations to benefit handicapped people has been introduced
recently by the Norwegian Ministry of Local Government. According to the Norwegian
Building Research Institute in Oslo, the proposal has been circulated for analysis to major
firms and organizations dealing with planning and design and rehabilitation.
A current research project being conducted by the Norwegian Handicap Organization in
cooperation with architects and planners is for the purpose of determining the costs of
adapting existing dwellings and local facilities for use by the handicapped. The object is to
establish the economic consequences of accessibility for society in general and to find if
accessibility does "pay" for the handicapped individual.
State of the Art / Duncan / 9
Significantly, the underground railway system in Oslo is generally accessible to disabled
people because the architectural planning principles utilized were sufficiently liberal to
encompass the minimal requirements of barrier free design. Ramps of generous dimension,
intended for the entire traveling public, are a feature of all station buildings. Large entrance
doors to the cars, which easily accommodate wheelchairs, were planned to increase the
efficiency of flow of all passengers. Interior space of cars is also liberal, which further
facilitates wheelchair access on this subway system. Although the original plans for the
subway in 1954 were completed without specific consideration of handicapped travelers,
current plans to improve the system, including the addition of lifts within station buildings,
are being made in consultation with Norwegian organizations for disabled people.
SWEDEN
In accordance with central recommendations from the Swedish association of local
authorities, many municipal authorities provide a local authority housing allowance for
handicapped persons. Other forms of support include the State housing grant for a disabled
person to furnish and equip a dwelling, plus any excess costs for hydraulic or electric lifting
devices. Apart from persons with severe orthopedic handicaps, certain persons with impaired
vision and those with greatly reduced ability to use their arms are entitled to this grant.
The Swedish Government has assumed financial responsibility for the disabled; nearly 50
percent of the disabled population receive some sort of pension and technical aids required
by handicapped individuals (some 450 items, including hearing aids and wheelchairs) are
paid for by the state.
Municipalities have assumed responsibility for personal care, services (including some
transportation) and various types of preventive measures, Municipalities draft building
development plans and build suitably designed apartments for the handicapped. Ninety
percent of all residential construction in Sweden is supported by state loans.
Standards for accessibility in Sweden were developed in 1964 and apply on a mandatory
basis only to those buildings and residential structures built according to guidelines set by
the National Housing Board. However, a movement is underway to make these norms
mandatory in private construction also. Incidentally, a trend which will aid adaptation in
private dwellings is a national movement towards the construction of single homes as
opposed to high rise structures.
If a handicapped person is living in an older residence, the government will allow
approximately $3500 to remodel the home; if an elevator is necessary, the grant will be
higher. Each year, nearly 3000 dwellings are modified for disabled people. Local county
housing boards decide on eligibility, in cooperation with rehabilitation counselors and
physicians. Most recently, mentally retarded persons have álso become eligible for these
grants.
In order to facilitate housing alternatives for the disabled, the Swiss Federation for
Integration of the Disabled into Economic Life has prepared directives on lodging
construction. Recently, the Directorate of Federal Constructions adopted, the directives for
consideration in construction of all public buildings, as well as those subsidized by the
Federation.
State of the Art / Duncan / 10
The Swedish Institute for the Handicapped is responsible for testing and evaluating all
technical aids for the disabled population. The aids are then recommended to the National
Board of Health and Welfare, which then approves them for grants. The testing also provides
a basis for centralizing buying of aids and its decisions can influence manufacturers designs.
The Institute also operates a telephone answering service for anyone wanting advice
regarding aids. Also operating from the Institute is the International Center on Technical
Aids, Housing and Transportation (ICTA), a standing commission of Rehabilitation
International, and a center for the collection and dissemination of information on these
subjects throughout the world.
Faltoversten is an inner city block of apartments sprinkled with units for the handicapped
which allow for complete integration. It is built over a busy subway terminal, with a
complete shopping center underground, accessible by elevator. A service unit is located in
the terminal just off the elevator, connected to each apartment for handicapped people by
alarm buzzers. Persons in wheelchairs can descend from their flats and go shopping, to a
library, or to the "winter garden," which is glass enclosed and heated in the winter. The
commercial, social and cultural services found in Faltovern are also used by residents of the
urban vicinity. Fourteen apartments of the 536 in the complex are designed for
handicapped individuals.
Undoubtedly, one of the most well known and emulated housing experiments for disabled
people is Fokus. The following report is a summary of the proceedings of a seminar on the
Fokus Society, held in 1972 in Canada:
Social services in Sweden are highly advanced, and it is within the context of these
services (and extremely high taxes) that the Fokus Society functions. County Councils
fund local authorities, and the latter, in turn can provide many services to a variety of
users. These services include home help, pensions, grants for renovating homes,
technical aids, health support, transportation and assistance in obtaining employment.
Dr. Sven Olaf Brattgard (founder of the Society) pointed out that although he is
confined to a wheelchair, he is not considered severely disabled. In other words, his
problems can be overcome by the normal provisions of state assistance.
The group which Fokus caters to are the severely disabled, who would normally be
confined to institutions. The Fokus program will shortly have housed 1,000 out of
approximately 2,000 persons in Sweden falling into this category.
In terms of new housing, the moderately disabled are well provided for. The Swedish
Government guideline for all subsidized housing, "God Bostad," requires (1) flexibility
in some unit designs to allow for conversion to suit a particular disabled user and (2)
dwellings designed to allow wheelchair visitors.
In Sweden, those suffering from various degrees of disability number about 10.4% of
the population in the age group 0-66 years and 29% of those over 66. In Fokus units,
80% are wheelchair users, 52% need help for normal toilet and kitchen use, 20% need
help in turning in bed and 25% come from nursing homes.
There has been a large demand for family units-disabled users want to marry in almost
the same proportion as the able-bodied population
The following is a summary by the Fokus Society, describing the design of the apartments,
the service component and the research element of its work:
State of the Art / Duncan / 11
One of the most important factors of successful rehabilitation is that the disabled
person
has to have somewhere to live-a home. But the most suitable flat,
well-planned and equipped is not enough. Equally important is the personal service he
can get. Another important factor is his opportunity to make contact with others
outside his home. Most of the money we spend on medical rehabilitation will be of
little value if we forget our duty to bring disabled persons back to a social life.
The simplest way in which we can give the disabled complete safety is some type of
institution. For some of the disabled, such an institution is necessary; from a social and
psychological point of view, these institutions are very bad. If the disabled person is to
be re-socialized, he has to take responsibility for his own life.
Planning for the disabled, especially the severely disabled, begins with the goal of
integration. From this point of view, it is necessary to build flats for the severely
disabled together with those for non-disabled in the same building. Such an integration
of the flats forces the community to plan all blocks and their surroundings, all shops
and offices with regard to the disabled. An integration of the flats will hasten the
opening up of the whole community to the disabled.
Dwelling Units
For single persons, we have designed a type of flat which looks like an all-activity
room. Only the bathroom is separated from the other part of the flat. The all activity
room has an area of approximately 410 square feet. There are different functional
areas in the room: one for preparing food, a dining area, a bed corner and a sofa group.
But it must be borne in mind that all the fittings in this flat are free-standing units.
Because of this flexibility, the tenant is able to redesign his flat according to his own
desires. The idea of this is not only to permit the redesigning, but is also an attempt to
introduce a home in which the tenant takes part in all that happens around him.
All the fittings are designed to offer tenants with some kind of disability the best
possible opportunities. Most of the tenants are wheelchair users and are thus in a sitting
position. Others use crutches and have to work in a standing position. AH fittings in the
kitchen and bathroom are therefore vertically adjustable. An easily operated
console-track system makes it possible to adapt the height of work-benches, cupboards,
stove and oven to what is best for the tenant.
The plan of the kitchen is based on a system of analysis and investigations in special
laboratories, as well as in practical use. The place for food preparation is between the
sink and the stove. Movable chests of drawers, preferably on wheels, offer the tenant
an ever-present choice of where he wants his storage units.
The bathroom is planned after a series of investigations into how disabled persons
move and act. With a special three-dimensional mirror-method, we have made an
analysis of the functions of persons with different types of disability and with different
technical aids. Both the hand-basin and the shower are placed in a console-track
system.
State of the Art / Duncan / 12
Services
The service system is as important as the designing of the flats. Very often, all
discussion of housing for the disabled is concentrated on the architectural level-very
seldom do we discuss personal assistance. The disabled person who only needs an
occasional helping hand is no problem; the situation is very different when day and
night services are required.
From our investigations and practical experience of the problems of the severely
disabled, we have found it necessary to create service units of not more than 12 to 15
flats. These flats are all integrated, but in such a way that it is possible for the
personnel to serve the resident easily, for example, one flat on each floor. To avoid the
tendency toward a total institution, we have arranged the service system as follows.
Every tenant who needs more than occasional help is given his own individual assistant
who comes each day for one or more hours. The assistant takes care not only of the
tenant, but also of his home. If the tenant needs, the assistant will wash clothes, clean
the flat, prepare food and purchase what is needed. Assistance is also given as needed in
daily living activities.
In addition to these individual assistants, the building has service attendants whose job
it is to give all tenants a helping hand at any time of the day or night.
We have divided the service provided into these two groups for several reasons. Most
importantly, the tenant likes to have his own individual assistant, someone who takes
care of him in particular, who knows his habits and so on. It is thus unnecessary for the
tenant to instruct all the attendants in detail. Another reason for having this
organization is that the individual assistants come in from the outside and impart a
special atmosphere. They are not regarded as servants-more as friends arriving with
news.
Selecting the service personnel is a very important matter. They must not nurse in the
ordinary hospital way, but must be very open-minded and careful of the tenant's
privacy. It is very important that all service personnel should receive special training.
Special transportation arrangements can also be made to enable residents to enjoy
cultural activities and holidays.
Development and Structure of the Fokus Society
The Fokus Society began in 1964. In 1965 we obtained a day on radio and television
for a telethon which raised approximately 2 million dollars. With this money we have
to date rented 280 flats in 14 cities throughout Sweden.
The Fokus Society never builds any houses or flats, but rents them from developers.
The developers obtain from the Government a subsidy (maximum of around $3,000)
for each flat completely adapted for a disabled person. If the costs for the flats and
common rooms exceed this amount, the developers must cover the costs by rents.
Therefore, the Fokus Society has to pay the "real" costs of the flat and common
rooms except for the Government subsidy.
State of the Art / Duncan / 13
The rent for the flat includes garage as well as common rooms. The tenant himself
must pay the rent, although if he has a low income, he will receive some subsidies from
the authorities and the Fokus Society helps many of the tenants with their rents.
The cost per year for a tenant in a Fokus, unit can be calculated from the experiences
in the cities where the activity has been going on for at least two years. In the first
year, there will be many extra costs which are not representative of the long-term
normal expenditures.
As an example, we can examine the total costs per year for the Fokus tenant in seven
cities in 1971. The mean total rent for the flats and the common rooms is about
$1,300. The tenants themselves pay around 18%. The subsidies from the communities
and Fokus total about $1,050 per year.
The mean total cost for the service staff, personal assistants as well as attendants in
general, is $3,300 dollars per year, per tenant.
The total cost for housing and services is approximately $4,500 a year-less than half
the cost of that in a modern nursing home or boarding school. The total cost per day is
around $10 a day in a Fokus Unit.
The structure of the Fokus Society includes three groups of participants. The first
consists of representatives of the community, the second comes from the organizations
of the disabled themselves and the third comes from the foundations and societies
working with and for the disabled.
The central board has the task of giving general directions for the work of the Society.
In each city where Fokus is established, there is a local board. The members of these
boards come from the local community, the tenants and the Fokus Society. Very close
cooperation is thus maintained between Fokus and the community. At all stages the
tenants or their representatives have an opportunity to make their voices heard.
Before establishing itself in a city, Fokus has discussions with the local authorities
about the location of the unit, the opportunities for the tenants to obtain jobs and
education. A very important item in the discussions is the transportation system for
disabled in the city. In all cities where Fokus is established, the community has a
special transportation system where the disabled with taxis or special buses can obtain
transportation to and from work, school or other activities, including visiting the
theater and friends.
Research
The Fokus Society has access to extensive research facilities. The Department of
Handicap Research at the University of Goteborg is one. Special research teams can be
assembled for specialized studies and paid for by the state. One example of the
thoroughness of the research is a time and motion study of food preparation. A
standard meal was prepared in a typical kitchen for the able-bodied and a Fokus
kitchen. The meal in the "normal" kitchen required 152 wheelchair movements and
458 hand movements, compared with 12 and 158 respectively in the Fokus unit.
State of the Art / Duncan / 14
Employment
Although most of the tenants (80%) were pensioners and out of work when they
obtained their flats, in the first 46 flats which have been in use now for more than
three years, nearly 80% of the tenants are working or receiving education. For many, a
job is a way to become closely integrated into society and to establish contact with
others.
A selected international bibliography on barrier free design was published as an annex to the
United Nations Report and is available from Rehabilitation International.
Barbara Duncan
Managing Editor
International Rehabilitation Review
122 East 23rd Street
New York, New York 10010
A MODEL SHELTERED WORKSHOP
Frank D. Gentile
Today there are many sheltered workshops throughout the country. They represent a wide
range of activities from remunerative work on a non-profit basis to a variety of services from
evaluation to placement in competitive industry. There are work activity centers which
require no minimum wage and serve the most severely disabled whose productive capacities
may be inconsequential. Then, there are those shops which employ people and provide a
wide variety of rehabilitation services for one type of competitive employment or another.
This paper will deal mainly with those workshops which pay at least 50 percent of the
minimum wage.
In 1968 the National Association of Sheltered Workshops and Homebound Programs (now
the Association of Rehabilitation Facilities) defined sheltered workshops as follows:
A sheltered workshop is a non-profit rehabilitation facility utilizing individual goals,
wages, supportive services in a controlled work environment to help vocationally
handicapped persons achieve or maintain their maximum potential as workers.
The best estimate today is that there are some 1700 workshops, many of which have two or
more branches. Probably some 400 are general in nature serving a variety of disabilities and
some 800 are work activity centers. The balance are specialized for the blind, the mentally
retarded and mentally ill. With the exception of the blind, the average workshop has
probably been operating for ten years.
Workshop Clients
The clients that are served by these shops represent a severely disabled population. Most
clients are mentally retarded, mentally ill or blind. Many also have a secondary disability. It
is safe to assume that most of the people who come to workshops for assistance have limited
educational background and experience. In addition, they present workshops with such
rehabilitation problems as transportation and assistance in activities of daily living.
Workshop Programs
Workshop programs fall into three main categories: rehabilitation, placement and work.
The area of rehabilitation covers personal adjustment training and activities of daily living.
In personal adjustment training, clients are taught to deal with demands of personal and
other relationships, and demands at work and in the general environment. In activities of
daily living the severely disabled are taught to be independent in their daily self-care. This is
especially true of the mentally retarded and the more severely physically disabled.
1
State of the Art / Gentile / 2
The second area is placement in competitive business and industry. This includes not only
the actual placement of the individual at work but all the elements in the placement process,
such as placement readiness training (e.g., job finding, interview techniques).
The third function of sheltered workshops is work which is remunerative and ranges from
assessment on the job to long-term employment in the workshop at a minimum of 50
percent of the minimum wage or above the minimum wage.
Workshop Management
While a workshop provides programs for severely disabled clients, it must also be concerned
with staffing, management, financial responsibility and contract procurement. In larger
workshops there are basically two types of staff: the professional staff, which handles the
rehabilitation aspects, and the management staff, which handles finance, business manage-
ment and contract procurement. However, in smaller workshops with minimal staff, many
of the people must assume multiple responsibilities, especially the workshop director. For
the purposes of this paper we will attempt to describe the larger organization that has at
least a minimal rehabilitation professional staff and management who must handle the
day-to-day people and business activities.
In the area of management, two of the most important concerns in this country today are
wages of clients and workshop finances. While it is difficult to get exact figures, we do know
that the average wage is just above the minimum and that shops usually require outside
sources of support. In addition, the individual also requires other sources of support, such as
public benefits or their families. Some shops subsidize wages. Public benefits are available to
the clients in a majority of the workshops. However, it is difficult to determine if these are
sufficient to make workshop clients' incomes comparable to average wages in business and
industries of the same size. In addition, the work sub-contracted to many shops is not
comparable to business and industry.
Workshops receive income mostly from contracts, but, in addition, many receive income for
services to clients from other agencies, and contributions. Contributions are generally the
least of the three. The average workshop generally breaks even at the end of a fiscal year.
A Workshop Model
In order to more fully understand the role of the workshop and the severely disabled at
work let us examine a model. This is a model not only of a demonstration work center but
of a comprehensive rehabilitation center serving the needs of the severely disabled.
Human Resources Center
Human Resources Center, established in Albertson, Long. Island, New York, is composed of
three coordinated units: Human Resources School, Human Resources Research and Training
Institute, and Abilities Inc.
Human Resources School is a private, non-profit educational institution chartered by
the Board of Regents of the State of New York, offering a full academic curriculum to
previously homebound disabled children from pre-school through senior high school. The
school, in conjunction with the Research and Training Institute, conducts research in
curriculum development, modifications of teaching equipment, physical plant design and
State of the Art / Gentile / 3
research in teaching techniques. The school also serves as a national center for teachers of
the disabled at the pre-school, elementary and secondary level.
Human Resources Research and Training Institute is the non-profit component conducting
research programs in medicine, bio-engineering and psychology relating to the disabled, aged
and retarded. The Institute also conducts evaluation and training programs. In addition, a
variety of innovative demonstration programs are conducted showing how the disabled can
be productive.
Abilities Inc.
Abilities Inc, is the non-profit demonstration industrial and clerical work center. Abilities
and Human Resources Center could serve as a model for any modern industrial and business
complex. There are no stairs. Where there is grading, ramps are provided. No one can trip on
a step and wheelchairs can move about unimpeded. Bathrooms, as well as water fountains
and phone booths, are accessible.
In Abilities the workers are all disabled, retarded or aged. They work a full 40 hours each
week to industrial standards. No pre-employment medical examination is given. The main
requirement for employment is motivation-the will to work. The employee is interviewed,
evaluated and trained, or hired on a three-month trial basis if he or she has had no work
experience. The handicapped worker receives at least the minimum wage or a higher wage
commensurate with experience. In addition, all the workers receive all benefits, including
life insurance, medical, hospital, major medical and pension, at no extra cost to them.
The Abilities' engineering team evaluate both the job and the worker, and they modify the
process by technical changes. Some of these modification have been adopted by local
industry and have proven helpful to the non-disabled as well. These modifications have
resulted in greater safety, increased production and less fatigue. In fact, the safety record at
Abilities has been so good that it has a low insurance classification, qualifying it for a rate
reduction of 30 percent.
Examples of job modification include such items as a raised working surface for a fused
arthritic who can't sit; holding fixtures for individuals who have the use of only one hand;
and bench machines lowered for those in wheelchairs, rather than being at a height designed
for standing.
Originally set up in a converted garage in Hempstead, New York, Abilities Inc. now occupies
50,000 square feet of manufacturing space as part of the Human Resources Center complex.
Abilities Inc. employs about 150 men and women, 99 percent sustaining a handicap of some
kind. Despite this, they operate highly technical precision machinery, working from
wheelchairs in many cases. Employees include those without full use of arms and legs,
amputees, paraplegics, cardiacs, arrested tuberculosis, deaf mutes, retarded, etc. Every
manager, foreman, production worker is totally qualified for his or her job. All are paid
prevailing wages, and many support families. For the severely disabled, Abilities is a place
where people are working productively and not soliciting business on the basis of a handout.
Abilities Inc.'s first work was in the aerospace industry. Under government contracts, it
produced components for companies like Grumman, Sperry and Republic. The workers
wired aircraft assemblies and put in circuit units. When the economic recession showed its
State of the Art / Gentile / 4
effects on business a few years ago, Abilities underwent a major reorganization in its
attempts to diversify into other fields. As the aerospace market evaporated, management
had to explore other possibilities, which led to production of computer parts for other
manufacturers in the commercial field. The organization's own reservoir of potential
management talent was tapped. Today managers from the handicapped workforce run the
operation.
This was one of the most important aspects of Abilities Inc.'s development. In order for
such a workshop as Abilities to survive it developed better management techniques and
contract procurement procedures, as well as diversifying its work and enhancing its
specialized areas.
Vocational Rehabilitation and Placement Programs
Another area of the Center which relates to Abilities' activities is the Research and Training
Institute, which conducts a series of research, training and demonstration studies of the
severely disabled in competitive work. The Center is a comprehensive vocational rehabili-
tation center with programs which include medical and psychological services, job modifi-
cation, architectural barrier removal, evaluation, training, work adjustment, attitudinal
seminars and placement.
One of the most important elements in a comprehensive workshop program for the disabled
is good evaluation, training and employment demonstration where the severely disabled can
succeed, and businessmen, professionals and others who are interested can see what can be
done first-hand.
Work Evaluation
The evaluation phase should consist of a battery of evaluation work samples, skills and tests
to determine potential. The series, where needed, should be adapted for the disabled.
Standardized tests should only be administered where needed. More important are the
informal and special instruments developed to measure the clients' progress during this
phase.
The Pre-Vocational Evaluation program at Human Resources Center offers a pre-vocational
evaluation to the severely disabled persons referred by the New York State Office of
Vocational Rehabilitation and other organizations.
The program exposes the disabled to work and job samples in a wide range of skills areas.
Included in the syllabus are small engine repair, gauges, meters, para-medical professions,
drafting, and heating and air conditioning.
The program is also designed to provide private business and industry with a means of
evaluating disabled employees for upward mobility potential, as well as to evaluate those
employees who were recently disabled prior to returning to work.
A maximum of five clients is evaluated during the two-week program. Each disabled person
is given the opportunity for vocational exploration through interest inventory testing, work
and job sampling, and individual and group counseling. Once the academic competency level
and areas of vocational interest are determined, the disabled individual and his counselor-
State of the Art / Gentile / 5
evaluator set up an individualized evaluation plan. This plan focuses on job and work
samples utilizing the Singer, J.E.V.S. and MIND approaches which simulate actual on-the-
job skills and physical requirements. The results of the pre-vocational evaluation indicate the
training areas that would be most appropriate for the disabled person.
Upon completion of the program, a complete report with training and/or placement
recommendations is sent to the state office of vocational rehabilitation or the appropriate
organization to assist the counselor and client in developing a realistic vocational plan.
Vocational Training and Job Readiness Skills
Those who successfully complete evaluation should then enter a training phase. This should
include work skill practice and social development skills such as working with others, work
habits, grooming and safety and job readiness. Also during this time, counseling could be
introduced for those who require it. It is also important to consider the use of audio-visual
aids such as films and programmed instruction. Each client should be evaluated for any
special devices required for successful placement.
While some of the disabled clients will have the basic education needed to perform the
proposed jobs, many may require some form of remedial work in order to become qualified
workers. Remedial classroom work in mathematics and reading, supplemented with
individual study, should be planned. This aspect of the program will especially help those
who were educationally disadvantaged.
Started in 1961, the Vocational Training Program at Human Resources Center serves the
severely disabled, mentally retarded and aged. The disabled persons are referred to Human
Resources Center by the New York State Office of Vocational Rehabilitation and other
organizations.
The curriculum for the Industrial course consists of instruction in the use of hand tools,
operation sheets and wiring diagrams, cable making, printed circuit board assembly, chassis
wiring and mechanical assembly. In addition, soldering, component identification and color
coding are included.
The Business Skills course includes filing, collating, typing, keypunch and office machine
operation, as well as record keeping, payroll and inventory control procedures.
Preparation for employment is stressed in a number of job readiness programs: Group and
individual counseling include role playing for job interviews, testing and personal grooming.
Sessions are also conducted in Job Seeking Skills.
Remedial assistance is available in Reading, Spelling, Grammar and Math if needed.
Adapted Driver Education
Many disabled clients have physical disabilities which are so severe that they cannot use
public transportation; others live in areas where public transportation is not available. At
Human Resources Center we have tried to solve this problem in the following way. Initially,
the person is asked to provide his own means of transportation. If this is not possible,
transportation during the evaluation and training phase is arranged through car pools,
State of the Art / Gentile / 6
private transportation on a reimbursement basis or the use of the Center's carryall bus
adapted for wheelchairs. However, since one of our major goals is to help the disabled
achieve independence, supportive transportation services are only utilized during the initial
phases. Once the person has been placed on the job, he is encouraged to make more realistic
transportation, arrangements.
However, it is realized that adapted driver education is vitally important in the vocational
placement of many handicapped individuals since mass transit systems do not offer a viable
means of transporting the disabled to and from work. In order to help overcome this crucial
problem and to aid the disabled to successfully enter the world of work, the Center offers a
comprehensive driver education program.
Here, the severely disabled are first evaluated psychologically, physically and functionally in
a driver simulator with adapted hand controls to fit individual needs. Following this, a
modified curriculum is utilized in both computerized simulators and on the road in an
adapted automobile. The laboratory is also being used to conduct a variety of research
projects to advance the state of the art so that more severely disabled people can drive.
On-the-Job Training
The phase of On-the-Job Training may be conducted either at the workshop or in the actual
business or industrial setting. Regardless of the setting, the individual should now be
brought from a benign atmosphere to a competitive one since he will be expected to develop
proficiency in all necessary job skills within the occupational classification.
This period requires a number of components important to successful placement. These
include a length of time allotted to training for the particular job, supportive counseling for
the client and employer, modification of equipment and facilities at the place of work, and
extended periodic follow-up on the worker's progress.
Innovative Models in Placement
Concurrently with the components discussed above, Abilities provides information and
attitude and sensitivity training for managers and first-line supervisors of companies
interested in hiring the handicapped. Human Resources has found this to be a critical
component. While those with negative attitudes may not become accepting, those who lack
information or are uncertain may develop a more positive attitude as a result of seminars in
a demonstration center such as Human Resources. This can demonstrate to the prospective
employer the positive aspects of the disabled by seeing firsthand what can be done and how
the disabled individual can lead a normal life.
Although the concepts of placement and employment are being discussed in other papers,
placement is a primary and vital element of workshop activities. Described below are some
of Human Resource Center's innovative placement programs.
Projects With Industry
Projects With Industry at Human Resources Center was designed for the severely physically
disabled-disadvantaged client. Our primary goals were to obtain entry-level white-collar jobs
in the business community and to expand the vocational opportunities for this population
State of the Art / Gentile / 7
in competitive commercial settings of major companies. In order to limit the Center's
training programs to each company's on-the-job training program, the staff was required to
work closely with a business advisory group so as to select and develop instructional
materials and training equipment. The project was designed to place the trainee on the job
as quickly as possible with evaluation and training limited to eleven weeks at the Center.
Each industry assumed responsibility for training the individual in the specific job tasks.
Projects With Industry has placed approximately 254 severely disabled persons in competitive
employment. Disabilities included are: paraplegia, quadriplegia, hemiplegia, cerebral palsy,
cancer, blindness, deafness, heart disease, post-stroke condition and sickle cell anemia. Over
10 percent of the people have had to be placed in more than one job SO that placements are
in excess of 254. Salaries range from $5,000 to $10,000 annually. Examples of specific job
titles include: microfilm technician, stock transfer clerk, accounting clerk, credit authorizer,
file clerk, typist and teller.
Work Orientation for Severely Disabled College Students
The purpose of the Work Orientation Program is to provide the disabled college student
with a realistic work experience related to his goal upon graduation and help in effective
placement. The program also serves to help ease the transition from student to employee,
and to better prepare the student to function as a productive, well-adjusted worker.
As part of the program each disabled student is offered a three- to five-day intensive
workshop encompassing job-seeking skills, means of selecting an appropriate occupation,
and methods to increase personal abilities in order to enhance employment opportunities.
Relevant part-time or summer employment is secured for those who complete the
orientation. The participating employer pays one-half of the student's salary for 400 hours.
At the completion of the second year of the program, 70 severely disabled students had
been employed in career-related summer and part-time positions. They were placed in
libraries, universities, service agencies and industry.
Homebound Employment
Competitive work can also be found for those severely disabled who are homebound. Under
a special innovative project the Center has developed jobs for the most severely disabled as
Insurance Claims Adjustors for a major insurance company working at home. Successful
placements have been made in a variety of telephone-based positions such as information
operator for disaster calls; personalized answering service operator; dispatcher; and substi-
tute teacher acquisition clerk for local school districts.
Affirmative Action
A recent development of particular importance to workshops is the Affirmative Action
regulations requiring all companies having federal contracts in excess of $2,500 to develop
and implement a satisfactory employment plan for the qualified handicapped person
including elimination of architectural barriers to employment, personnel and training
provisions and job modifications when necessary.
State of the Art / Gentile / 8
As a result, Human Resources Center developed seminars and an Advisory Service in order
to help business and industry comply with these new regulations.
The Future
Workshops throughout the country must survive and grow in today's economy by
developing and implementing a number of programs and practices.
One of the priorities is the development of better management and contract procurement
procedures and policies. Workshops must begin considering the effective utilization of
N.I.S.H. and the Wagner-O'Day Amendments in the procurement of contracts on a Federal,
Regional and State basis. This might include such concepts as the organization of a
consortium of workshops in an area to centralize strengths. Other developmental programs
might also consider the use of business "consultants" in the manufacturing process and
management techniques, as well as methods engineering for the more severely disabled in
the actual sheltered work setting.
Another prime consideration in the actual work setting is the exploration of more
diversified types of work and enhancing the current expertise of work skills available in the
shop. This might include finding areas for better contracts and employment than currently
being provided. For example, some shops could consider expanding from simple packaging
to routine clerical tasks which might be available for sub-contract and entry level
employment in local businesses. Another area of consideration could include upgrading the
current level of work contracts in the shop from simple mechanical assembly to more
complex mechanical assembly operations through job methodization and engineering.
In the area of vocational rehabilitation (i.e., placement), better and innovative placement
techniques and programs should be given top priority, researched and developed for more
effective placements. There are a number of models that have been developed across the
country. These include group integrity placements, trial and short OJT placements, the
training of placement specialists in the agency, and the development of jobs through
increased and closer contacts with business and industry.
A second important consideration in placement is a more effective and vigorous implemen-
tation and use of the Affirmative Action sections of the Rehabilitation Act of 1973. This is
an area where workshops and vocational rehabilitational facilities can be particularly helpful
to the federal, educational and business communities. Expertise could be offered not only
from a legal point of view, but as persuasive and educational techniques as well.
Finally and equally as important is the development and cultivation of closer relationships
with the local, state, regional and federal vocational rehabilitation agencies (as well as other
related organizations) in order to increase and enhance workshop activities. The proper
maintenance of these relationships could lead to funding for expansion and innovation in
placement process projects, professional and management staff development, more realistic
training programs and an improved channel of information dissemination.
State of the Art / Gentile / 9
By not only recognizing the needs of the severely handicapped, but those of the employer
and professional as well, and utilizing a realistic approach in placement, employment of the
handicapped can work effectively. Each of the some 200,000 disabled people placed across
the country each year have their own success story and have shown that vocational
rehabilitation pays. It is the task of sheltered workshops and vocational rehabilitation
centers to collaborate with business and industry and together prove the job can be done.
Frank D. Gentile
Vice President
Human Resources Center
Albertson, Long Island, New York 11507
INDEPENDENT LIVING ARRANGEMENTS FOR
SEVERELY PHYSICALLY DISABLED PERSONS
Lex Frieden
Just as housing tops the needs list for the general population, so it does for severely
physically disabled persons. The number of severely physically disabled (SPD) persons in the
United States is not exactly known, but it is probably on the order of 200,000 (Fay, 1975)
Several comprehensive surveys have been done to determine the housing needs of SPD
persons, and they all reach the same conclusion: SPD persons are in need of specialized
housing and few suitable solutions exist today (California, 1969; Fenton, 1972; Michel,
1972).
The problems of housing for SPD individuals should not be taken out of the broader
context from which they come. Housing problems for SPD persons are special because such
individuals have extraordinary needs. A severe physical disability, in the sense to which it is
here referred, is a mobility or function impairment which requires a person to be signifi-
cantly dependent on other people or devices to satisfy his basic life needs.
Housing generally refers to physical structures or dwellings, but when one speaks of housing
in terms of severely handicapped persons, it must also refer to necessary life support
systems. Life support systems provide services which must be incorporated in housing plans
and implementation. To avoid associations with the traditional use of the word "housing,"
and to clearly indicate the broad nature of the problems involved in providing suitable living
accommodations for SPD individuals, all references in this paper to housing in the broader
context will be in terms of "living arrangements."
Almost everyone concerned agrees that SPD persons exist in significant numbers, and most
authorities agree that many SPD people are forced to live in unsuitable accommodations.
Disagreements begin to arise, however, when one tries to determine what sort of accommo-
dations are suitable for SPD persons to live and prosper in. The thesis of this paper is that
almost any living arrangement can be made suitable if the proper resources are available and
if the SPD resident is given a part in the planning and managemènt of the arrangement. A
suitable living arrangement is an independent living arrangement.
Philosophical Concepts
Several basic philosophical concepts are critical to this position. Perhaps the most important
of these is independence. The different between suitable and unsuitable living arrangements
for SPD individuals may actually be the difference between independence and dependence.
Complete independence is not obtainable for anyone. It should be possible, though, for
persons to choose what they will depend on and to readjust their dependency whenever
they like. SPD persons will always be dependent on their social and physical environment to
some degree. They may never be independent in terms of financial income, personal
1
State of the Art / Frieden / 2
physical care, or environmental barriers; but they should be able to choose what sort of
wheelchair they buy, who takes care of them, and where they live.
To live independently one need not be physically independent. He must, however, have
some control over his own life, and the extent to which he does influence his own destiny
determines the degree of independence he maintains. A SPD person can involve himself in
an environment free of physical and social barriers where reliable and sufficient attendant
care is available. Under these circumstances, he can learn and work and live relatively
independently. This is the epitome of an independent living arrangement (ILA). An ILA is a
suitable living arrangement in which the SPD resident has an opportunity to manifest his
independence by choosing his own course.
It should be noted that just because someone is given a choice, he may not necessarily make
a decision. Some physically dependent persons who live in unsatisfactory nursing homes will
not move to a more independent living arrangement even if they are given the opportunity.
They should, nevertheless, be given the choice.
Everyone should be able to choose where he lives-in what section of town, in what sort of
physical structure, and where in that dwelling he stays. The SPD person is restricted from
making these choices now because very few housing structures are accessible to wheelchairs.
Preference surveys of the sort which indicate that handicapped persons prefer to live
together (Columbus & Fogel, 1971; see also Fishman, 1971) may be used to justify the
construction of specially designed housing projects exclusively for SPD persons, or
"ghettos" for the handicapped. These projects are fine for those persons who choose to live
there, however they are unsatisfactory for those persons who must live there because they
have no choice.
Another important concept which relates to independence and freedom of choice is
individuality. The concept of individuality applies to living arrangements because it stresses
the importance of planning not for a class of disabled person, but instead, for an individual
person who may be disabled. Individuality should be manifested in the personalization of
one's living space. Individuals should have the freedom to choose their own furnishings and
decorations, regardless of where they live. Also, persons should not be restricted to their
original selection and arrangement of furnishings. They should be free to rearrange their
personal living space whenever and however they wish.
The individual's right to and need for privacy should also be considered by living
arrangement planners. Provisions need to be made so that the SPD person will have a place
to be alone whenever he desires, without feeling trapped or insecure.
Two basic theoretical approaches should be added to the concepts of independence and
individuality to be used as guidelines by planners of ILA's for severely disabled persons.
These are systems theory and developmental theory.
Generally, all considerations involving housing should be made from a systems viewpoint,
with close attention given to the total environment. This is particularly important when SPD
persons are concerned, for their needs are broader than those of the normal able-bodied
population. For example, a SPD person who cannot drive his own car, yet who lives within
rolling distance of his school or work, and other conveniences, may be just as independent
State of the Art / Frieden / 3
as an able-bodied person who drives his own car. In this case, environmental and systems
considerations may have helped the mobility impaired individual compensate for his
handicap by locating him in a community of nearby resources.
A systems approach to the problems of living arrangement design for severely disabled
persons is also useful from another standpoint-that is, the organization of need-satisfying
services. It is not sufficient to simply make available necessary services for the SPD person.
These services must be provided in an organized fashion and this can only be done within a
systems framework by someone who understands the needs of the individual and has the
authority, resources, and competence to make the system work. In this way, the needs of
the individual can be met in a coordinated manner consistent with his desires.
The developmental approach is an extremely useful one in the context of living
arrangements for severely disabled persons. Disabilities are often developmental by nature.
A person's physical condition may improve or become worse, slowly or suddenly. Attitudes
may change in addition to physical abilities and these psychological variables may affect the
living arrangement needs of individuals. In any case, living arrangements should be available
to accommodate the severely disabled person during any stage of his life. Developmental
considerations add emphasis to the need for a variety of solutions to the problem of
arranging independent living opportunities for SPD persons.
The principle of normalization is closely related to the developmental approach.
Normalization, in this case, is a transition by a SPD individual from an institutionalized sort
of dependent living arrangement to a more independent community-based residence. Over
half of the SPD individuals in a study reported by Stock and Cole (1975) moved from an
institutionalized group living arrangement to a more independent setting. A SPD person may
need to be institutionalized during some times of his life, but this fact does not justify
keeping him institutionalized if he chooses to be more independent.
Physical Characteristics
Now, having reviewed the ideological bases of ILA's, let us look at some of the particular
physical and social aspects. The physical characteristics of an ILA are very important for
they may directly affect the degree of independence a resident can maintain. Many sorts of
behavior are site dependent, and ecological studies have demonstrated that the degree of
independent behavior by SPD individuals may vary as a function of changes in the physical
environment (Willems, 1972; Willems and Campbell, 1975). A paraplegic who lives in a place
where he has easy access to a bathroom will probably be considerably more independent
than he would be otherwise. Likewise, the quadriplegic who can reach and operate the
knobs on his wash basin may be more independent than one who cannot.
The SPD person will be able to realize and manifest his independence in a barrier-free
environment. Many different physical barriers may prevent free access to the SPD person in
a living arrangement. Among these are curbs, steps, narrow hallways and doorways, heavy
doors, high counters and cabinets, small bathrooms and kitchens, low beds, low tables, and
low toilet seats.
The best sort of barrier free environment is one which is adaptable. An adaptable design
allows for individual differences and takes into consideration the developmental aspects of
State of the Art / Frieden / 4
disability as well as the transient nature of some individuals. A truly adaptable living space is
one in which the walls are moveable, and in which the toilet seat, bathroom and kitchen
fixtures, cabinets, shelves, and household appliances can be raised, lowered, and moved to
meet the needs of any individual (see Brattgard, 1971).
Probably the most important consideration to be made in relation to the physical living
space of the SPD person is location. It affects the extent to which an individual is dependent
on transportation to reach location-bound goods and services. As pointed out earlier, living
arrangement location may best be viewed from a systems approach, within the context of
the total environment (LaPierre, 1974). Site planners should consider location with respect
to an individual's occupation, as well as his service and convenience needs. Such needs might
include medical centers, shopping centers, recreation centers, and transportation centers.
It is necessary to provide a suitable amount of personal and private space for every
individual in an ILA. The amount of personal space one needs varies across individuals and
time. Every person should have at least enough space for a bed, a desk, clothing, and
personal articles.
In group residential settings, an extra room may be advantageously used as an operations
center. Residents may use intercoms or other call systems to communicate with personnel in
the center.
Many special considerations which lie beyond the scope of this paper may be given to the
physical environment as it related to the SPD person. In addition to barrier free design,
environmental control devices (i.e., remote controls, Possum, etc.) may be effectively
utilized to make the mobility impaired individual more independent in his living
arrangement. It should be realized that SPD persons may become dependent on a barrier
free or mechanized environment to the extent that they cannot function outside that
specially designed environment. In this case, independence in the broader sense may be
sacrificed for a limited sort of physical independence.
Life Support System
The life support system is an integral part of any ILA. Probably the most critical service to
be provided in a system of life support services for the physically limited is that of attendant
care.
Attendants may be called upon to assist the SPD person in completing a variety of tasks.
These tasks include daily living and personal hygiene activities. They may also include
general housekeeping and maintenance activities. In some cases, attendants may be required
to run errands or assist with transportation.
The foremost tasks to be done in making an attendant arrangement are selection and
supervision. Attendant candidates may be located through a number of means. Employment
agencies and school placement centers are usually the best sources of finding reliable
employees since the individuals who are referred have been pre-screened. Newspaper
advertisements get voluminous responses, but the chances of finding responsible attendants
State of the Art / Frieden / 5
through this route are not good.
Another potentially useful source for locating and screening attendants is a central registry.
The Center for Independent Living in Berkeley has used this method effectively for several
years and it should be tried elsewhere. Central registries may help coordinate life support
systems across a number of ILA's, thereby allowing for better use of existing services.
Since almost anyone can learn the skills required to be a good attendant, the most
important attendant selection criteria are those of attitude and dependability. The best
bases from which to judge these characteristics are interviews. Information about attitudes
may be obtained from discussions with the applicant, his friends, and former employers.
Work histories and listed references may be useful in determining probable dependability.
After an attendant has been selected, it is standard to make a job agreement with him. He
needs to understand the extent of his responsibility. A job description like the one in Table
I may be useful in outlining expectations. The attendant should agree to give sufficient
notice when he intends to quit. He should also agree to notify his employer as early as
possible if he is not going to be able to work on any particular occasion.
It is prudent for the SPD person in need of daily assistance to always have a contingency
arrangement worked out for use when the primary system fails. Satisfactory contingency
arrangements are best made with family members or close friends.
Shared attendant services may be very efficient and cost-effective. ILA's involving small
groups of four to eight are fairly easy to manage. With larger groups, attendant staffing and
scheduling becomes complicated and administrative tasks multiply. Everyone in the group
should assume a share of these responsibilities, whether they do so by hiring someone to
manage the system or by dividing the work among themselves.
The key to good management of any successful ILA is organization. The SPD individual
must plan and schedule activities ahead of time if he is to function independently in a living
arrangement. Some persons may argue that extensive use of planning and scheduling makes
an individual more dependent. In one sense, this is true. However, independence in the sense
used here refers to managing one's own affairs. Plans and schedules are simply organizational
tools which allow the SPD person to be more independent.
Table I
Attendant Job Description
The TIRR residential services program is a complete living arrangement designed to meet the
basic needs of a group of handicapped young adults. The concept of independent living is
supported by a system of assistive services provided by a staff of non-professional aides and
attendants.
The duties and responsibilities of the aides and attendants are:
To assist in activities such as:
showering
dressing and undressing
bowel and bladder programs
transferring
changing and caring for urinary devices
emptying and cleaning leg bags and bed bags
serving and setting up food trays
State of the Art / Frieden / 6
To provide assistance in the following housekeeping services in each individual room:
laundry (wash, dry, fold)
bed making
straightening of personal articles in room
To accept responsibilities of general building maintenance by:
emptying trash cans in orderly room and recreation room
keeping tables in cafeteria clear of trash and trays
keeping halls, recreation room, and orderly room clean and clear of trash
keeping utility room clean
All established schedules such as shower schedule, laundry schedule, transportation
schedule, get-up sheet, and evening activity sheet should be followed carefully and should
not vary except in emergency situations.
All requests for assistance by the residents should be promptly considered and carried out
without delay.
When not busy with resident assistance, all staff members should stay in the hall so that
lights can be answered without delay.
Scheduling in group ILA's may be done ahead of time with sign-up sheets. These forms may
be kept in a convenient place so that residents can write down when they wish to get up, go
to bed, shower, or utilize transportation services. To avoid scheduling conflicts, service
priorities should be predetermined when services are shared. Scheduling activities one day in
advance seems to be sufficient in existing systems. This allows residents to make fairly
spontaneous plans, and it gives the system manager the opportunity to adjust employee
schedules to meet the demand.
Staff scheduling is a pertinent issue here. Improper staffing may lead to a number of
problems. If too many attendants are on duty at any given time, unnecessary expenses are
incurred and residents are tempted to depend on staff assistance with tasks they might
otherwise do themselves. If too few attendants are on duty, residents may receive
unsatisfactory care or become frustrated waiting on service.
To maintain maximum service efficiency, staffing patterns must be based on routine
demand. Service demands vary, but individuals customarily develop predictable behavior
patterns which make attendant scheduling easier. Peak demands occur regularly in the
mornings when residents are getting up for work or school, and in the evenings when
everyone is going to bed. Under normal conditions, staff needs can be predicted fairly
accurately. Table II illustrates a method of determining how many attendants will be needed
on duty during a particular part of the day.
After determining staff needs, an efficient routine staff schedule can be planned. Two
primary staffing patterns and various combinations of these two have been operative with
large groups. The first style is modelled after industrial staffing patterns where three
eight-hour shifts follow each other consecutively throughout the day. This style works
exceptionally well for groups of SPD persons who need constant or frequently unscheduled
attendant care.
State of the Art / Frieden / 7
The other primary group staffing pattern is more efficient with smaller and less severely
disabled groups. This style provides a personal aide for each resident every morning and
evening to assist him with dressing, undressing, and bathing. In this arrangement the entire
group shares a full time or live-in attendant for incidental and emergency care.
Attendant managers should always be aware of and take steps to accommodate special
non-routine activities which may affect group needs (i.e., recreational events, holidays, etc.).
Life support systems become overloaded when the demand for services exceeds the available
supply. Since the demand for life support services cannot usually be stifled, the only
solutions to system overload are to increase the number of attendants on duty or improve
the proficiency of the existing staff.
Table II
Determining Staff Needs
Amount of time over which dressing
activities may be distributed.
1 hr.
2 hr.
3 hr.
4 hr.
Amount of time required to
30 min.
2
4
6
8
assist each resident in dressing.
1 hr.
1
2
3
4
Number of residents cared for
by one attendant.
TOTAL NUMBER OF RESIDENTS IN GROUP
NUMBER OF RESIDENTS CARED FOR
= NUMBER OF ATTENDANTS
BY ONE ATTENDANT
NEEDED (round up)
When staff shortages occur, standby attendants must be called upon. The best way to
maintain an efficient routine system and still be able to accommodate system overloads
quickly is to keep a long list of dependable standby attendants on call.
Administrative affairs of ILA's include the payment of bills and staff salaries. These
functions should be handled expeditiously. Management duties in group ILA's may include
resident selection and discipline. Resident selection is vital to the integrity of some groups.
Applicants are screened by interview and questionnaire, and admitted on the basis of
group-determined criteria. Group dynamics often dictate the use of authority to maintain
order and stability. This authority logically falls to the management or leader figures in the
group.
Transportation is sometimes considered a problem independently of living arrangements.
However, the systems approach leads one to consider both problems in a broader related
context. A SPD person may find an ILA which requires no more transportation than that of
a wheelchair. If the SPD person has needs which must be satisfied outside of his immediate
environment, then he must arrange for a more sophisticated means of transportation.
State of the Art / Frieden / 8
Depending upon the extent of his needs, he may be able to utilize public transportation,
private jitney service, or his own private vehicle.
Groups may be able to provide themselves with transportation service by sharing vehicles
and drivers. These arrangements are usually very efficient, but they require coordination
much the same as group attendant management.
Food preparation is also a basic unit of the life support system in an ILA. Meals may be
obtained at restaurants or cafeterias. Food may be brought in by attendants or friends. The
SPD person may have someone assist him with meal preparation at home. Common dining
facilities are popular and efficient with groups.
Many different physical structures and life support services may be combined to make an
ILA. An ILA may exist in a nursing home, a family residence, a dormitory, a public housing
project, a group home, or any other residential setting. Attendant work may be done by a
visiting nurse, a nursing home aide, a neighbor, a student, a friend, a family member, or any
other assistant. Transportation may be via a wheelchair, a public bus, a private automobile,
or any other accessible vehicle. Food may be prepared in a cafeteria, a restaurant, a home,
or any kitchen.
Examples
Several types of ILA have been created and tested by SPD persons. A variety of these
exist in Houston today. Independent Lifestyles is located in a large accessible apartment
complex. Each of the thirty residents is responsible for his own apartment. Physical
assistance is provided by a staff of attendants who are supervised by a resident manager.
Scheduling of physical activities is utilized extensively to avoid system inefficiencies. The
nonprofit corporation which provides service to the residents owns a van and employs a
driver. Transportation is provided on a first-come priority basis. Meal preparation is the
responsibility of the resident, although attendants are generally available to assist in this
task. Services are contracted on a monthly basis and charges vary depending on the amount
of services needed. Monthly fees usually range from $500 to $600 including apartment rent.
Some residents receive service subsidies from the state Division of Vocational Rehabilitation
although most residents support themselves entirely. Independent Lifestyles has a Board of
Directors made up of elected resident representatives who advise the resident manager on
critical issues.
Spring Tree is a medium-sized apartment complex which has been remodelled to be
wheelchair accessible. Twenty-four SPD persons live near each other in the complex and
share attendants. An attendant manager schedules the twelve person staff. Routine care
activities are scheduled by the residents. Attendants assist the residents with all aspects of
their physical care. Transportation is provided by a charitable nonprofit corporation on a
priority needs basis. This service is augmented by a private contractor who serves those
residents who qualify for state subsidized transportation. Apartment rent in the complex is
$165 per month. The State Department of Public Welfare pays $208 in staff salaries in
behalf of each resident, all of whom qualify for Homemaker and Chore Services. Each
resident contributes three dollars per month to a fund which is used for parties, gifts, and so
forth. Spring Tree residents voluntarily assist the attendant manager with her duties and
assume full responsibility for their own personal welfare.
State of the Art / Frieden / 9
Free Lives is a cluster of 11 SPD persons who live in the same wing of the 292-unit
Independence Hall, a FHA 236 project for the handicapped and elderly. Each resident has
his own apartment and subscribes to a cooperative attendant service. Routine physical care
activities are scheduled by the residents, and the 12 person staff is managed by a chief
attendant. Cafeteria service is available in the complex, although some residents prefer to
use their own kitchens. Transportation is provided on a prescheduled basis by the apartment
sponsors, Houston Goodwill. Service charges are based on mileage. Apartment rent ranges
from $80-$151 per month, and attendant services are $260. Some residents' services are
subsidized by the state Division of Vocational Rehabilitation and Goodwill. Free Lives has
an elected grievance council and a resident administrator who interact with the attendant
manager and the project management.
Cooperative Living, a more institutional group ILA, is housed in a hospital facility which it
shares with the Texas Institute for Rehabilitation and Research. Twelve SPD persons live
there in separate dormitory-style rooms. The residents manage and share their own
attendant services. In addition to the cafeteria service available in the facility, some residents
have refrigerators and hotplates and prepare food in their rooms. The residents also own and
share a microwave oven. The groups owns a large van and they employ a driver. All
transportation and routine attendant service is scheduled a day ahead of time on a first
come basis. Monthly room fees are $110, attendant services range from $120-$220 per
month, and transportation charges average about $60 per month. All service charges are
based on the amount of service required. Residents receive subsidies from the local housing
authority, the state Division of Vocational Rehabilitation, and Supplemental Security
Income. Cooperative Living has a management council of four elected residents who divide
and share the management responsibilities equally.
Several individuals in Houston have created innovative ILA's for themselves. One SPD
person lives alone in a large apartment unit which has been made accessible. He depends on
neighbors to come in and assist him each morning and evening. He drives himself but must
depend on passers-by to help him load and unload his wheelchair. He pays his friends $2.50
per hour for their assistance and his monthly apartment rent is $185.
This writer, who is SPD, shares a house with two able-bodied individuals. One able-bodied
person provides attendant assistance, while the other drives for the group. Since the
attendant is brain damaged, the SPD person assists him with certain organizational
functions. This cooperation results in a rewarding symbiotic relationship. Both disabled
partners share expenses which amount to about $700 per month.
Comparisons
ILA's may be compared on two fundamental dimensions. These are dwelling type and life
support service style. (See Figure 1.) Dwelling types range from single family dwellings to
dormitories. Life support service styles range from informal arrangements to highly
organized programs. As illustrated in Figure I, those ILA's which involve large groups in
multi-resident dwellings and employ many attendants in an organized program are more
institutionalized than those ILA's which involve a single individual in a single family
dwelling who depends on a neighbor to provide his care.
State of the Art / Frieden / 10
LARGE
*institutional*
Cooperative Living
Independent Lifestyles
Spring Tree
LIFESUPPORT SERVICE
STYLE
Free Lives
INFORMAL
FORMAL
Symbiotic
Relationship
Individual
*non-institutional*
SMALL
DWELLING TYPE
FIG. 1. A two-dimensional analysis of independent living arrangements.
General comparisons of ILA's may be done on the basis of cost-benefit analyses. Table III
illustrates such a comparison. Costs of ILA's may be both material and non-material, while
benefits are mostly non-material. Material costs of ILA's may be relatively low for those
persons who live in multi-resident dwellings and share life support services. On the other
hand, material costs may be relatively high for those persons who choose to live alone and
hire a full-time personal attendant, or those who live in more institutionalized settings.
Non-material costs include frustration caused by waiting and compromising, insecurity
caused by undependable attendant services, or uncertainty about arrangements, and
boredom resulting from routinization and segregation. Some non-material costs, like
frustration and boredom, may be higher in more institutionalized settings; while other
non-material costs, like insecurity, may be higher in less institutionalized arrangements.
Non-material benefits are high in any ILA. The independence one maintains in such an
arrangement is invaluable.
Pragmatic Issues
Several pragmatic issues should be considered with respect to planning and implementing
ILA's. Funding is always an important issue. Just as an ILA may be created by combining a
physical facility with various life support system resources, so may the required funding be
obtained from the combination of a variety of resources. In addition to what the individual
may contribute himself, funds may be obtained from both public and private agencies.
Federal, state, and private rehabilitation agencies, public welfare departments, Social
Security offices, local housing authorities, community development offices, and charitable
foundations should all be considered possible contributors to ILA's. Group ILA's which are
subsidized or sponsored by established agencies are obviously more stable than those which
are not.
State of the Art / Frieden / 11
Table III
A Cost-Benefit Comparison
Material
(Possible)
Non-Material
costs
costs
benefits
Independent Lifestyles
$550
frustration
independence
Spring Tree
$430
frustration
independence
Free Lives
$500
frustration
security
independence
Cooperative Living
$400
boredom
security
frustration
independence
Individual
$550
insecurity
privacy
independence
Symbiotic Relationship
$350
insecurity
integration
independence
Note: Cost figures are approximate and do not include personal needs.
Accountability is also crucial. It is important for the SPD person to realize that if he
depends on a third party to provide him with attendant service, he should hold that party
accountable when the contracted service is unsatisfactory. It is his responsibility to
communicate with his providers so that they will know when service is not satisfactory.
Attendant care may be indispensable for SPD persons, but no specific attendant or service
arrangement is indispensable. The ultimate accountability and responsibility for an ILA rests
with the individual resident.
Social relationships are critical to the success of ILA's. The interpersonal relationship
between a SPD person and his attendant is paramount. Good relationships are founded on
consideration. These relationships may be balanced with friendship and kindness in addition
to financial compensation. The relationship may become strained if the SPD person's
physical needs are not well met. In this case, it may be beneficial for the SPD individual to
be more assertive and authoritarian. The SPD person should never be afraid to seek a new
attendant when one demands too much or gives too little.
Resident-to-resident relationships are vital in group ILA's. Residents must assume a more
businesslike or formal attitude toward their living arrangement when services are shared. For
the program to function smoothly, they must cooperate with each other and respect each
other's needs. Schedules and rules must be followed closely by everyone to avoid imposing
on other participants in the system.
Another important relationship exists between the SPD person in an ILA and his
community. Persons who plan and live in ILA's should be considerate of public opinions
and attitudes toward their arrangements. Good public relations can be maintained without
sacrificing self-respect or personal values. SPD persons can be "good neighbors" by taking
State of the Art / Frieden / 12
part in community affairs and by respecting the viewpoints and privacy of others.
The concept of ILA's is based on a systems approach which presupposes an integrated
society. In this society, SPD persons have a responsibility to maintain their independence
and contribute to the general public welfare. Society has the responsibility of giving the SPD
person the opportunity to create and maintain an ILA. New legislation providing for
subsidized attendant care programs for SPD persons should be written and passed. Existing
legislation which provides housing and transportation privileges for SPD individuals should
be enforced. Innovative housing and social service legislation should be supported by higher
funding levels. Finally, present third party welfare subsidies for SPD persons should be
redirected to the disabled person himself.
It takes hard work to plan and organize all the necessary resources to make an ILA. ILA's
must be maintained by financial support and good management. The main ingredients of an
ILA are a physical structure, a life support system, and an SPD person who has the
imagination and desire to be independent.
Lex Frieden
Texas Institute for Rehabiliation
and Research
133 Moursund Ave.
Houston, Texas 77025
State of the Art / Frieden / 13
References
Brattgard, S. Fokus: A Way of Life for Living. Goteborg, Sweden: Fokus Society, 1971.
California Department of Public Health. Residential Care Needs: Handicapped Persons Pilot Project.
Berkeley, Calif.: State of California Department of Public Health, 1969.
Columbus, D. & Fogel, M. Housing for the disabled II: Characteristics of those willing to move to specially
designed facilities. Perceptual and Motor Skills, 1971, 32, 212-214.
Fay, F. Housing alternatives for individuals with spinal cord injury. In M. Fuhrer (Ed.), Selected Research
Topics in Spinal Cord Injury Rehabilitation. Houston: Rehabilitation Services Administration,
USDHEW, 1975.
Fenton, J. Residential Needs of Severely Handicapped Children and Young Adults in New York State. New
York: Institute of Rehabilitation Medicine, NYU Medical Center, 1972.
Fishman, P. Adaptive Housing for the Handicapped. Boston: Tufts-New England Medical Center, 1971.
Kliment, S. Into the Mainstream: A Syllabus for a Barrier Free Environment. Washington: American
Institute of Architects, 1975.
Kugel, R. & Wolfensberger, W. Changing Patterns in Residential Services for the Mentally Retarded.
Washington: President's Committee on Mental Retardation, 1969.
LaPierre, R. Discussant. In E. Lavine (Ed.), Proceedings of National Conference on Housing and the
Handicapped. Bethesda, Maryland: Health and Education Resources, 1974.
Lassen P. Barrier Free Design: A Selected Bibliography. Garden City, Mich.: Paralyzed Veterans of
America, 1973.
Laurie, G., Laurie, J. & McGwinn, D. Housing and Home Services for the Disabled, Elderly, and Mentally
Retarded. New York: Harper and Row, in press.
Laurie, G. Housing and home services for the disabled in the U.S. Rehabilitation Gazette, 1973, 16, 38-45.
Melia, R. Special Services in Housing for Handicapped Persons. Washington: Rehabilitation Services
Administration, USDHEW, 1974.
Michel, P. Report of the Specialized Housing for the Handicapped Project. Boston: Massachusetts
Department of Community Affairs, 1972.
Noakes, E. What is the problem? Whose problem is it? How widespread is it? In E. Lavine (Ed.),
Proceedings of National Conference on Housing and the Handicapped. Bethesda, Maryland: Health
and Education Resources, 1974.
Roos, P. Normalization: Implications for developing a national program. In E. Lavine (Ed.), Proceedings of
National Conference on Housing and the Handicapped. Bethesday, Maryland: Health and Education
Resources, 1974.
Stock, D. & Cole, J. Adaptive housing for the severely physically handicapped. Rehabilitation Counseling
Bulletin, 1975, June, 224-231.
Urie, R. Student Aides for Handicapped College Students. Laurinburg, N.C.: Social and Rehabilitation
Service, USDHEW, 1971.
Weinrich, E. Discussant. In E. Lavine (Ed.), Proceedings of National Conference on Housing and the
Handicapped. Bethesda, Maryland: Health and Education Resources, 1974.
Willems, E. Place and motivation: Complexity and independence in patient behavior. In W. Mitchell (Ed.),
Environmental Design: Research and Practice. Los Angeles: University of California at Los Angeles,
1972.
Willems, E. & Campbell, D. Behavioral ecology: A new approach to health status and health care. In
B. Honikman (Ed.), Responding to Social Change. Stroudsburg, Pa.: Dowden, Hutchinson and Ross,
in press.
TRANSPORTATION FOR THE MOBILITY HANDICAPPED
Thomas C. O'Brien
Introductory Statement
The characteristics of persons with physical handicaps, and those persons whose mobility,
flexibility, and coordination are significantly reduced by aging, together with characteristics
of the transportation system and process, make travel by the handicapped and elderly very
difficult-often impossible. In a society where transportation is an integral link to all goods
and services required for a full life, most handicapped and elderly persons have only limited
access to jobs, medical services, shopping, recreation, and other community-based activities.
Despite this enormous need, the federal government, the transportation providers and
equipment manufacturers have provided only token response to the near total lack of viable
transportation alternatives for the handicapped and elderly.
Five years ago the U.S. Department of Transportation stated that it was national policy that
the elderly and handicapped have the same right as other persons to utilize mass
transportation. Today we are witnessing the implementation of the latest in a series of token
responses to the "right to use" policy-off peak/half fare programs for the handicapped. A
chart of relevant legislation appears on the following page.
Background
Sensitivity to the mobility problems of the elderly and handicapped has increased in the
past few years. As recently as 1970 the chairperson of the jointly sponsored HEW/DOT
conference on Transportation and Aging stated:
this [conference] is the first systematic effort to accumulate a body of information on
mobility
Since the pioneering work on the mobility of the elderly, performed by Frances Carp in the
late 60's, a significant effort has been developed towards analyzing the problems of
handicapped and elderly. These studies have shown that the physical and, in some cases,
psychological problems of the elderly and handicapped, together with the characteristics of
the transportation system and the transportation process make it difficult, if not impossible,
for most handicapped and elderly to use public transportation facilities.
Since the Biaggi Amendment, which also dictated that transit funds be utilized to finance
transportation programs for the elderly and handicapped, there has been little done to
address the problem of mobility. There have been studies but the results. of most of these
studies merely adorn the shelves of libraries and the results and recommendations are
seldom implemented. The funding mechanism of the Biaggi Amendment was merely
1
State of the Art / O'Brien / 2
optional and few states made any attempt to take advantage of the funding possibilities.
A later amendment to the UMTA act, the so-called Abzug amendment (Section 16 b 2)
provides that grants and loans may be made to private, non-profit organizations to assist
them in providing transportation services for the elderly and handicapped. This latest
demonstration of a contrived impression of concern is the best example of false rhetoric.
Many organizations of, by and for the handicapped have been created in recent years.
Similarly, numerous Golden Age and Senior Citizen groups have been started and continue
to exist on limited funding, at best. Yet, the 16 b 2 program requires these groups to pay for
20% of the capital costs of the program and 100% of the operating costs. There are no
provisions for continuity.
The Federal Highway Act of 1973 offered a stronger statement regarding the elderly and
handicapped:
The Secretary of Transportation shall assure that projects receiving Federal Financial
Assistance
under Section 147 of the Federal Highway Act of 1973 shall be planned
and designed so that mass transportation facilities can effectively be used by elderly
and handicapped persons who by reason of age, injury, illness, congenital malfunction
or other permanent or temporary incapacity or disability are unable without special
planning or design to utilize such facilities and services as effectively as persons not so
affected.
This regulation affects only those projects funded by FHWA funds and not the majority of
mass transit projects which are funded by UMTA.
The first law which contains a strong provision concerning transportation of the elderly and
handicapped was the National Mass Transportation Assistance Act of 1974. Systems
receiving assistance under Section 5 of this act (which provides operating assistance) are
required to offer half fares to the elderly and handicapped during off-peak hours. At the
same time that the Federal government is spending money on rehabilitation programs to put
handicapped persons back to work, it institutes a program designed to save on
transportation cost excluding the hours that most people travel to and from work.
However, Federal regulations are being proposed that may have the greatest impact on
shaping transportation policy for the elderly and handicapped. The proposed UMTA
regulations require that, effective October 1975, all transportation improvement programs
and long range plans contain a definite plan for meeting the transportation needs of the
elderly and handicapped.
Further, S 662, recently approved by the Senate Banking Committee, would require that
new vehicles, station buildings, and other structures for any new or expanded rapid rail
system meet accessibility standards. New buses would also be required to meet such
standards "with such reasonable exceptions from accessibility standards as the Secretary
may deem required by the nature of the vehicle, its proposed use, or the commercial
availability of reliable equipment to facilitate accessibility." It is blatantly obvious that with
such broad exceptions and the use of words such as "reasonable," there is little commitment
to the policy statement that appeared in 1970.
State of the Art / O'Brien / 3
Placing the blame totally on the Federal government is, however, not entirely fair. In 1961
the American National Standards Institute, Inc. (ANSI) published its "Specifications for
Making Buildings and Facilities Accessible To and Usable By, the Physically Handicapped."
The development of these standards, known as ANSI Standards 1.17.1, was sponsored by the
President's Committee on Employment of the Handicapped and the National Easter Seal
Society. These standards have been the underlying basis of most accessibility legislation and
regulations for the handicapped which are currently law. I would like to point out the fact
that the handicapped, as well as organizations of the handicapped, have failed to recognize
the standard ANSI 117.1 as a useful tool to accomplish the task of insuring accessible
facilities. Worse, is the fact that Public Law 90-480, passed in 1968, has been virtually
ignored by the handicapped community as another tool, or in this case, a weapon to fight
the unthinking or mindless builders and architects who continue to emulate the pyramids.
It is important to note that 90-480 is typical of numerous bills that are vague, contain no
compliance and/or monitoring provisions and are as a result, permissive. Following 90-480
a series of other major barrier-free acts became law. One of the objectives of the
Rehabilitation Act of 1973 (PL 92-112) was to make up for a lack of any strong
enforcement mechanism in 90-480. Section 502 of the V.R. Act establishes an
Architectural Barriers and Transportation Barriers Compliance Board. This board, the
authority of which is enhanced by the amendments contained in P.L. 93-516 (passed in
1974), has the power to "conduct investigations, hold public hearings, and issue such orders
as it deems necessary to ensure compliance" with the provisions of P.L. 90-480. The
sincerity of the Federal government must be questioned again when one considers that it
was mid-summer of 1975 before the new "Compliance Board" was staffed.
While the Federal policy towards transportation has been slowly evolving, a concerted effort
to hasten action has been initiated by community groups in dozens of communities across
the nation. Many legal actions have been filed and legislative actions taken in many states
and ordinances and other acts at the local level.
The major battles are being planned now and we must utilize all the available resources.
Most of all we need a unified position. Not necessarily a single viewpoint-but a well defined
stand. The differences of opinion between the handicapped consumers must be presented as
a mix of needed services and not the inability of those in need to agree on what they want
or need. A recent editorial published in the American Public Transit Association Journal
(August '75), entitled "Elderly and Handicapped: A Diversity of Opinion" states: "What we
seem to be faced with is the lack of any real consensus as to what the requirements of the
elderly and handicapped are Also, the editorial tries to undermine the similarity of
problems faced by the elderly and handicapped by claiming that: "Clearly, in a great many
cases, the transit needs of the elderly are not the same as the handicapped." An article in the
May '75 issue of the Journal entitled "Mobility for the Elderly and the Handicapped: A
Case for Choices," cites the difference between "MOBILITY" and "ACCESSIBILITY." In
other words the transportation industry refers to the problem as the difference between
"door to door" service, usually provided by van-type vehicles, and fixed-route service which
traditionally provided by transit-style vehicles. Which is best? Both types? How much of
each? What is the next step?
State of the Art / O'Brien / 4
Before presenting possible solutions to this problem or, to be more precise, strategies and/or
actions to be undertaken, it is important to note that there are three major questions which
must be answered:
1. Who are the Transportation Handicapped?
2. Which of their transit needs are not being met?
3. How can those needs be satisfied?
The answers to these basic questions must be answered by the handicapped themselves. How
often are programs designed for the disabled or, for that matter, any group with special
needs, and the group in question is not part of the process by which the solutions or results
are determined? A number of studies are aimed at getting answers to these and other
questions but how effective are the results? Further research is being conducted on the
national level to determine the numbers of persons affected-the type of disability and the
transportation dysfunction. How meaningful the results will be is itself an unanswered
question. However, I submit that demonstration projects that provide hardware and
operational experiences are more meaningful and productive than surveys and question-
naires.
As early as December 1973 the National Technical Information Service, U.S. Department of
Commerce, issued "A Bibliography with Abstracts" entitled Transportation for the Elderly
or Physically Handicapped.
The emergence of the American Coalition of Citizens with Disabilities (ACCD) as a viable
consumer organization is most encouraging. I am privileged to function as Chairman of the
ACCD Transportation Committee and endorse the ACCD position which contends that full
access to all public transportation is necessary. This position does not, of course, eliminate
or even diminish the need for demand responsive or dial-a-ride systems to serve the
handicapped when appropriate.
Two organizations have also recently emerged that will undoubtedly assist the handicapped
and elderly achieve the goal of accessible public transportation: The Public Interest Law
Center of Philadelphia (Pilcop, James J. Raggio, Atty., 1315 Walnut St. 16th Floor,
Philadelphia, Penn. 19107) and The National Center for Law and the Handicapped, Inc.
(Harvey A. Bender, Exec. Director, 1235 North Eddy, South Bend, Indiana 46617).
Three other resources for information are:
1. The National Center for a Barrier Free Environment
Attn: Edward J. Leonard
8401 Connecticut Ave.
Washington, D.C. 20015
President's Commission on the Handicapped
Washington, D.C. 20210
(202-653-5079)
State of the Art / O'Brien / 5
2. Architectural and Transportation Barriers Compliance Board
James Jeffers or Peter Lassen (202-245-1803)
Room 1004
Mary E. Switzer Building
330 C Street, S.W.
Washington, D.C. 20201
3. Office for Handicapped Individuals
Frances Lauder (202-245-0449)
To coordinate with ACCD contact me, Thomas O'Brien, 15 Wellesley Rd., Danvers, Mass.
01923.
Conclusion
A single recommendation, I feel, is appropriate at the present time. Those with a mobility
problem must establish a meaningful dialogue for the purpose of establishing a position on
their transportation needs. The product of the discussions must include a strategy for
implementing programs that will meet their needs.
Thomas C. O'Brien
1975 Chairman, Transportation
American Coalition of Citizens with Disabilities
115 Wellesley Rd.
Danvers, Mass. 01923
State of the Art / O'Brien / 6
Major Funding Sources for Transportation Services
For the Elderly & Handicapped
Level of Government
Department and
Specific Title Numbers
Statute Title
If Relevant
I. Federal Sources
A. Department of Health, Education
and Welfare
1. Older American's Act
III, IV, VII, IX
2. Public Health Service
III, XII
3. Social Security Act
VI, XIX, XX
4. Mental Retardation Facilities
Construction Act
II
5. Vocation Rehabilitation Act
-
6. Higher Education Act
I
7. Library Service & Construction Act
I
B.
Department of Transportation
1. Urban Mass Transportation Act
Sections 3, 5, 6, 9, 16(b)(2)
2. Federal Aid Highway Act
Transfers from Interstate
C.
Department of Labor: Comprehensive
Employment & Training Act
III
D. Office of Economic Opportunity:
Economic Opportunity Act
III, esp. Sect. 222
E.
Veteran's Administration: Veteran's
Health Care Expansion Act
I
F. ACTION: Domestic Volunteer Service Act
II
G. Revenue Sharing: State & Local Fiscal
Assistance Act
I
State of the Art / O'Brien / 7
MAJOR FUNDING SOURCES cont.
Level of Government
Specific Title Numbers
II. State and Local Sources (Illustrative Only)
A. Special Taxes
-
B.
Special Funds
-
C.
Bond Issues
-
D.
Tax Relief
-
E. Lottery
-
F.
Transit Districts
-
III. Private Sources (Illustrative Only)
A. Muscular Dystrophy
-
B. American Cancer Society
-
C. American Red Cross
-
D. United Cerebral Palsy
-
E.
Easter Seal Society
-
F.
Local Religious Groups
-
Source:
Joseph S. Revis, Institute of Public Administration, Transportation for Older
Americans, Final Report, Tables V-1, V-2, and V-3, April 1975.
State of the Art / O'Brien / 8
Bibliography
"Elderly and Handicapped: A Diversity of Opinion," editorial, American Public Transit Journal, August
1975
Suanne Brooks, "Mobility for the Elderly and Handicapped," American Public Transit Journal, May 1975.
James J. Raggio, "Coalition Building and Direct Advocacy," The Public Interest Law Center of
Philadelphia, 1315 Walnut St., Phila., Pa. 19107
Statement by Senator Harrison Williams, Congressional Records, Vol. 1.121, No. 19, Feb. 11, 1975,
Washington, D.C.
Senator Harrison Williams, "Opening Statement," Hearings by Subcommittee on Housing and Urban Affairs
on S.662, National Mass Transportation Assistance Act Amendments of 1975, June 17, 1975.
"Transportation for the Elderly or Physically Handicapped, A Bibliography with Abstracts," National
Technical Information Service, U.S. Department of Commerce, Dec. 1973. COM-74-10887
"Consumer Leadership Conference," Massachusetts Council of Organizations of the Handicapped, Inc. in
Collaboration with Tufts Rehabilitation Research and Training Center, April 1975; published by
Cerebral Palsy Center of Metropolitan Boston, Newton, Mass.
Harold S. Remmes, "A Consumer's Guide to Organizing the Handicapped," Massachusetts Council of
Organizations of the Handicapped, Inc. 41 Woodglen Rd., Hyde Park, Mass. 02136
Linda L. Mandel, "Transportation for the Handicapped-An Equal Opportunity to Travel, Metropolitan
Magazine, May/June 1975.
Legislation
Public Law 90-480
Architectural Barriers Act of 1968
Public Law 91-453
Urban Mass Transportation Act of 1964;
Section 16 (Biaggi Amendment);
Section 16(b)(2) (Abzug Amendment)
Public Law 93-87
Federal Aid Highway Act of 1973
Public Law 92-112
Rehabilitation Act of 1973
Public Law 93-516
Public Law 93-503
National Transportation Assistance Act of 1974
Proposed UMTA Rule 609.11
Senate Bill 662
MEDICAL ASPECTS OF DISABILITY WITH A VIEW TO INDEPENDENT LIVING
Sheldon Berrol, M.D.
Edna Brean, R.N.
Introduction
Great strides are presently being made in the acute management of the severely disabled
patient as a result of the development of regional centers for treatment of catastrophic
illness. Unfortunately, the level of long term medical management has not as yet kept pace
with this progress, due in no small part to the attitude of governmental and insurance
organizations which are apparently only now on the verge of recognizing that adequate
health maintenance can be equated with fiscal responsibility.
The team approach to the severely disabled involves not only the medical community and
its recognized paramedical specialists, but also the rehabilitation counselor, the peer
counselor, and when necessary the consumer advocate. The goal of this concerted effort
should ultimately be independent living. In this context, independent living is more than
living at home or in a sheltered workshop. It encompasses an active participation in the
social process, being a head of household, and finding meaningful work which may or may
not be remunerative. The role of health maintenance in this process revolves around
freedom from egocentric body needs. This can only be achieved by indoctrinating sound
principles of preventive health care in the daily routines of the disabled.
Our intent here is not to provide a detailed description of basic rehabilitation programs, but
rather a brief overview of issues that interfere with the maintenance of an independent life
style. We have essentially avoided surgical approaches to problems, except for a few selective
instances. Some of our approaches may be controversial, but they represent the summation
of successful experiences.
Routine Health Maintenance
The decrease in mortality rate among the severely neurologically disabled appears to parallel
the adequate medical follow-up, the hallmark of which remains the annual physical exam.
Most patients who live within reasonable geographic proximity of the rehabilitation center
can generally have their evaluation performed as an outpatient. The patient who lives at
some distance can usually have the full evaluation accomplished within two to three days.
A reasonably comprehensive evaluation should include intravenouspyelography. (or a renal
scan in the case of dye sensitivity) CBC, panel chemistries (which include a BUN), and
serum creatinine. Pulmonary function studies should be included in quadriplegics, or when
involvement of the thoracic musculature is present to any significant degree. In children
with SCI, polio, myelomenigocele, muscular dystrophy, etc., evaluation of the spine for
progressive scoliosis must be performed, and after capping of the iliac crests, on an elective
basis. Urine cultures and sensitivities should be performed annually, but the method of
obtaining the specimen should preferably be by Suprapubic Aspirate. If this cannot be
accomplished, direct catheterization would be the next most reliable method. In no instance
would obtaining a specimen from the indwelling catheter, or from a bad leg bag be
1
State of the Art / Berrol & Brean / 2
acceptable. If a change in residual capacity, or in bladder spasticity is suspected by history, a
cystometrogram or air cystometry should be performed.
A full physical examination including a re-evaluation of neurologic function and disability
must be performed, and establishment of potentially new rehabilitation goals considered
annually.
Bladder
The most significant advance in the care of the urinary tract in patients with a neurogenic
bladder has been the introduction of the intermittent catheterization program. If the patient
has been fortunate enough to have had the program instituted early in the acute
rehabilitation phase, then his urine may remain consistently sterile. Even if the injury or
disease process has been longstanding, the success rate in preventing urinary tract
complications is outstanding. An adequate evaluation of bladder function, i.e., the type of
neurogenic bladder, must be done in order to properly determine the need for concomitant
drug therapy. In the case of the small, spastic bladder, banthine is frequently of value in
relaxation of the detrusor muscle of the bladder. In the flaccid bladder, bethanechol will
increase bladder tone and produce more effective emptying.
The Crede procedure should be taught the patient with the Lower Motor Neuron bladder,
and reflex stimulating procedures to the patient with an Upper Motor Neuron bladder.
Careful attention should be directed to bladder residuals with a maximum of 20% for UMN
bladders and 10% for LMN bladders.
Tidal drainage is mentioned as a procedure to be avoided,
In patients with high outflow resistance, a sphincterotomy is a simple procedure which
usually results in elimination of the catheter. The male patient with an indwelling catheter is
an anachronism at this point in time, with the exception of its temporary use in the case of
ureteral reflux.
The female patient with her short urethra is, however, frequently treated by indwelling
catheter. "Padding up" may be an acceptable technique for a small minority of women and
is not without hazard to skin. The selective use of the artificial spincter in appropriate cases
appears to be a major advance in bladder control.
Overdistention of the bladder must be avoided. Prophylactic antibiotic therapy appears to
be an unwarranted approach in the avoidance of urinary tract infection. Recent studies
suggest that the upper urinary tract is resistant to pseudomonas and, in the absence of
symptoms, treatment on the basis of cultures alone is not necessary. Monitoring of pH of
the urine should be taught to the patient and attendant, and appropriate acidification
accomplished by dietary intake or supplemental ascorbic acid.
One must remain constantly alert to the possibility of bladder neoplasm, the incidence of
which is significantly higher in the patient with the indwelling catheter.
State of the Art / Berrol & Brean / 3
Spasticity
The presence of spasticity is not an indication for its control. The patient with upper motor
neuron spasticity should be adequately evaluated to determine if his functional capabilities
could indeed be increased by proper utilization of spasticity.
Spasticity usually represents a loss of cortical inhibition, which may be modified by several
modalities with varying success. In the physical therapy gym, local application of ice usually
decreased spasticity long enough to range a joint, but results are rarely effective beyond two
weeks. Acupuncture has achieved a degree of folk popularity, but clear-cut clinical trials in
spasticity as yet are not available.
Conservative treatment remains the pharmacologic approach. Diazepam has for many years
been the mainstay of drug control, but not without hazard. A frequent problem is the
accompanying lethargy and altered reaction time by virtue of its central nervous system
effects. It maintains a distinct addictive capability and may induce withdrawal seizure
activity. Therefore any patient who has been on Diazepam, particularly in large doses,
should be gradually tapered whenever the drug is withdrawn.
Dantrolene has been a major advance in drug control of spasticity in that the primary site of
action is in the effector organ-the muscle fiber. It too must be carefully administered, with
the dose slowly increased to maximum effect in order to minimize sedation and gastro-
intestinal effects. Liver function studies must be closely monitored, for toxic effects are not
uncommonly encountered.
The class of drugs generally considered "muscle relaxants" are essentially valueless in upper
motor neuron spasticity.
Motor point blocks with phenol or alcohol can be most effective when spasticity can be
isolated to a few major muscle groups.
Ablative surgical procedures for spasticity will not be considered here.
Contraception
The sexual revolution has created a new wave of societal mores and with it has evolved an
awareness that the disabled are sexual beings. The psychological aspects of sexuality will not
be discussed, but in considering medical management, concern must be expressed for
effective birth control methods.
The severely disabled male may continue to use pre-morbid forms of birth control (if
disability is due to injury) such as condoms (which may be an advantage if leakage of urine
occurs) or continue to rely on his partner. The vasectomy is a simple and effective method
of contraception that has gained a great deal of apparently well deserved attention and is
applicable to most disabled men.
The woman appears to have greater problems. If the disability confines her to a wheelchair,
then a sizable amount of venous stasis will occur in the lower extremities. If she does not
have a regular routine of standing, be it a standing frame, braces, etc., then the incidence of
State of the Art / Berrol & Brean / 4
acute inflammation of veins of the leg may be increased if she uses oral contraceptive
hormones. We know of no studies that take into consideration pre-existing venous stasis and
its relation to thrombophlebitis when taking oral contraceptives. The IUD (intra-uterine
device) may be preferable in selected cases of disabled women. A great deal of mythology
has evolved regarding this device, and there have been some serious problems. There appears
to be no greater danger of uterine perforation in disabled women. Indeed, such serious side
effects are markedly decreased when insertion is accomplished by proficient physicians. The
device may be expelled by the uterus and many women cannot use the device because of
dysmenorrhea or menorrhagia. Where a monogamous relationship exists with a desire to
avoid progeny, the male partner should consider vasectomy.
There is no one single method that is most desirable. The basic desirability and functional
status of the individual must be considered in selecting an appropriate safe method of
contraception.
Pregnancy
Some degree of controversy has existed in rehabilitation centers regarding the most
appropriate site for delivery of the neurologically disordered woman. There is no question
that adequate and comprehensive obstetrical care can be delivered in the general hospital
setting, provided consideration of the special needs of the patient are met. Far too many of
these women, whether SCI, polio, or myelomeningocele, are offered caesarian section rather
than vaginal delivery because of unnecessary anxiety on the part of the obstetrician. The
indications for surgical approaches are the same as for able bodied women.
A major concern must be in the prevention of pressure sores during delivery. The pain
insensitive woman must not remain in the lithotomy position for periods longer than two
hours. Indeed, she should not be brought to the obstetrical amphitheater until delivery is
imminent in order to avoid prolonged and unnecessary pressures over boney prominences.
Stirrup cuffs should also be sufficiently loose so as to avoid excessive pressure. A 2" foam
pillow (or perferably gel) should be placed under the buttocks.
As with the able bodied woman, anesthesia should be held to a minimum, but the pain
insensitive patient may be fortunate enough to be able to avoid any anesthetic.
Autonomic dysreflexia has occasionally been reported during delivery, and continual
observation is essential. Close monitoring of bladder and bowel must be maintained.
If excessive spasticity is a problem, Diazepam may be administered I.V., keeping in mind its
potential depressant effects on the fetus.
The mother and child should not be denied the pleasures and advantages inherent in breast
feeding merely because of the mother's disability. Moreover, the convenience of breast
feeding for the mother should not be underestimated when compared to the burdensome
aspects of preparing sterile formula.
Pulmonary Problems
Sleeping problems are frequently encountered in patients with pulmonary insufficiency
secondary to neuromuscular disorders. The administration of sedatives or soporifics
State of the Art / Berrol & Brean / 5
compounds the problem by further depressing respiration. Frequent evaluation of pul-
monary function has been mentioned, but must be emphasized at this point. Significant
abnormalities should signal the need for blood gas studies. All patients with decreased
pulmonary function and their attendants, and family should be taught postural drainage,
chest mobilization techniques and the essentials of good bronchial toilet. Breathing exercises
should be taught at the rehabilitation center, and daily use encouraged by professionals
involved in long-term management. Those patients who are high quadriplegics should learn
glossopharyngeal breathing. In the presence of upper respiratory infections, antibiotics
should be utilized when necessary, and all measures for reducing the viscosity of sputum
should be encouraged early such as increasing fluid intake and the adequate use of
expectorants. Steam inhalation is frequently of value. Antihistamines which may thicken
secretions should be avoided in pulmonary problems.
Fractures
The osteoporosis which results from the loss of axial loading and resultant loss of stresses of
muscle pull predispose the neurologically deprived patient to long bone fractures. An
adequate maintenance program should reasonably include some method of obtaining an
upright position to retard this process. The concept of weight bearing must be appreciated
for its beneficial effect on calcium metabolism, urinary drainage, bowel function, prevention
of bladder calculi, prevention of circulatory stasis, and maintenance of muscle tone.
Treatment of long bone fractures must be approached conservatively. Osteomyelitis is a
major hazard to open repair. Bracing is generally not advisable in lesions above T-10.
Mobilization should be delayed until adequate healing is demonstrated radiographically. If
ambulation is not a factor, nonunion may be tolerated.
In fractures of the lower extremities, positioning should be maintained by pillow splints,
and casts avoided. If a cast must be applied, then it should be bivalved to avoid excessive
pressure, and carefully observed during the period of immobilization.
The possibility of spontaneous fracture must be kept in mind in patients with extensor
spasticity.
Heterotopic ossification may occur as early as 1 month or as late as 12 months after injury.
It is often confused with acute thrombophlebitis when it occurs unilaterally, and accurate
differential diagnosis must be made to avoid incorrect treatment. It has not uncommonly
been confused with sarcoma when evaluated by x-ray alone. Alkaline phosphatase elevations
precede radiographic findings, and should always be determined serially when heterotopic
ossification is suspected. When severe enough to cause limitation of function, correct timing
for possible surgical intervention should be established using serial radio isotope uptake
ratios. The presence of heterotopic ossification is not a contra-indication for passive range of
motion, but an indication.
Autonomic Dysreflexia
The one true medical emergency in long-term management of the spinal cord injured patient
is autonomic dysreflexia (hyperreflexia). It is found in patients with spinal cord lesions
State of the Art / Berrol & Brean / 6
above the level of the fifth thoracic vertebra. The stimulus may be a distended or spastic
bladder, a stool impacted rectum or a locus of irritation in the skin. This stimulus initiates
reflex activation of the sympathetic and parasympathetic nervous systems, which if not
controlled, can precipitate a cerebral vascular accident and even death.
The patient complains of a pounding headache, nasal stuffiness, sweating of the face, and
"goose bumps." He is excessively apprehensive, and demonstrates a bradycardia in the
presence of a severe hypertension which may reach levels as high as 300/160.
The patient should immediately be placed in an upright position, to facilitate the pooling of
blood by gravity in the lower extremities and abdomen. The bladder should be drained, and
if the catheter is found to be plugged, it is irrigated gently with no more than 30 CC of
solution. The rectum should be checked for a fecal mass. If present, a topical anesthetic
ointment should be instilled to decrease the stimulus, and after symptoms have subsided,
the feces removed. If the blood pressure does not decline immediately, parenteral drug
therapy should be initiated, such as I.V. Diazepam, followed by a ganglionic blocking agent
such as Regitine 5 mg. I.M. if the former is not rapidly effective.
Skin Care
The single most costly complication of the severely disabled remains the pressure sore. The
tendency to legitimize this major effect of negligence by applying the title Decubitus Ulcer
should be discouraged. The patient will be better served to acknowledge (as will the
physician and nurse) that this is indeed a sore resulting from prolonged pressure.
The two major events contributing to its occurrence are prolonged pressure, and sheer forces
that produce excessive friction. Prevention demands frequent relief of pressure, requiring
turning every two hours while in bed. The patient must be indoctrinated with the
importance of elevation in the wheelchair every 20 to 30 minutes. The skin may frequently
be damaged by trauma from friction that occurs during transfers. The current availability of
pre-washed jeans has apparently eliminated the firm abrasive seams that caused problems in
the past. Bedsheets must be kept dry and free of wrinkles.
A host of predisposing factors facilitate the development of pressure sores and general.
measures for their correction should be instituted. The patient's perineal area must be kept
dry and free from maceration. An adequate diet must be maintained, and in the presence of
skin breakdown, the caloric intake should be increased above the normal levels, and
maintained at about 3000 calories a day. Americans generally take vitamins in frighteningly
excessive quantities, and the disabled are no exception, but the case for high doses, (2-3 Gm.
daily) of ascorbic acid appears to have been clearly established in the promotion of healing.
The correction of anemia is a sine qua non in ulcer care.
Any reddened area occurring over a boney prominence that does not blanch with simple
pressure must be considered a pressure sore, even without skin breakdown. The immediate
care demands removal of all pressure, and the assumption of the prone position, alternating
with side lying. Water beds have been much in vogue to reduce pressure. Strong
consideration must be given however, to the loss of independent function incurred by the
physically disabled on this soft bedding. Additionally, the plastic cover may contribute to
undue maceration of skin and further compound the problem. The use of the partially
State of the Art / Berrol & Brean / 7
water-filled air mattress is a far less expensive and more portable means of pressure relief
that enables the patient to utilize leverage for full bed independence. Additionally, the
vertigo frequently encountered with water beds is eliminated.
Local care of the wound demands adequate aeration. This means the total avoidance of any
occlusive medication such as antibiotic ointments, zinc oxide paste, and tincture of benzoin.
The use of the latter as a skin toughener is totally without merit.
A simple but effective regime employs half strength hydrogen peroxide wash, followed by
the application of povidone-iodine solution, every 4 hours. Deep ulcers frequently require
packing with the latter.
The use of karaya powder alone or mixed with povidone-iodine has been of value in infected
ulcers in some institutions, and the use of oral zinc therapy is felt to be of occasional value.
Patients must be motivated by the professionals to avoid the development of pressure sores,
and it is our responsibility to insure that they are fully indoctrinated with these caveats.
Bowel Care
Although the principles of good bowel care and function are acquired and the client was
laxative free before injury, (s)he often has difficulties in this area with the commonest
complaint being slow response to suppository. Increased attention to bulk content of the
diet is helpful with supplementary metamucil as needed. Enemas should be avoided and the
use of glycerine or biscodyl suppositories followed by massage of the abdomen about 20
minutes later in a clockwise direction is beneficial. An attempt should be made to wean the
patient from suppositories. Use of a commode chair is recommended to approximate the
normal flexed or squatting position. The bowel program should take place at regular and
specific hours (generally ½ to 1 hour after a meal to take advantage of the gastrocolic
reflex), every other day or twice weekly. In an upper motor neuron disorder mere
introduction of a gloved, well lubricated finger into the rectum with a circular motion may
set off reflex bowel evacuation as well as reflex bladder emptying. Simple stretching of the
anal sphincter can cause satisfactory peristaltic "rushes" with evacuation in some people.
In the rare instance when an enema becomes necessary, small amounts of fluid should be
used, and the practice of securing the catheter in the rectum by means of an inflated foley
bag should be condemned as intestinal rupture with subsequent serious complications is all
too common, due to the inability of the intestine to expel the balloon in a peristaltic rush.
In an enema, the catheter should only be inserted past the external sphincter and the fluid
held no higher than 18 inches. Because of the need to maintain enema-free bowel balance,
laxatives and enemas should not be ordered before IVPs and only before major surgery.
Diarrhea caused by dietary indiscretions is usually self limiting within 4-6 hours. Useful in
controlling diarrhea are lomotil, or bismuth and paregoric for 2 to 4 doses. Hemorrhoids can
cause bouts of autonomic dysreflexion and should be looked for. Often they can be treated
by anusol suppositories, careful attention to diet, and temporary discontinuance of digital
evacuations. Relief of temporary constipation may be accomplished by increasing the
dosage of stool softeners such as DSS (colace, surfak, softon, etc.) 1-4 capsules daily,
Mondane 1-2 tables 4-8 hours before retiring, and metamucil, 1-2 tablespoons in fruit juice
daily to provide needed bulk quickly. Attention to diet can frequently resolve most minor
bowel problems.
State of the Art / Berrol & Brean / 8
Conclusion
The ongoing medical needs of the disabled in the period starting with discharge from the
rehab facility and tapering off when full and competent involvement and participation in all
life activities is reached can best be met by community based centers which offer diverse
services in a non-medical setting. Those services which may be called "medical" are
concerned with the prevention of illness and hospitalization together with enhancement of
self-confidence, high competency in self-care technics, increase in energy levels, and
continuing education in new and relevant medical advances. The model for this type of
facility is the Center for Independent Living which, among other things, offers a diversity of
necessary services in a warm and welcoming atmosphere. In the socialization process
inherent in such a center, much can be dealt with at low-voltage levels which would
otherwise be ignored or met with later as acute medical problems.
Health care teaching for the disabled should include categories of skin, bladder, bowel,
respiratory, nutrition and obesity, spasticity, emergencies, monitoring vital signs, facts about
supplies and equipment, communicable diseases including poison oak, VD, etc., using
medical facilities and resources effectively, and costs and medical consumerism, among
others. The professionals who work with peer health counselors should keep in mind the
"seeding" effect and the need for propagation of this system in an expanding pattern for
which the peer health counselors will be among the chief agents.
In addition to direct counseling and the establishment of peer health counselors, a system of
teaching and training for non-professionals (attendant, aides, families, etc.) in home nursing
skills and rehab principles should be instituted.
A third goal of such a comprehensive plan should be the establishment of "half-way" houses
based on the Cowell Residence Program but not restricted to U.C. students or other
"affinity" groupings. Such living systems offer maximum exposure to peer training and
positive role models, plus low-key, steady professional input, and should have a specific time
limit on periods of residency in order to have maximum beneficial impact.
Although experience is said to be the best teacher, it is certainly the most expensive and
painful. The ability and opportunity to learn from others and to share one's own first-hand
knowledge is surely as valuable and indeed, worth full inclusion in any on-going rehabili-
tation system. Among others, this concept provides one of the most sturdy underpinnings
for the C.I.L.
Sheldon Berrol, M.D.
Chief, Head Injury Rehabilitation Unit
Santa Clara Valley Medical Center
751 South Bascom
San Jose, Calif.
Edna Brean
Medical Services and Training
Center for Independent Living
THE THREE R's OF DISABLED CONSUMERISM
Daniel A. Poling II
I. Preface
This paper is being written for a two-fold purpose. First, it is being written for a conference
at the Center for Independent Living in Berkeley, California. This conference will be
composed of a select group of professionals and consumers and will discuss the various
problematic aspects of independent living which are confronted by severely disabled people.
Second, it is being written for the American Coalition of Citizens with Disabilities, Inc.
ACCD is a brand new national organization which attempts to include consumers with all
types of disabilities. It is experiencing growing pains and finds itself in need of developing
both a basic code of ethics and a basic philosophy. It is hoped that this document will
provide a foundation for this philosophical endeavor.
II. Introduction: My Philosophical Orientation
In order for you to know where I am coming from in this document, you must have some
understanding of my basic philosophical orientation. I am a trained sociologist and,
furthermore, a sociologist from the Functional School. Therefore, in order to understand
me, you must understand something about Functional Sociology.
Functional Sociology views society as a gigantic system made up of many sub-components,
sub-systems and sub-units. We believe that society is analogous to a human body or any
other living organism. The smallest societal unit is the individual man, woman or child. For a
society to be healthy, each sub-unit must contribute to the welfare of the whole. Hence, a
pluralistic society, such as our own American Society, is one that is diverse, fluid and
flexible. In return, a healthy society is capable of nurturing and developing the potential of
its smallest unit; the individual man, woman and child. Thus, Functionalism implies a
spiraling effect, either of growth or decline. In spiraling growth, all of the societal sub-units
contribute to the whole; in turn, the whole society benefits its smallest sub-unit-namely,
the individual. Conversely, in spiraling decline, the societal sub-units cease to contribute to
the whole; resultantly, the whole is unable to continue to nurture the individual. Therefore,
a society is analogous to a human body or any other organism; the whole is only as healthy
as its smallest parts-namely, its individual cells. As, in the words of John Donne,
1
State of the Art / Poling / 2
Any man's death diminishes me, for I am
involved in mankind
Any imposed restriction on one individual
restricts each of us,
for we are both singularly and collectively
part of mankind.
I also believe in a modified version of Social Darwinism. I believe that both man and his
society-our society-is evolving and not devolving. Within this evolution, there is a
hydraulic process in which changes, improvements, or advances within one segment of
society directly produce all cause, changes, improvements, or advances within another
segment of society. Hence, the disabled minority was literally created by the continued
advance of medical science. It has only been in existence 25 to 50 years. Because the
disabled minority is brand new, it is like a precious gem which is still in the rough; it needs
to be polished, refined and sophisticated.
In addition, even as all other human beings, the disabled individuals have the right to
develop their potential to the maximum. However, before this can be achieved, not only
must society recognize its responsibility to the disabled individual, but, also, the disabled
individual must recognize his or her responsibility to society.
Finally, due to this sociological- orientation, I am in disagreement with the phraseology,
"The Art of Independent Living." In the first place, it is not as an art, but rather, it is a
science-or, to be more precise, it is a behavioral science. True, an essential ingredient of
both art and science is creative imagination; however, that is where the similarity stops.
Every work of art is unique and cannot be reproduced, whereas, a science is governed by
laws and therefore involved explanations, predictions, and ultimate control. Because science
has the potential of controlling a situation, it also has the potential of reproducing the
situation.
In the second place, even as a disabled person does not want to be forced into "dependent"
living, so in reality he or she would not want to be forced into total "independent" living.
For, complete independent living means total isolation and exclusion from society. All
human beings-disabled or non-disabled-must function vis-a-vis society; no man is an island,
no man can stand alone! In order for disabled people to live productive and fulfilled lives,
they must integrate themselves into society in total. Therefore, in this paper I will be
addressing the subject, the behavioral science of interdependent and integrated living of
disabled individuals.
III. The Nomenclature and the Social Evolutionary Process
Language is one of the most effective ways for man to communicate. By studying specific
words and the mental concepts that those words represent, we can gain insight into the
entire evolutionary process that society is undergoing. For example, within the last hundred
years, the black minority has undergone a tremendous transformation and upgrading.
During this process, the words referring to a member of the black minority underwent
corresponding changes. First, the word "slave"; then, it was "nigger"; next, it was "negro";
finally, the word has evolved to "a black human being."
State of the Art / Poling / 3
We can trace the same type of social evolutionary process within the disabled minority by
briefly noting the succession of words that have been used to denote its members. Probably,
the first word to be used was "patient." "Patient" is a derivative of the latin, passion, and
means "the suffering or the enduring of pain, trouble, or evil, with calmness and
compusure." If one reflects upon this definition for a moment, one might stop to ask
oneself how in hell can a human being endure pain, trouble, or evil, while remaining calm
and composed. As I express in my book, To Be Human is to Continually Strive to Better
One's Lot in Life, when one is continually striving, it is absolutely impossible for one to
remain calm and composed. Consequently, there is a basic contradiction within this
definition and the only way to resolve this contradiction is to literally de-humanize the
patient. If a patient is void of all human feelings, then of course he can remain calm and
composed-even in the face of pain, trouble, or being evil.
Clinton Hilliard, who has Cerebral Palsy and who is a specialist in speech pathology, best
summed up this de-humanization in a description of his own birth:
"It" was born, and I say "it" as "it" needed to be differentiated from the usual he or
she that might have been born on March 16, 1927. "It" needs further differentiating as
"it" was blue resulting from the then little known RH factor and "it's" skull was all
distorted due to the use of forceps, both factors contributing to the resulting "it." The
doctors being sure "it" would not survive since "it" could not swallow and hardly
breathe at all, gave "it" little chance for survival. The parents were advised to ignore
"it" and let "it" go back to "it's" maker and this they were advised as late as 11 years
of age, only the methods of termination were changed with age.
The next term to come upon the evolutionary scene was "client." This is the term used by
most providers of rehabilitation services. The word, "client," is a derivative of the Latin,
cliens, meaning follower or one who leans on another for protection. In ancient Rome a
client was a plebian under the patronage of a patrician, in this relation called a patron, who
was bound, in return for certain services, to protect his client's life and interests. Obviously,
this renders the disabled person an extremely dependent posture. The term possesses the
danger of misleading both the disabled person and the service provider into thinking that the
disabled person requires so much protection that he is incapable of making any decisions on
his own.
The latest term to evolve is "consumer." "Consumer" is a derivative of the Latin,
consumare, and means a person who buys goods or services for his own needs and not for
resale. Referring to a person as a consumer automatically places that person vis-a-vis the
producer or the provider. In general, consumerism is the effort to equalize the rights, access
to information, and power of the buyer with those of the seller. "Consumer protection,"
says consumer advocate Bess Myerson, "is economic justice based on moral law."
Thus, by denoting a disabled person as a consumer ipso facto acknowledges that that
individual possesses certain powers and specific rights. Yet, what do we mean when we place
the adjective "disabled" in front of the noun "consumer"? What is a "disabled consumer"?
In a report the Urban Institute defines "disability" in terms of functional limitations.
Therefore, we may assume that a disabled consumer is a person who is seeking to purchase
those goods and services that will improve his functioning within society.
0
State of the Art / Poling / 4
We may further assume that, within the societal market place, a disabled consumer is no
different from any other consumers. A disabled consumer must engage in competitive
transactions. In any transaction there is a quid pro quo flow of social interaction. That is,
just like any other consumer, the disabled person must give something in return. The things
which a disabled person may offer in a social transaction, we may call "his or her
responsibilities." The things which a disabled person may receive in a social transaction, we
may call "his or her rights." Furthermore, a disabled person is free to use his or her creative
imagination in negotiating or bargaining. That is, a disabled person can create new
responsibilities in exchange for receiving new rights. This creative imagination of a disabled
person we will call one's repertoire.
This document, then, is about the rights, the responsibilities and the repertoire of
consumerism; or, in short, the 3 R's of disabled consumerism.
IV. The Rights of Disabled Consumerism
Before proceeding further, let us stop and define precisely what is meant by the word
"right." The Dictionary of American Politics states that a right is a claim, entitlement,
privilege, or prerogative which has been conferred upon a group or person by heredity,
usage, or law. A legal right may be vindicated or protected in the courts.
Furthermore, the Dictionary of Sociology states that a right is that which any social unit,
individual, or group, is entitled to expect from its environment in accordance with the
norms of that society. Philosophically or ethically, the term is often used to apply to
benefits or privileges which the individual or group feels that it ought to receive from
society or from the world at large. Sociologically, rights have reality only as they are
guaranteed and will be enforced by some social agent. All practical rights are socially
conferred and socially guaranteed and have no existence beyond the extent to which they
will be socially supported.
Basic human civil rights are shared by all individuals-disabled and non-disabled alike. What
are these basic rights of any human being? Dr. Carl Rogers, the famous psychoanalyst,
states, "the organism has one basic tendency and striving-to actualize, maintain, and
enhance the experiencing organism."
The organism actualizes itself along the lines laid down by heredity. It becomes more
differentiated, more expanded, more autonomous, and more socialized as it matures. This
basic tendency of growth-to actualize and expand oneself-is seen to best advantage when
an individual is observed over a long period of time. There is a forward movement in the life
of every person; it is this ongoing tendency which is the only force that the therapist can
really rely upon to effect an improvement in the client.
The right of each and every human being, then, is to have the privilege or the prerogative to
grow, to mature, and to be fulfilled. It was with this growth motif in mind that Adler
devolved the concept of the creative self. To Adler, the creative self is the first cause. It
intervenes or mediates between stimuli and responses. The doctrine of the creative self
asserts that men made their own personality out of the raw materials of heredity and
environment.
State of the Art / Poling / 5
Heredity only endows him with certain abilities. Environment only gives him certain
impressions. These abilities and impressions, and the manner in which he "experiences"
them-that is to say, the interpretation he makes of these experiences-are the bricks
which he uses in his own creative way in building up his attitude toward life. It is his
individual way of using these bricks, or in other words his attitude toward life, which
determines this relationship to the outside world.
Lindzey Hall, Theories of Personality
Society has protected man's right to grow throughout its evolution. For example, the
Declaration of Independence states:
We hold these truths to be self-evident, that all men are created equal, that they are
endowed by their Creator with certain unalienable Rights, that among these are Life,
Liberty and the pursuit of Happiness
Almost two hundred years later, this same basic principle was still being reiterated as the
fundamental corner stone of our American Society! For, in 1960, the President's
Commission on National Goals proclaimed:
The status of the individual must remain our primary concern. All our institutions-
political, social, and economic-must further enhance the dignity of the individual,
promote the maximum development of his capabilities, stimulate their responsive
exercise, and widen the range and effectiveness for individual choice.
This political line of reason also has solid support within the ranks of the behavioral
scientists. For example, in 1965, the noted psychologist, John W. Gardner, in his book,
Self-Renewal, posed this line of reasoning in these terms:
As far as adults are concerned, it is not certain whether anything can be done to supply
creativity that is not already present. But much can be done to release the potential
that is there. It is the almost universal testimony of people who possess this trait that
certain kinds of environments smother their creative impulses and other kinds permit
the release of these impulses. The society interested in continuous renewal will strive to
be a hospitable environment for the release of creativity.
Although the above quotations refer primarily to able-bodied individuals, this same right to
grow and to mature belongs to the forty million disabled within this nation. On the 8th of
October, 1973, at the International Conference on "Models of Service for the Multi-
Handicapped Adult," Ms. Anna Maris Mulligan delivered a paper. Ms. Mulligan is a staff
member of the Division of Social and Preventive Psychiatry, Nebraska Psychiatric Institute
in Omaha. Ms. Mulligan stated:
Normalization is the utilization of means which are as culturally normative as possible
in order to establish and/or maintain personal behaviors and characteristics which are
as culturally normative as possible. More simply put, we could say that the "Principles
of Normalization" provide the handicapped individual with the means and opportuni-
ties for achieving a lifestyle that is as normal as possible.
Ms. Mulligan then went on to explain another precept which is interrelated to the concept
of normalization. This precept is that of socially integrative opportunities. A socially
State of the Art / Poling / 6
integrative opportunity is a situation within the community in which a severely handicapped
adult has a chance, on a regular basis, to interact with non-handicapped adults. In fact, in
many respects, this concept of Mulligan's is similar to Gardner's hospitable) environment.
According to Mulligan, it is society's responsibility to be a creative pioneer in generating
these types of situations!
Therefore, in order for disabled people to enjoy the right of growth and maturity, they must
be integrated into society. I used to do social work in the ghettos of Washington Heights and
Harlem in New York City. In fund raising, one of my favorite quotes was that of the brilliant
educator Max Lerner. Lerner once was asked to summarize in a single word the keystone of
American development. He answered, "Access." Lerner went on to define what he meant by
access. "By this, I mean access to economic opportunity, access to social mobility, access to
geographic movement, access to political participation. Most important of all, perhaps,
would be access to educational opportunity."
Lerner was speaking about social access. Social access is denied to all minorities before they
become integrated into society. This is what I mean when I speak of the rights of disabled
consumerism. I mean the right to live a relatively normal life in spite of one's disability. I
mean the right to function as an equal of a non-disabled person. I mean the right to be
creative and imaginative.
V. The Status and the Consequences of the Disabled being a Minority
However, before we can start demanding rights for the disabled, we must be sure that we
know about whom we are precisely speaking. Fifty years ago there was no such thing as an
aggregate of disabled individuals. Now that the social evolution has produced them, who are
these individuals, and what type of group do they consider?
In her book, The Sociology and Social Psychology of Disability and Rehabilitation,
Constantina Safilios-Rothschild discusses the question of whether or not the disabled
minority can be legitimately considered a minority. There are certain similarities and certain
dissimilarities between the collectivity of disabled people and other minorities. Each of
these two categories will be examined below, and then conclusions will be drawn as to
whether in fact this disabled collectivity does or does not constitute a minority.
Regarding the similarities:
This disabled collectivity is considered deviant, is segregated from the non-disabled, and
occupies a separate and isolated social position within the general society. This segregation
implies that the non-handicapped population segment considers the disabled collectivity as
being inferior. Hence, segregation is the means by which the non-handicapped keep their
social (and even territorial) distance from the disabled collectivity. This segregation is
rationalized as being beneficial to the disabled. They are happier interacting with other
handicapped individuals. The disabled tend to be evaluated according to their group
characteristic rather than their individual attributes. This characteristic of group member-
ship is "being disabled" and leads to ipso facto prejudice.
State of the Art / Poling / 7
In regard to the dissimilarities:
There is no clear-cut dichotomy between disabled and non-disabled; in fact, almost every
person is at least partially handicapped at one time of his life or another. The disabled
minority does not constitute a homogeneous group itself. Its members are as varied in their
attributes as are the members of its parent society. There are some subtle differences
between discrimination between other minorities and the disabled. In the case of the
disabled (as well as the old and women), discrimination is often camouflaged by protective
legislation and is rationalized on the basis of biological and physiological limitations and
weaknesses. The disabled collectivity does not self-perpetuate its own membership, nor does
it perpetuate its own values and norms. Rather, its membership-as well as its values and
norms-are determined by the general society.
Rothschild concludes (and I agree with her) that the general aggregate of disabled people
can indeed be considered as a minority. Rothschild further states that the phenomenon of
the disabled minority can be explained in terms of "the general series of deviance."
"Rehabilitation," then, becomes an institution of social control, and sometimes it has a
conflicting social role. On the one hand, it must help the disabled overcome those aspects of
their condition that are considered deviant. On the other hand, however, it socializes the
disabled to play the proper role of deviant.
There is a great deal of stigmatizing and stereotyping of disabled people by the non-disabled
public. Because of this stereotyping and stigmatizing, a great amount of social distance is
placed between these two societal segments. In fact, it is justified to state that, even as the
black minority has been placed in urban ghettos, so the disabled minority have been placed
in ghettos of ignorance and outright stupidity.
In its major research report, Youth in the Ghetto (1964), Haryou characterized the state of
the Harlem Ghetto in the following manner:
Ghettos in contemporary America may be defined primarily in terms of racial and
color-determined restrictions on freedom of choice and freedom of movement. Ghettos
are the consequence of the imposition of external power and the institutionalization of
powerlessness. In this respect, they are in fact social, political, educational, and-above
all-economic colonies. Those confined within the ghetto walls are subject people.
They are the victims of greed, cruelty, insensitivity, guilt, and fear of their masters. The
concrete indications of the powerless aspect of the American urban ghettos are to be
found in deteriorated housing, overcrowdedness, infant mortality, and high disease
rates. The psychological dimensions of the ghetto clearly related to, determined and
reinforced by objective characteristics, involve patterns of general hostility, random
aggressiveness, despair, apathy, a cursory grandiosity and posturing.
The critical two things regarding any ghetto or imprisoned minority are the imposition of
power from without and the internalization of power from within. We are all familiar with
the type of imposition of power from without regarding the disabled minority-that is,
architectural barriers, job discrimination, and adequate housing, and so on. In other words,
imposition of power from without is depriving the disabled minority of their human and
civil rights. As serious as the problem of imposition of power is, I am even more concerned
with the problem of the institutionalization of powerlessness from within.
State of the Art / Poling / 8
By "the institutionalization of powerlessness from within," I méan that disabled people
start to actually believe the stereotyping and stigmatizing of the general public. They place
the self-fulfilling prophecy into operation. To be blunt, since they let themselves believe
they are nothing but shit, they actually turn into a pile of shit. In other words, they
themselves become their own worst enemy. The psychologist, G. W. Allport, describes a
number of ego defenses which the disabled have developed. A few of these are:
Obsessive Concern: Hypersensitiveness
Denial of Membership: Rejecting their Disabled Status
Withdrawal and Passivity
Identification with Dominant Group:
Self-hatred & Feelings of Inferiority
Prejudice toward Own Group
Fighting Back: Militancy against Out-Group
Strengthening In-Group Ties:
Developing an esprit de corps
Enhance Striving towards the Norms
Symbolic Status Striving:
i.e., Compensation by Substitution
Self-Fulfilling Prophecy
VI. The Disabled Minority Needs An Active Advocate
At this stage of the evolutionary process within society, the disabled minority is in need of a
leadership group that will be interposed between itself and the rest of society. Such a
leadership group would function as an ombudsman, a referee, an advocate, or a mediator.
This leadership group would attack both the imposition of power from without and the
institutionalization of powerlessness from within. It would lobby on behalf of the disabled;
for, consumerist Betty Furness points out the important function the government must
play: "The consumer can't tell Detroit to build cars that get 20 miles to the gallon, but the
government can. When consumers want one thing and business wants another, it's essential
for the government to be the arbitrator."
We may define such a leadership group of consumers, as does Zeigler and Peak in their book,
Interest Groups in American Society, as an organized social aggregate which seeks political
goods that it is incapable of providing for itself.
Zeigler and Peak go on to explain:
It is important not to confuse the concepts of group interest and organized association.
The former is a shared desire for a particular political good or set of political goods.
Organization, on the other hand, is a manifestation of social technology; it is a means
by which individuals coordinate their energies and resources toward accomplishing a
common objective.
The historical existence of such special interest groups or ombudsmen in America can be
traced back even beyond its earliest years as a nation. A hasty perusal of Federalists No. 9
and 10 reveals clearly that the founding fathers recognized their existence. Excellent
State of the Art / Poling / 9
examples of such organized interest groups are the trade unions. Back in the middle of the
19th century, labor was one of the most exploited segments of our entire population.
However, at that time, the unions started to organize on a national scale, until today one
might even argue that the unions are too powerful.
At this moment in time, the disabled minority is at the same primitive stage of development
as was the labor movement in the mid-1800's. There have been several attempts to organize
the forty million disabled people on a national scale. One of the most notable of these
attempts has been the Congress of Organizations of the Physical Handicapped. COPH has
been in existence for approximately two decades. Its founder and executive director is
Elmer Josephs, of the Chicago area. Josephs is a pharmacist by trade. He has tried to
organize COPH in his spare time. COPH has suffered from a lack of funds, traveling
expenses, and a paid staff. In recent years its membership has been dwindling. It used to
have three state councils, but now it has only two. COPH feels that its identity is being
threatened by ACCD, and it refuses to join the Coalition on the grounds that it doesn't want
to be associated with the mentally retarded.
The most recent and, in my opinion, by far the most exciting attempt at organizing the
disabled minority on a national basis is the American Coalition of Citizens with Disabilities,
Inc. ACCD is in the second year of its existence and is attempting to incorporate all types of
disabled consumers into its structure, including those with mental retardation. ACCD is
struggling with all of the many problems that COPH encountered; however, by far the most
serious of all problems is that of coping with the acute paranoia and suspicions of its
members-both individuals and groups. Disabled people have been exploited for so long that
they are literally afraid of trusting anybody, including other members of their own
minority. This is what I mean when I say institutionalization of powerlessness. This is what I
mean when I say disabled people are their own worse enemies.
In order for ACCD to be successful, its leadership must take the initiative and develop its
creative imagination. It must go into the societal market place and actively bargain on behalf
of its constituency. We must figure out what we can realistically offer society. We sure as
hell know what we want from society. We want our human and civil rights! But do we know
what we can offer society in return for these rights? We also must arrive at specific strategies
and concrete tactics for securing these rights. Indeed, the final two sections of this paper
will be devoted to formulating extremely tentative answers to these two questions.
VII. The "Responsibilities" of the Disabled Minority
Are we, the disabled people of this nation, to consider ourselves and to be considered by
others as objects of pity and remorse, as poor little crippled children who hold out little tin
cups for a nickle worth of charity? Or, are we mature men of value and words? If we are
satisfied to remain the former, then we can remain free-loaders and sponge off society for
the rest of our lives. If, however, we are to be transformed into the latter, then we must use
our creative imagination to invest ways of becoming creating and productive members of
society. If we want to be equal to others in the rights we receive, then we also must be equal
to others in the responsibilities that we are willing to contribute to society. We must
establish a quid pro quo relationship between society and ourselves. We must be willing to
give something in turn for receiving something. We must be willing to exchange a
responsibility for a right.
State of the Art / Poling / 10
Yet, what is meant by the term responsibility? Responsibility is an answerability or an
accountability under social custom or law for the proper performance of actions or duties as
well as the consequences of those duties or actions. The Dictionary of Sociology further
states that the term responsibility implies some degree of comprehension of an act or duty
and the deliberate or voluntary carrying out of the act or duty. Responsibility is thus not
attributable to the insane or the very young. Nor would it be ascribed to an individual who
was coerced into doing something against his/her will.
With the above in mind, what are the responsibilities of the disabled minority? What can our
disabled minority contribute to this society? I believe that our contribution can be an
awareness of a new social reality or in the words of Rothschild:
Unless the disabled themselves unite, thus becoming a kind of 'militant' group trying to
shape their own destinies according to their own needs and demands, it is difficult to
conceptualize the present state of the field as representing a social movement. A
militant movement of disabled would try to create a new image of man, that of man
with a disability as equally acceptable and 'normal' as man without a disability
The image of the disabled must be freed from stigmatizing and stereotyping. From the very
outset of this nation's history, the focus of American counselors has almost entirely
revolved around the Protestant work ethic. The time has come when it would be to the
advantage of our entire society to take some of the emphasis off the monetary aspects of
life and place greater emphasis on the esthetic quality of living. Further, I believe that the
disabled minority can be the pioneers in this esthetic revolution, and this can be the
contribution of the disabled minority to our society.
Such an esthetic revolution would require a complete restructuring of our value system. A
handicapped person is forced to go through this restructuring of his/her value system in the
process of coming to accept his/her disability. In her book, Physical Disability-A
Psychological Approach, B. Wright describes this process, and it will be instructive for us to
briefly review it at this time. "Acceptance" of one's disability is seen as the mid-point in a
continuum. One end of this continuum is the futile and vain (useless) attempt to improve
the improvable disability, while the other end is total resignation. Acceptance, then, is
keeping one's balance between these two extremes.
Dembo and his co-workers developed a theory of "acceptance of loss." Wright has taken this
theory and expanded it. The theory involves four types of changes in a person's value
system or structure. The four types of changes are: (1) enlarging the scope of values; (2)
subordinating physique; (3) containing disability effect; and (4) transforming comparative
values into asset values. The four types of value changes are interdependent and will be
discussed below.
Regarding the first type of change in the value system: To compensate for any loss-be it
the loss of a loved. one, a physical ability, or something else-a person must go through a
period of mourning. During this mourning period, that person realizes emotionally the
existence of other values in addition to the value of the lost item. Values heretofore
undiscovered come to the fore. These new and unique values add new meaning to a person's
lifestyle, enriching and enhancing it.
State of the Art / Poling / 11
Regarding the second change, subordinating the value of the physique: In our culture,
physique is supremely valued. A disabled person must, therefore, reorder his/her priorities,
so other values will be more important than (surface) appearance and performance.
The third change has to do with containing the psychological spread of the effects of the
disability. A disability is often perceived as imposing a wider range of limitations than it
actually should. This perceived spread often is transformed into the social reality of the
situation. Social reality consists of physique, other physical environmental factors,
personality traits, and interpersonal circumstances. (The objective is to limit the disabling
symptoms to only those portions of the physique which are actually affected and not let
them emotionally spread to other unrelated portions of the social reality.)
The final change is by far the most important, and it is contingent upon the first three. This
change has to do with transforming a value from a comparative value to a set value. A
comparative value is when the evaluation is based upon a comparison with a (social)
standard. This comparison is usually made between an item and presumed average, a cultural
norm (an ought), or certain formal requirements (i.e., rules for membership into a social
club). An asset value is when the evaluation is based upon the qualities inherent in the
object of judgement itself. The evaluation is made on how well those intrinsic qualities meet
the unique needs and demands of a specific situation. Asset values, then, may also be termed
intrinsic values or substantive values. Asset values are par excellence of human dignity.
In my opinion, it would enhance the entire society if its basic value system could be
restructured in the above fashion. In my opinion, this is what the disabled minority has to
offer society in toto. In my opinion, it is the responsibility of the disabled minority to be
pioneers and to lead the way in this esthetic revolution.
In the course of social evolution, as a minority is assimilated into its parent society, its basic
values are also assimilated, thereby enhancing and enriching the entire societal fabric. As our
minority is being assimilated, let us have as our central value the basic dignity and worth of
each and every human being. Let's judge each human being on his own unique merits and
appreciate him or her for the potential contribution that person can make to society as a
whole. Consider, for example, the following letter that I recently received from a young
man who is mentally retarded. Also, consider the fact that this young man has been
institutionalized all his life and he is just now learning to express himself. Under these
conditions, I believe that this simple letter has the same intrinsic beauty as Milton's Paradise
Lost or Shakespeare's Hamlet:
Dear Mr. Poling:
One of my major problems is last Wednesday I found out my foster mother has breast
cancer. It was pretty serious to me, shocking. I went to Denver for the weekend and
saw her. I was relieved to see her there where she was in good hands.
Other major problems is getting out of Kelwood. It is a residential care run by the
Boulder County Board. I figured I learned all I can learn in Kelwood but I don't have
enough money at this point to move out. So I started eight hours doing pots and pans.
I get tired of it sometimes doing pots. One major problem I hope to make my goal is to
get back as an apprentice as an electricians helper cause I remember the good times in
Grand Junction when I climbed up and put the wire through.
State of the Art / Poling / 12
One of my other achievements I want to learn is financing money and doing budgeting
better. That's one of the biggest achievements in the outside to make money work in
society.
I hate the public service bus system-they stop running Sunday at two and Saturday at
seven. I don't know how people can get home from the show. The mayor Pen Tate is
trying to get RTD started in Boulder-public service buses are against RTD. They're
dirty and not running right and half the time the windows won't open.
I have a problem dating a girl-when I get up or come downstairs she asks if I want to
go out. I don't have the money to take her out all the time. And she never pays.
I don't like Kelwood. It's too run down and the rent is too high. I get sick and tired of
the rules they've got there. Curfew-being in at ten thirty. Sitting at the table too long
when we get through. I don't care for the houseparents-they're not there when you
need them and are grouchy and all that. They keep medicine locked up and won't give it
to you when you need it. The food should be better and the house should be fixed up.
One of the good things they've done was put a sprinkler system in.
Charles Dieterle
VIII. The Repertoire of the Disabled Minority
We have now defined both rights and responsibilities of the disabled minority. We also have
demonstrated that the only way that we are ever going to gain our civil and human rights is
by developing and offering new and unique responsibilities to society in exchange for these
rights. Finally, we have demonstrated that a leadership group of disabled consumers is
needed to act as an ombudsman or a mediator in the societal market place. It is extremely
necessary for this leadership group to be highly skilled in the art of bargaining and
negotiation.
These skills of bargaining and negotiation I refer to as the repertoire of this leadership
group. In order to negotiate effectively, this leadership group must possess a large repertoire
of bargaining strategies and tactics. The term "repertoire" is derived from the Latin,
repertorium, and means inventory. However, before we partially enumerate the repertoire
needed by ACCD, let us be certain that we understand precisely what ACCD is up against!
The disabled minority is just starting to find its self fulfillment and its self identity. Its
dreams and aspirations are just starting to rise. Therefore, at this moment in time, the
disabled minority is just about where the black minority was one or two decades ago. In
other words, ACCD is sitting on a potential powder keg of dynamite; in the words of one
social analyst describing the situation in Harlem 12 years ago:
Given an increase in the positive self-image of Negro youth, based upon the realities of
effective social action and demonstrated social change, there should emerge a solid
basis for a new cycle of greater personal and community effectiveness. From this
perspective, it can be seen that the closer the Negro community gets to the attainment
of its goals-the closer it gets to the removal of the determinants and manifestations of
racial exploitation and powerlessness-the more impatient individual Negroes will
become for total equality.
State of the Art / Poling / 13
Success in removing some barriers feeds the idea of personal and community
effectiveness and provides the strength and the motivation for increased activity. This,
in turn, makes the existing barriers even more intolerable. This accelerated impatience
and the lowering of the threshold of frustration for remaining inequities, paradoxically,
increases the chances of racial tensions and ferment, if not explosions. This level of the
cyclic relationship between increased personal effectiveness and successful community
action makes careful, thoughtful, and realistic planning starkly imperative if the
chances of social chaos are to be reduced.
Haryou, Youth in the Ghetto (1964)
Today, at this very moment, a similar critical situation exists within the disabled minority.
In order to diffuse this explosive situation and redirect the energies into more constructive
channels, ACCD must attack the institutionalization of powerlessness from within and the
imposition of power from without. In attacking the institutionalization of powerlessness,
the leadership of ACCD must function as role-models. Whereas, in attacking the imposition
of external powers, the leadership of ACCD must function as reference individuals. Being
role-models and reference individuals are the two major components within the repertoire of
disabled consumerism. Each will now be briefly discussed.
As role-models, the leadership of ACCD must be examples of the behavioral types that other
disabled people desire to emulate and to copy. Furthermore, the ACCD leadership must
conduct themselves in such a way as to overcome the acute paranoia and mistrust of their
disabled constituency. One method of doing this is to govern ACCD as democratically as
possible.
In the early part of the twentieth century the initiative, referendum, and recall were
introduced in an attempt to curb the influence of big business interests in local and
state politics by giving the people a more direct voice in government.
1. Initiative. The initiative is a device by which a certain percentage of the voters
(usually 5 percent) may propose a bill by petition. The proposed bill is then presented
to the people for their approval or rejection. If approved, it becomes a law.
2. Referendum. The referendum, a popular form of the veto power, is a device by
which a certain percentage of the voters (usually 5 percent) may petition that a law
already passed by the legislature be submitted directly to the people for their approval
or rejection.
3. Recall. The recall, a popular form of impeachment used largely in city government,
permits a certain percentage of voters (usually 5 percent) to petition for the recall of
an elected official whose services have been unsatisfactory. After the petition has been
filed, a special election is held in which the voters decide whether to retain the
incumbent in office or to replace him by another candidate for the position.
It is recommended that the Board of Directors of ACCD institute the above procedures. In
exchange for this, their disabled constituency would render the Board of Directors of ACCD
adequate authority to act decisively, to negotiate and to bargain on their behalf.
In being reference individual to the non-handicapped society, the leadership of ACCD must
be examples of what disabled people can do and what they can be, if and only if they are
State of the Art / Poling / 14
given the human and civil rights of any other citizen. Their emotional and intellectual
conduct must be above reproach. Under absolutely no condition must they allow themselves
to fall back into the old rut of behaving like spoiled little crippled brats; but rather, they
must conduct themselves as fully mature and responsible adults at all times, for all
occasions, and even under the most trying of circumstances. This is a large order indeed to
fill, and I suggest the following six rules from Christopher News Notes that may serve as
guidelines for disabled consumerism when dealing with the non-handicapped society:
1. Complain when necessary; in fact, if it is called for, given them hell. However, always
be certain that your criticism is responsible and it can be substantiated with fact.
2. Whenever possible, do comparative shopping. In some communities, service providers
offer a duplication of services. Select the one that best meets with your personal needs.
Make them aware that you are evaluating them.
3. Know your rights. When you make demands, make those demands as specifically and
as concrete as possible. Don't speak in generalities.
4. Give credit where credit is due. Don't be always bitching just because you are
frustrated and have nothing to do. Recognize the fact that, even as no one is all right, so no
one is all wrong either. Whenever possible, be positive rather than negative; be constructive
instead of destructive.
5. Deal honestly. When you make a mistake, simply admit it. Don't be afraid to
apologize.
6. Work at your work. When you finally obtain a position of importance, do exactly
what you have been telling non-disabled professionals to do. At all costs, do not operate
under a double standard: one standard for non-disabled professionals; the other standard for
disabled professionals.
IX. Summary and Conclusion
This paper has attempted to address itself to the subject: "The Behavioral Science of
Interdependent and Integrated Living of Disabled People." It was pointed out that this
subject matter was not an art at all; but rather, it was a calculated science, a science
governed by laws and hypotheses. The main objective is to integrate the disabled minority
into the main stream of American life. We have defined and elaborated upon the three R's
of disabled consumerism: namely, rights, responsibilities, and repertoire. We have attempted
to use these concepts in explaining the basic propositions, hypotheses, and laws underlining
this behavioral science.
Perhaps one of the most important sections of this paper was the suggestion that the
disabled minority assume the moral leadership and be the pioneers in the esthetic revolution
of this nation. This would take the disabled minority off the defensive and put them on the
offensive. This would give them a positive posture rather than a negative posture. This
would give them a mission and purpose in life-something towards which to work and to
strive.
Daniel A. Poling, II
Editor-in-Chief
Poling Magazine
122 East 23rd St.
New York, N.Y. 10010
State of the Art / Poling / 15
Bibliography
Adams, John et al. The Declaration of Independence (1776).
Adler, A., The Fundamental Views of Individual Psychology (1935).
Allport, G. W., The Nature of Prejudice, Addison-Wesley (1954).
Black, M., The Social Theories of Talcott Parsons, Prentice-Hall (1961).
Only a Consumer? Christopher News Notes, No. 213 (1975)
Dembo, T., Leviton, G. L. & Wright, B. A., Adjustment to Misfortune-A Problem of Social Psychological
Rehabilitation (1956).
Gardner, J., Self-Renewal Harper & Row (1965).
Hall, Lindzey, Theories of Personality, John Wiley & Sons, Inc. (1957).
Hopkins, T. The Exercise of Influence in Small Groups, The Bedminster Press (1964).
Jahoda, M., Social Psychology in Interrelations Between the Social Environment and Psychiatric Disorders,
Milbank Memorial Fund (1953).
Merton, R., Social Theory and Social Structure, The Free Press (1957).
Robert, H. M., Robert's Rules of Order, Pyramid Books (1974).
Safilios-Rothschild, C., The Sociology and Social Psychology of Disability and Rehabilitation, Random
House (1970).
Shean, G., Studies in Abnormal Behavior, Rand McNally & Co. (1971).
Somerville, J., The Way of Science, Henry Schuman (1953).
Williams, C., Topical Review of American History, Topical Review Book Co. (1936).
Wright, B., Physical Disability-A Psychological Approach, Harper & Row (1960).
Zeigler, Le., & Peak, G., Interest Group in American Society, Prentice-Hall (1964).
Models of Service for the Multi-Handicapped Adult, UCP (1973).
. The President's Commission on National Goals, Commissioned by the Presidents Eisenhower and
Kennedy (1960).
"CRIPS LIB": AN OVERVIEW OF LEGAL ISSUES
Jack Achtenberg
Preface
This piece is meant to survey the recent litigational developments in the field. Many new
cases are being filed daily. The problem with this type of article is that it is out-of-date even
before it is published. For those who wish to remain up-to-date, the author suggests a
subscription to the Newsletter of the recently funded National Center for a Barrier Free
Environment. One can contact them by writing to the President's Committee on Employ-
ment of the Handicapped, Washington, D.C. 20210.
This article brings together the current legally significant developments regarding the
physically disabled, but it does not contain substantial material about the Constitutional
protections of the physically disabled. Those wishing a more detailed survey of these
possible protections should read "Abroad in the Land: Legal Strategies to Effectuate the
Rights of the Physically Disabled," 61 Georgetown Law Journal, p. 1501 (1973). A very
recent handling of Constitutional rights is found in a publication, "Equal Access to Public
Transportation: the Disabled and the Elderly" (December, 1975), by the Public Interest
Law Center of Philadelphia, 1315 Walnut St., Phila., Pa. 19107.
Introduction
On July 19, 1974, the Final Report of Wisconsin's Task Force on Problems of People with
Physical Handicaps was issued. The introduction to the extensive compendium of problem
analysis and recommendations began with a quote from William Hazlitt:
Man is the only animal that laughs and weeps: for he is the only animal that is struck
with the difference between what things are and what they ought to be.
The physically disabled are presently second-class citizens. However, they are rebelling
against the restraints imposed upon them by society.
Several years ago, the disabled became, in the words of the Los Angeles Times, a "pushy new
political force." The "Crip Movement" is now expanding from the halls of the legislature to
the steps of the courthouse. However, NOW, those steps are not going to act as barriers but
rather as rampways to social integration.
In the 1960's a political and legal revolution was begun because there was a significant
minority population who had to sit at the back of the bus. Today it is realized that a
significant minority cannot even get on the bus.
1
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 2
It has been "discovered" that the disabled have been ghettoized and deprived of their
humanity. Three years ago most health professionals did not realize that the physically
disabled quadriplegic wants to know about his or her sexual potential. Sexuality and severe
disability were assumed to be incompatible. They are not.
A few years ago, the author, returning with his attendant from an extended stay in Europe
where he was able to visit almost all of the ancient European monuments, was denied the
opportunity to even attempt to visit the relatively modern state-owned park and castle at
San Simeon, California.
A person in a wheelchair may be admitted to a movie theatre. The theatre has seats,
drinking fountains and restrooms for the able-bodied. However, if this person is unable to
leave the wheelchair, he cannot use on a full and equal basis, these amusement facilities. His
access is as completely denied as if the theatre had a sign saying, "Disabled Do Not Enter."
A series of recent law suits indicate that rapid transit districts throughout the country do
not realize that narrow doorways and high stairs make it impossible for a person in a
wheelchair or with severe mobility difficulties to use rapid transit, thus substantially
reducing the individual's opportunity for gainful employment and a productive life.
In July, 1975, one of the first discrimination cases involving the disabled was tried.¹ This
was not a case of covert discrimination, but rather it was a case of a theatre manager saying
in effect, 'If you are in a wheelchair, I don't want you in here.'
Evolution of Militancy
It is almost impossible to know how many people are affected by discrimination against the
disabled. There are several reasons for this phenomenon, not the least of which has been
society's attitude of "out of sight, out of mind." This attitude has had two primary effects.
The average person, average architect, average engineer, has built and designed for the
average. The disabled person has, if his disability is not too extensive, tried to pass as
"normal." On the other hand the severely disabled, the quadriplegic, the "high" paraplegic,
the cerebral palsied and the epileptic have been substantially excluded from society and
have been exposed to sufficient ego-destroying pressures, SO that the militancy necessary for
demanding legally protected rights has been slow to develop.
In the 1960's, primarily at the behest of vocational rehabilitation and health professionals, a
series of laws were passed at both the federal and state levels requiring that certain
accommodations and facilities be made accessible to the disabled. To date, the federal
government² as well as all 50 states and the District of Columbia³ have passed architectural
barrier laws which require various types of newly constructed buildings be made accessible
to the disabled and that certain modifications of pre-existing structures be made accessible.
Several states, including California⁴ and Washington,5 have passed anti-discrimination
statutes and civil rights statutes to insure the rights of the disabled. The federal government
has, where federal grants are involved, also passed an anti-discrimination statute.⁶
In the early 1970's the efforts of the health professionals and such disabled groups as the
Paralyzed Veterans of America were supplemented and enhanced by strong input from large
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 3
numbers of diverse disabled themselves. Spreading out from college campuses the physically
disabled have begun to humanize society. The "Crip Lib" movement is afoot. Efforts are
being made to integrate the physically disabled into society in every aspect.
The disabled themselves, and those familiar with their plight, are increasing the pressure on
the establishment through a myriad of legislative and legal processes. This increasing
pressure resulted in the landmark 1973 Vocational Rehabilitation Act and its 1974
Amendments. This Act declared that it was against government policy to allow any person
receiving a federal grant to discriminate against the disabled solely because of their disability
and further required affirmative action hiring policies, by those who contract with the
government (Sections 503 and 504). The 1970's also witnessed the placing of the disabled
under Fair Employment Practices Acts in such states as California (Cal. Labor Code,
sections 1413 and 1420).
The 1964 Mass Transit Act stated that all efforts should be made to provide transportation
for the disabled. The current tentative regulations indicate, however, that no adequate effort
to incorporate facilities for the severely mobility disabled will be made. The Federal
Aviation Administration has issued tentative regulations for the transportation of the
disabled by commercial airlines. These regulations do not seem to provide adequate facilities
for those with severe disabilities. As a result, many consumer groups are contemplating or
have begun lawsuits in the area of transportation.
The early 1970's also produced a legislative and legal movement in the mental health field.
Legal developments relating to retarded children's education have potential for use by the
physically disabled in their effort to obtain educational equality. Numerous cases were
brought on behalf of parents and children in such jurisdictions as Pennsylvania⁷ and the
District of Columbia.⁸
Enforcement Difficulties
The disabled have found that legislation is no panacea. Constant and militant monitoring of
enforcement has been necessary. The one element which runs throughout the developments
of the 1960's and 1970's is that the laws and regulations which were passed have seen little
or no effective enforcement.
The history of the California Architectural Barrier Statutes is indicative of the unwillingness
of some governmental officials to live within the spirit of the law. The original California
statute dealt with public "buildings" and "facilities" being made accessible to the disabled.
Within weeks after the passage of the statute an official in Los Angeles decided that the
word "facilities" did not include sidewalks around state buildings. This necessitated a return
to the state legislature on two different occasions to have the word "sidewalks" specifically
placed within the statute. On another occasion, one of the major building officials of San
Francisco simply refused to recognize the passage of the architectural barrier laws as they
applied to his city.
The disabled have had a very difficult time enforcing the laws as they exist and in obtaining
recognition of their other rights. Why is this? Even when there is statutory authority there
has been substantial resistance to effective enforcement. Many people claim that they are
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 4
unaware of the laws while others simply do not comply with the laws because they fear it
will substantially add to the expense of building construction, or the costs of providing a
usable mass transit vehicle. Moreover, until recently, there has been no effective government
mechanism to oversee enforcement. The disabled themselves have been unable to bring
sufficient pressure to enforce compliance. Most disabled people are poor, often unemployed
or under-employed, and until very recently had no coherent organizational support. A
classic example of the non-compliance with state-mandated architectural barrier laws is
found in the Smuggler's Inn case.⁹
In late 1972, Mr. Dick Wooten, who is confined to a wheelchair, went to a restaurant in the
outskirts of Sacramento, California. That restaurant had been constructed after the
architectural barrier laws became operative. The entrance to the building was surrounded by
stairs. The dark and narrow kitchen entrance through which Mr. Wooten was admitted led
to a foyer which itself was ringed by stairs. With the help of employees Mr. Wooten,
together with his wife, was able to move to a table, although they had to forego a visit to
the bar which they had intended. After dinner, Mr. Wooten asked where the restroom
facilities were located; he was ushered through the kitchen and employees' locker room area
to a restroom used only by employees. The restroom was so small, however, that it was not
possible to get the wheelchair and himself within the commode area and still close the door.
In full view of all the male and female employees, and with a male employee of the
restaurant standing guard at the other end of the hallway, Mr. Wooten attempted to have a
normal urination.
As a result of his experience, Mr. Wooten contacted a paralyzed attorney in Los Angeles and
asked him to bring suit. This attorney felt it would be better legal strategy to convince the
State Attorney General's Office to commence the action because the lawsuit would be most
effective if the government agency responsible for enforcing the Architectural Barrier Laws,
the County of Sacramento, were forcefully reminded of its responsibility. Although the
State Attorney General's Office was not opposed to bringing suit, it took two years for
them to find the necessary manpower. Mr. Wooten's position in the State Rehabilitation
Department was crucial in motivating this suit. Otherwise, this violation of the laws might
never have been effectively challenged.
Why, in the Smuggler's Inn case, would Mr. Wooten need to wait for almost three years
before effective and continuous legal action was possible? Why was he not able to approach
a lawyer who could have taken the case on a contingency basis? Why did he not approach
the American Civil Liberties Union? Why would not the average disabled person, who is
poor, be able to get legal relief from the Office of Economic Opportunity Legal Aid
Foundation (now a federally funded corporation)?
The answers to these questions are not simple. Most private attorneys do not have, at
present, the expertise to bring these cases. Many attorneys are reluctant to involve
themselves in cases where there is little judicial authority and therefore a substantial
likelihood of appeals all the way to the United States Supreme Court. American Civil
Liberties Union and Office of Economic Opportunity lawyers also presently lack expertise.
Historically, they have been so overworked defending their black, brown and poor clients
that they have not recognized the unique problems of the disabled.
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 5
Why not simply appeal to the National Center on Law and the Handicapped located at
Notre Dame University? Existing limitations have thus far precluded such an appeal. The
Center, founded in the early 1970's, has been acting on its own sense of priorities and has
placed little emphasis on the physically disabled, the deaf and the blind; rather, it has done
most of its precedent-setting work in the area of mental retardation and mental illness. More
important, however, is the fact that one center, with but a few lawyers, provides insufficient
staff to litigate a problem affecting one-tenth of the nation's population.
Enforcement Through Litigation
While it has been difficult to obtain the help of private attorneys and legal aid societies, it
has not been impossible. Beginning in 1972 a series of suits were filed in several different
states and the District of Columbia.
The courts were asked to require agencies to whom responsibility had been delegated for
enforcing the rights of the handicapped to perform their duty. In these suits, as well as in
strictly Civil Rights suits, the judiciary was petitioned to recognize the Constitutional and
statutory rights of the disabled.
Architectural Barrier Cases
The first two cases, both in Ohio, 10 brought to vindicate the rights of the disabled were filed
to gain access to courthouses. In both instances the lawyering was provided by pro bono
lawyers (serving the public interest without charge) and law professors. Each case ended in a
consent decree. The case of Friedman V. County of Cuyahoga involved a city councilman
who was unable to use his own office because he was wheelchair confined. The building had
flights of stairs but no elevators. The courthouse was built long before the effective date of
the Ohio architectural barrier laws and thus the complaint and points and authorities
stressed the Constitutional right to inter-state travel. It also claimed that these barriers
substantially interfered with the First Amendment right to assemble and to petition the
government. The plaintiff also relied on the privileges and immunities clause of the
Fourteenth Amendment. The plaintiff was victorious in having the building modified, but
no precedent was set for future litigation.
In the District of Columbia an action was commenced by pro bono private attorneys to
require the newly formed Washington Metropolitan Area Transit Authority (WMTA) to
adhere to the Federal Architectural Barrier Law. Transit facilities (stations, platforms, etc.)
last for decades; these facilities were being built without compliance with architectural
barrier laws. If the project had been built without access, the disabled would have been
effectively excluded for generations to come. The defendants argued that the funds needed
to make the facility accessible had to be provided by Congress, and since Congress had not
done so, it was impermissible to impose upon the WMTA the added costs of building
facilities accessible to all. The defendant Transit District contended that Congress' effort to
place WMTA non-rolling stock under the Federal Architectural Barrier Law was, therefore,
without meaning. However, a federal judge enjoined the further construction of the project.
The legislation, combined with substantial pressure from numerous Congressmen and
Senators, resulted in Congress voting funds to make the project accessible. This Congres-
sional action rendered further litigation substantially moot. Since the original federal court
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 6
decision, however, the judge has had to require that specific stations be actually accessible
before they were opened to the public. Therefore, the Transit Authority has not been able
to complete certain parts of the line and put them into service until actual modifications
have been made.
In 1974 a voting booth accessibility case¹¹ was tried. The argument was that a fundamental
Constitutional right was denied a disabled person who could not physically enter a voting
booth in order to cast a ballot. The case was argued on the basis of invidious discrimination
under the Federal Constitution and statutes, as well as under the California State
Constitution, statutes, and California Election Code. The Judge ruled that there was no
irrational classification nor was any fundamental right infringed since there was an
alternative-an absentee ballot. He did not accept the argument that being forced to vote by
absentee ballot deprived the voter of the opportunity to consider late developing facts. The
case is on appeal.
Another architectural barrier case concerns the new student union now under construction
at San Francisco State University. 13 Under the California State Architectural Barrier Laws
all publicly financed buildings must be made accessible to the disabled. In this suit the
question is what constitutes "adequate accessibility." Large areas of the uniquely designed
student union are completely available to those with mobility problems. However, the two
pinnacle towers that flank the building are only accessible at the first level. These towers
will contain social, study and meditation rooms. The contention of the plaintiffs is that
"accessibility" means full accessibility and not "adequate equivalency accessibility." They
say that separate but equal is not a viable concept any more. 14 As long as the towers are
unique they should be open to all the public, for to deny the disabled full access is to
restrict the scope of their activities and their lives. The university administration contends
that they have not violated state laws nor state mandates and that they are permitted a
substantial amount of flexibility in determining which parts of public buildings should be
made accessible.
Although the San Francisco State Case has not presently gone to trial, and may never do so,
it has already had three noteworthy effects. First, the Federal Housing and Urban
Development Department (HUD) has cancelled the tentative loan that was to be given to
help finance the student union. This was in direct response to the suit. Secondly, the design
architect is being directly sued for not making the building totally accessible to the disabled.
Thirdly, the halting of construction has caused a major re-evaluation of construction
projects on all campuses of the nineteen-school state college and university system. As one
observer ironically put it, the San Francisco suit has caused virtual panic among chancellors,
deans and architects on the state college campuses. "They are almost paralyzed with fear."
Discrimination Against the Disabled
In late June, 1975, the Edwards Theatre case was tried. 15 This was one of the first recorded
"discrimination against the handicapped" cases brought against a private defendant. The
case involved an ex-Marine, Marsh, who had become a "high" paraplegic as a result of an
auto accident. His disability had led to a state of depression and to a marital breakdown. His
parents, in order to cheer him up, decided to take him to a motion picture theatre. Upon
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 7
arrival at the theatre he tendered the appropriate fee and at that point he was informed by
the manager that unless he could sit in a regular seat he would not be allowed admittance.
The manager stated that to allow him to remain in his wheelchair would violate fire
regulations and, moreover, there simply was no room for a wheelchair. His parents offered
to sit with him in the back of the theatre so that he could be immediately removed in case
of emergency. The manager informed them that this was not acceptable. He threatened to
call the police if there was any further disturbance. Marsh was so humiliated and outraged
by these events that he immediately went into a state of total depression. Although three
years have elapsed, he has yet to attend a theatre.
In arguing this case the plaintiff asked for, and received, jury instructions that the disabled
are covered under the California general civil rights statutes. This was highly significant for
two reasons. After a five year delay, the case of In re Cox, 16 on which the judge
substantially relied, was finally used to aid the disabled. In that case the California Supreme
Court held that the seemingly closed-end state general civil rights statute was not restricted
to the categories enumerated therein-race, color, religion, ancestry, or national origin. It
also included any instances of invidious discrimination by a business establishment. In Cox
the court found that there was a violation of the plaintiffs' civil rights when two long-haired
teenagers were denied access to a retail shopping center solely because of their appearance.
The second important aspect of Edwards deals with damages. California's Civil Rights
Statutes for the Handicapped seemingly provide for reasonable attorney's fees in injunctive
actions only when such injunctions are sought to end discriminatory activities under
California Civil Code Sections 54 and 54.1 or violations of the Architectural Barrier Laws.
The general civil rights statute, the Unruh Act, provides, on the other hand, for claims of
plaintiff's "actual damages," as well as $250 penalty damages. By allowing actual damages,
the incentive for private attorneys to bring valid suit is greatly increased. This is exemplified
in the result of the Edwards case.
Although no actual damages were awarded, the result was in favor of the plaintiff. The jury
found that there was room in the theatre for the wheelchair, that the claimed. violation of
the fire ordinance was only a pretense, and by a nine to three vote, decided they would have
awarded $90,000 in damages, both compensatory and punitive. However, they refrained
from doing SO because they concluded that Marsh really wanted an injunction so that, in the
future, disabled persons would not be excluded from places of public amusement. They
assumed the judge would issue such a decree.
While the jury was deliberating, the judge, in the process of trying the equitable issues,
decided there was a present, speedy and adequate remedy at law (damages) and refused to
issue the injunction. The members of the jury, upon learning of the judge's decision, were
furious.
Mass Transit Cases
Personal liberty consists in a power of locomotion, of changing situations, or
removing one's person to whatever place one's own inclination may direct, without
imprisonment or restraint, unless by due course of law.
I.W. Blackstone, Commentaries 231
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 8
From the earliest times, it has been recognized that mobility is the key to social integration
and job flexibility, and a vital ingredient in a productive and useful life. It is not surprising,
therefore, that the second major target area of the disabled has been urban mass transit. The
inability to use mass transit affects every aspect of a disabled person's life. Without either a
private car or a very expensive van, a mobility-impaired person is often deprived of the
opportunity to go to school, to recreate, or to explore job opportunities. Without sufficient
education and flexibility in finding housing the disabled person may be relegated to a
non-productive life.
In 1973 a suit was filed in New York City to gain accessibility to the facilities and rolling
stock of the subway and urban mass transit systems. 17 It is only fitting that the first major
transportation suit should be brought in New York. New York City, with only four percent
of the population of the United States, accounts for almost thirty percent of the total
number of people who use public transportation. The New York suit is partly based on a
general constitutional attack on lack of accessibility for the disabled. Unlike some later
suits, the New York case asks for retroactive modification as well as improvements in future
design capabilities.
In recent months a long series of mass transit cases have been filed. In Seattle, Washington, a
state court judge ruled that it was not a violation of Washington State's anti-discrimination
law¹⁸ nor of the United States Constitution to fail to provide mass transit facilities for the
disabled. Suits have also been brought in California, 19 Hawaii,²⁰ Maryland, 21 Alabama, 22
Illinois² and Texas. By far, the most interesting case is the one filed against the Golden
Gate Bridge, Highway and Transit District in California²⁵ in late 1974. What is particularly
interesting about this case is that the judge's memorandum opinion upheld, at the demurrer
stage, two of six causes of action. After upholding the plaintiff at the demurrer stage, the
judge refused to give a preliminary injunction, but the case is going to trial on the two
upheld causes.
It is ironic that the San Francisco Bay area should be the home of one of the major mass
transit suits. After ten years of struggle by individuals, provider groups, and handicapped
consumers, the Bay Area Rapid Transit System (BART) was made accessible to the disabled.
Yet when the disabled arrive in downtown San Francisco they are faced with curbs
impossible to negotiate and an inability to use the Mass Transit System. Moreover, the
situation is not improved when one comes in from the Marin side of the Bay. For these
reasons, a suit was brought against the Golden Gate Bridge, Highway and Transit Authority.
This Transit Authority, like many others, recently applied for new buses under the Urban
Mass Transit Act of 1964. In that application, no special provisions were made for persons
in wheelchairs or who have substantial mobility difficulties because of age, lack of sight,
difficulty in hearing or lack of co-ordination. The San Rafael Indoor Sports Club brought
a class action to halt purchase of the new buses by the District. The suit was brought with
the help of Terry Ross, an attorney who had previous experience in the mental health
movement. The grounds for the lawsuit were only tangentially Constitutional; the major
thrust of the suit was statutory. First, it was claimed that lack of full accessibility to urban
mass transit violated the California Handicapped Civil Rights laws. In his ruling, the state
court judge found that this might state a valid cause of action since active discrimination by
a public entity was not necessary.
State of the Art / Achtenberg. / 9
Plaintiff's second cause of action was also sustained on demurrer. It was found that
California Government Code Section 4500 did not cover this situation. This particular code
section states that rapid mass transit system accessibility is not required on incidental
equipment until such equipment is available from two or more sources. The judge found
that the operation of buses is more than incidental to the operation of a bridge, highway
and transportation district.
The third cause of action involved section 504 of the 1973 Rehabilitation Act. Plaintiff
contended that the policy against discrimination found in this Act required that government
entities make specific provisions for those in wheelchairs or with severe mobility problems.
The court rejected this argument by noting that Section 502, Title 29 U.S.C. 792 mandated
the creation of the Architectural and Transportation Barrier Compliance Board. One of the
duties of the Board was to consider ways to meet the travel expenses of those who were not
able to use mass transit systems. The court interpreted this to mean that Congress did not
intend mass transit to be available to everyone, and therefore the severely handicapped
could not judicially compel transportation systems to meet their needs under the Act.
Plaintiffs' fourth cause of action was based on policies enunciated in the Urban Mass Transit
Act of 1964. The court said that the UMTA only declared a national policy, and therefore
did not create a cause of action for which relief could be granted.
The Marin judge found as a matter of law that it was not unreasonable to treat the disabled
as a separate class under both the California and federal constitutions. He noted that the
statutes relied upon for the previous causes of action were specifically designed to promote
state action which would afford the disabled special status and protection.
The last point considered by the judge dealt with damages. He found that Section 55 of the
California Civil Code only allowed reasonable attorney's fees for injunctive relief. He said
that neither Sections 55 nor 54 created a private right of action for actual damages. The
Golden Gate Transit case represents a preliminary, partial victory for the disabled.
Two other mass transit cases illustrate the extremes in the usefulness of litigation to the
disabled. A lawsuit, or the threat thereof, can produce social change. This is indicated by the
consent decree entered in a Baltimore mass transit action. 26 In this case, the Mass Transit
Authority of Baltimore, Maryland, the Department of Transportation for the State of
Maryland, and the Federal Urban Mass Transit Administration consented to a memorandum
of understanding wherein defendants, in return for plaintiffs' dismissing suit, agreed to
modify the 209 new buses by installing hand rails, vertical stanchions and stepwell lights. In
addition they agreed to reserve and mark three seats behind the driver in all buses for the
elderly and handicapped and to purchase ten new buses specially equipped to accommodate
persons confined to wheelchairs.
On the other hand, a right to transit case in the Alabama federal district court²⁷ was a
complete disaster. The Judge ruled that section 16(a) of the Urban Mass Transit Act did not
require installation of facilities for those in wheelchairs, provided that some effort had been
made by the transit authority to make it easier on the walking disabled. In this instance, the
bus company had included such items as stanchions, grab rails and power assisted doors. In
effect the judge's ruling was that a mere good faith effort to implement the declared
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 10
national policy of aiding the disabled in transportation was sufficient. The judge found that
there were no adequate, presently available buses designed for those with severe disability
problems, even though medium sized buses are available from several companies. The judge
further stated:
Modern technology has not progressed to the point of doing more for these people
than is already being done by B.J.C.T.A. (Birmingham-Jefferson County Transit
Authority). In fact under the present state of available bus technology
it would
seem inherently unreasonable to bring all new bus procurements to a halt while new
equipment is being designed, developed, tested, and produced.
The federal judge stated that neither section 504 of the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 nor the
equal protection clause of the Federal Constitution were offended by the actions of the
Jefferson County transit Authority. The judge reasoned that the statute was not applicable
since the Authority did not deny handicapped people access to buses if they were able to
get on board with assistance. Therefore, a person was not being denied his rights solely by
reason of his handicap, and there was thus no need to cut off federal funding. Moreover, in
response to the equal protection arguments, the court found that there was no unconstitu-
tional deprivation and discrimination provided that plaintiffs were not being prohibited
from riding on the bus, and that any lack of equal access to the bus came rather from
defendant's failure to affirmatively provide vehicles designed for the disabled.
A major reason for the rash of transportation suits is that the just-announced tentative
regulations of the Urban Mass Transportation Administration contain no special provisions
for those in wheelchairs, those who cannot get through narrow front doors or those who
cannot use high steps. 28
Another instance in which a federal agency has not made adequate provisions through
rule-making for the disabled is found in the airline situation. At the present time the Federal
Aviation Administration (FAA) has still not issued permanent provisions that impose a duty
on all interstate airlines to serve the severely disabled.
Therefore, airlines' pilots and officers have had extensive discretion in determining whether
to allow the disabled on airplanes. The theory behind this discretion is that the disabled are
more likely to be hurt in a crash or will take up the valuable time of flight personnel in an
emergency. This first theory disregards the disabled person's own willingness to take the risk
of such danger. Each airline has instituted its own policy. This led to a famous incident in
which an aide to a United States Senator was forcibly ejected from an airplane and then
arrested because she was in a wheelchair, and possessed no doctor's certificate stating that
she could care for herself. She filed suit claiming discrimination and false arrest. 29 This suit
has been dismissed at least temporarily, because the federal judge ruled that the Civil
Aeronautics Board had primary jurisdiction and that all administrative remedies had not
been exhausted.
In terms of future litigation, the new proposed federal regulations may not improve the
situation greatly. Under the proposed regulations, only as many disabled persons as there are
emergency exits will be allowed on any flight. No disabled person will be allowed to sit near
an emergency exit. Only one person confined to a litter and accompanied by an attendant
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 11
will be allowed on each plane. Another drawback of the proposed regulations is its
definition of a handicapped person as "a person who may need the assistance of another
person to expeditiously move to an exit in the event of an emergency evacuation. As
stated by Senator Tunney, this definition is "so vague and general that anyone from one's
grandmother to a skier with a sprained ankle could be classed as handicapped."³¹
Education Cases
Several decades ago most states made no provision for educating the orthopedically disabled
or the retarded. Then through a series of campaigns by such organizations as The Easter Seal
Society and by parents themselves, a series of laws were passed which required educational
programs for these persons. 32 However, in many instances these educational "advances"
have resulted in "handicapped ghettos." Students often arise at 5:00 a.m. in order to be
bused fifty, sixty, even seventy miles to attend school in centrally located, specially adapted
institutions. In order to avoid the expense of modifying the architectural plans of local
schools, many districts have decided to bus students with all types of disabilities to such
special schools. Some students, of course, need intensive and constant care so that there is
no practical way to integrate them into the normal school population. However, for others
who are less severely disabled and only confined to wheelchairs or who have balance
problems, yet are of normal or superior intelligence, this refusal to adapt the educational
environment to their requirements has resulted in social and intellectual isolation.
Although there are presently no cases directly on the issue of "appropriate education" for
the orthopedically disabled, analogies can be drawn to cases found in relation to the
mentally retarded and the deaf. In the case of Mills V. Board of Education, 33 it was
specifically found that the constitution required that exceptional children be publicly
educated. Of course to say that one must be educated is not to say one must be educated in
a certain environment. However, the implications of the black school integration cases and
the federal policy of integration for the disabled would seem to be clear. A physically
impaired child would presumably learn better, have less stigma, and be better socially
adjusted to ultimate employment and community life if he were not exclusively in the
company of those similarly situated. Just as it has been necessary that blacks come into
contact with whites so that the white population may adjust to living with minorities, it is
valuable for the future co-employee of the disabled person to meet him first at the
childhood rather than at the adult level.
Two potential cases dealing with the educational problems of the deaf³⁴ also raise the issue
of segregation versus integration. In the potential Utah case, it will be contended that deaf
students, who must communicate in sign language, should not be put in a totally different
educational tract or totally segregated from those who use the normal verbal tract. At
present, the students are not even allowed to mingle at lunch time or in after-school
activities. In Ohio, a legal action may evolve because of a state statute³⁵ which says that all
students must begin school in a verbal modality. The statute also requires a testing program
after the first year. However, this testing program has never been fully funded and, as a
result, many deaf or partially deaf students have lost educational opportunities or have
become so frustrated that they have left school.
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 12
Employment
In an earlier age the only purpose of rehabilitation was preparation for the job market.
Although there is language in the 1973 Vocational Rehabilitation Act and the 1974
Amendments thereto, recognizing the need for providing services for those with non-
vocational goals, even today it is easier to justify architectural barrier modifications and
special admissions procedures to schools and universities if put in terms of improved job
placement opportunities. There is more resistance to these programs for the disabled when
one speaks of them merely in terms of "improving the quality of life."
Many states have included the disabled under their Fair Employment Practices Acts. Many
of these state statutes are so recent that there are no regulations or criteria for determining
when disability in fact disqualifies someone from employment.
In the first nine months during which they were covered under the California Fair
Employment Practices Act, the disabled initiated about eight percent of the complaints filed
(212 out of 3110). 36 The settlement rate on these cases (44 percent) was seventeen percent
higher than in all other unlawful discrimination cases. The handicapped who initiated these
actions included those with limited vision, mild epilepsy, heart conditions, very severe back
problems, and hearing deficiencies.
The administrative mechanism provided by the California Fair Employment Practices
Commission is preferable to the situation that existed prior to the Act's coverage of the
disabled. For example, before such coverage, well qualified people who were confined to
wheelchairs or had difficulty standing for extended periods of time were summarily denied
teaching jobs. It was necessary for disabled to go to the state legislature to lobby SO that the
qualified disabled could obtain teaching positions. It is a sad commentary that in the year
1974 a law must be passed which mandates that no person is to be denied the right to
receive training or to practice teaching in any school solely because of his physical handicap
or physical deformity.³
Even with these laws, substantial difficulties remain. For example, a co-ordinator of
handicapped services at Los Angeles Valley Junior College³ found it necessary to threaten
to obtain the opinion of the Junior College's attorney to convince the Board of Trustees to
allow him to hire a deaf, somewhat spastic office manager and secretary.
The 1973 Vocational Rehabilitation Act requires that those who contract with the Federal
government must initiate affirmative action hiring policies. The first set of regulations were
vague. 39 Many institutions, such as the Bank of America, began to develop their affirmative
action hiring policy for the disabled without much assurance that their efforts would
conform to the Federal regulations. 40
In August, 1975, the Employment Standards Administration of the Department of Labor
issued proposed permanent regulations. 41 These regulations are meant to provide govern-
ment contractors with more detailed guidelines as well as to make the new affirmative
action hiring and promotion policies conform to the broader definition of "handicap"
found in the 1974 Amendments to the 1973 Act.
There is, at present, a lack of legal precedent and a dearth of authoritatively interpreted
regulations at both the federal and state level. This, combined with the fact that contested
State of the Art / Achtenberg / /13
cases heard before Fair Employment Practices Commissions may take from nine months to
three years before final disposition, indicates a substantial need for "watch dog" legal aid
societies. Their function would be to protect the employment rights of the disabled, and to
furnish input into the administrative process.
Critical Need for Ongoing Legal Expertise
Constitutional theories, case law and arguments for more stringent enforcement of presently
existing laws have been around for many years. Because the disabled have long had to rely
upon over-worked legal aid societies and pro bono time donated by socially interested
attorneys, court actions have been minimal. However, times are changing. The disabled are
developing a series of organizations to bring continuous legal expertise to bear.
A year ago a pilot project was begun in Philadelphia, Pennsylvania, which has resulted in the
formation of a legal aid society for the elderly and disabled. On June 1, 1975, the final
formation of that society was assured through a series of private grants and the financial
backing of the Pennsylvania Rehabilitation Department. The head of the project, Thomas
Gilhool, represented the plaintiff in one of the most famous of the mentally retarded
children's education cases.⁴²
In Michigan, and again at George Washington University in Washington, D.C., funding has
been obtained to carry out legal projects and to institute law suits on behalf of the deaf. The
National Center for Law and the Handicapped has indicated that it will soon change its
emphasis from the legal problems of the retarded to those of the physically impaired.
In California there have been several developments. The San Francisco Bar Association has
been approached for funding for a legal aid society for the disabled and mentally-
incompetent, and the Disabled Peoples Legal Resource Center has been founded in
Berkeley. This Berkeley project, still embryonic, has concentrated so far on individual case
counseling at the paralegal level.
In Los Angeles, the A. Milton Miller Memorial Foundation has been funded to conduct a
feasibility study for the State Department of Rehabilitation. The hoped-for result of that
study will be an advocacy organization named the Western Center on Law and the
Handicapped.
It is logical that legal aid societies for the disabled should develop in several states and that
one of the first legal aid societies should be in California. California has over twenty million
people. Its better-than-average weather combined with its reputation as a land of
opportunity would lead one to believe that a disproportionately high number of the
disabled live within its borders. Added to this, the Golden State has a well-developed
network of private associations serving the handicapped. Recently, these associations have
been joined by "consumer groups" such as the Disabled Student Unions found on each of
the nineteen state college campuses. The mental health system in California, as well as the
state hospital system for the mentally ill, has been very progressive and its precedents and
ideas (such as California's highly developed community treatment system for the mentally
ill) will provide analogies for legal actions affecting the physically disabled.
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 14
The California state court system is widely reputed to be the most progressive in the nation,
making it possible to obtain for the disabled significant progress through judicial decisions.
This is particularly important at a time when the attitude of the United States Supreme
Court towards the rights of minorities is in substantial doubt.
California has been ahead of most states in legislating for the disabled. Enforcement,
however, has been sporadic. A legal aid society is needed to help set forth enforcement
criteria which presumably will be widely initiated throughout the country.
The San Francisco and Los Angeles Bar Associations have shown substantial interest in the
rights of the physically disabled. The law schools at the University of Southern California,
the University of California at Berkeley, University of Santa Clara, Golden Gate University
and University of San Fernando Valley College of Law have expressed interest in a seminar
on rights of the disabled. These institutions may well act as a valuable resource and the
Center may well provide a valuable training ground for law students. Moreover, the School
of Social Welfare and School of Gerontology at the University of Southern California are
interested in the project.
The most important justification for any legal aid society is that it may prevent litigation
and the waste of many resources. Never again will a building official of a major California
city feel justified in saying, in a flippant manner, that the disabled should sue him if they
don't like the way he is enforcing the architectural barrier laws.
Jack Achtenberg
Attorney at Law
University of San Fernando Valley
College of Law
8353 Sepulveda Blvd.
Sepulveda, Calif. 91343
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 15
References
1. Robert L. Marsh, Jr. V. Edwards Theatre Circuit, No. C 55,376 (L.A. County Super. Ct., June 16,
1975) [hereinafter referred to as the Edwards case]. This case is presently on appeal. The author was
"of counsel" in the original Superior Court trial.
2.
42 U.S.C. Sections 4151-52 (1968)
3. President's Committee on Employment of the Handicapped, Analysis of Collected Data on
Legislation and Standards of 50 States and the District of Columbia Concerning Laws Requiring That
Buildings and Facilities be Accessible to Handicapped Persons (June 1975). The study sets forth a
chart delineating those states which have provisions for accessibility in publicly financed, publicly
used and privately financed buildings. A more detailed analysis, including a notation to the relevant
state code sections, is available in the latest edition of President's Committee on the Handicapped, A
Survey of State Laws to Remove Barriers, Washington, D.C. 20210.
4. California Civil Rights Statutes affecting the Disabled are found in Cal. Civ. Code Sections 54-55
(West Supp. 1975).
5. Washington's Civil Rights Statutes affecting the Disabled are found in Rev. Code of Wash. Ann.
(Supp. 1975), Sections 49.60.010, 49.60.030, and 49.60.040.
6. Rehabilitation Act of 1973, Section 504, 29 U.S.C. Section 794.
7. Pennsylvania Association for Retarded Children V. Commonwealth of Pennsylvania, 343 F. Supp. 279
(E.D. Pa. 1972).
8. Mills V. Board of Education of the District of Columbia, 348 F. Supp. 866 (D.D.C. 1972).
9. People V. Smuggler's Inn, Associated Hosts, Inc., No. 251428 (Sacramento County Super. Ct,, March
1, 1975) [hereinafter referred to as the Smuggler's Inn case].
10. No state has architectural barrier laws that require retroactive modifications of pre-existing structures.
However, in the two Ohio cases, buildings were modified even though they were in existence before
the architectural barrier laws were passed. See Consent Decree, Wargowsky V. Novak, Civil No.
C-72-138 (N.D. Ohio, March 30, 1973); Friedman V. County of Cuyahoga, No. 895961.
11. Washington Urban League, Inc. V. Washington Metropolitan Transit Authority, Inc., Civil No. 776-72
(D.D.C. 1973).
12. Jacqueline Selph V. City Council of L.A., Civil No. CV7448-DWW (C.D. Cal., filed March 20, 1974).
13. Disabled Student Union, et al. V. Board of Trustees, et al., Civil No. 692-231 (S.F., Cal. Super. Ct.,
July 1, 1975). Case cite received from the lawyer of record, Mr. Mark Himmelstein.
14. Brown V. Board of Education of Topeka, 347 U.S. 483 (1954).
15. Edwards case, supra, note 1.
16. In re Cox, 3 Cal. 3d 205, 474 P.2d, 992, 90 Cal. Rptr. 24 (1970) [hereinafter referred to as Cox].
17. Roni Stier V. New York City Transit Authority (S.D.N.Y. 1973).
18. John A. Martin V. Seattle King County Metropolitan Transit Commission, No. 795,806 (King County,
Wash. Super. Ct., filed April 25, 1975). The judge ruled against the disabled client on June 30, 1975,
according to a letter from the attorney of record, William L. E. Dussault. The case is on appeal.
19. Bohlke V. Golden Gate Bridge, Highway & Transportation Dist., Memorandum and Minute Order No.
73362 (Marin County, Cal. Super. Ct., May 9, 1975) [hereinafter cited as the Golden Gate case].
20. Abilities Unlimited V. UMTA, Civil No. 75-000! (D.Hawaii, January 2, 1975).
21. Disabled in Action of Baltimore V. Harry R. Hughes, Civil No. 74-1069-HM (D.Md., October 30,
1974).
22. Jane Snowden V. Birmingham-Jefferson County Transit Authority, Civil No. 75-G-330-S (N.D. Ala.
State of the Art / Achtenberg / 16
filed June 24, 1975) "mem."
23. Lloyd & Wolfe V. Illinois Regional Transportation Authority & the Chicago Transit Authority, Civil
No. 75C-1834 (N.D.III., filed June 6, 1975).
24. Might V. Briscoe, Civil No. A 75 CA 31 (W.D.Tex. April 15, 1975).
25. Supra, note 19.
26. Supra, note 21.
27. Supra, note 22.
28. The tentative regulations are found at 40 Fed. Reg. 8314 (1975). According to an interview with Ms.
Diane Bartols, law student intern and employee on Handicapped Affairs for the Southern California
Association of Governments, in Los Angeles, California, September 5, 1975, the final regulations will
not be issued until some time in late December.
29. Judith Heumann V. National Airlines, Inc., Civil N. 75-1046 (D.D.C. 1975).
30. The proposed F.A.A. regulations are found in 39 Fed. Reg. 24667, 24668-69 (1974).
31. The remarks of Senator Tunney are found in Heumann, "Flying Not So High," pt. II, 2, The
Independent 2-4 (house organ for Berkeley's Center for Independent Living) (1975).
32. E.G., Cal. Educ. Code Sections 895.4, 895.5 (West 1969).
33. Supra, note 8.
34. These potential cases were brought to the author's attention by Mr. Raymond Jones, Director for the
Center for Deafness at California State University, Northridge, during a Board of Directors meeting of
the A. Milton Miller Memorial Foundation, on August 17, 1975. The Utah situation is still only in the
talking stages. The Ohio case was scheduled to be filed in late October, 1975.
35. Ohio Rev. Code Sections 3323.06 (1973).
36. Governor's Committee on Employment of the Handicapped, Dept. of Industrial Relations, Div. of
Fair Employment Practices, State of California, News From FEPC (May 7, 1975).
37. Cal. Educ. Code Sections 13168.1-2 (West 1974).
38. Interview with George Kopoulos, Coordinator for the Handicapped Student Affairs, in Sepulveda,
California, April 22, 1975.
39. In 39 Fed. Reg. 20566-71 (1974), the Dept. of Labor Employment Standards Administration
formally notified government contractors that they would need to have anti-discrimination clauses
relating to the handicapped in all solicitations after July 11, 1974 and in all contracts executed after
October 11, 1974. These interim regulations do not have specific guidelines for the contractor. The
author of the regulations effectively minimized their long term impact because he requests that
interested persons submit comments, suggestions, data or arguments, and specifically states that
"material thus submitted will be evaluated and acted upon in the same manner as if this document
were a proposal," id. 20566.
40. Interview with a Bank of America official, at a meeting of the San Fernando Valley College
Employment of the Handicapped Committee, April 6, 1975.
41. The new proposed regulations are found at 40 Fed. Reg. 39887 (1975). Comments on these new
criteria were to be accepted until October 13, 1975.
42. Supra, note 7.
SEXUALITY AND INDEPENDENT LIVING SKILLS
Neil Jacobson
Why live independently? With so much time and attention being put into teaching the
physically disabled how to live independently, one rarely asks why. The reasons can be
found to be the same as those which propel us to do anything. It feels good
it's desirous
it's in line with our self-image. What's my definition of self-image? The way a person
perceives him/herself. To perceive is to see. In looking at ourselves, the first thing we see is a
body. Is it deformed, is it revolting? Does it disturb and nauseate us, or is it handsome? Do
we like what we see and do we take proper care of it? How do we want others to handle it?
Do we enjoy and appreciate its existence, or is that irrelevant? These considerations are
vitally important to those who contemplate living independently. When we realize that these
are the concerns of a sexual being as well, we have begun to establish the correlations
between sexuality and independent living.
It is my premise that independent living develops the individual's sexuality. Conversely,
sexuality can propel one towards independent living skills. In examining this cycle from
independence to sex and back again, a person must realize that this exchange does not
describe the situation for all disabled people. Some never experience sex while enjoying
independence, and still others live their entire lives in sheltered environments and are
sexually active. This paper does not attempt to explain each conceivable combination, but
simply addresses itself to the situations where sex may affect the independence of the
physically disabled.
Independent living presumes an environment in which the disabled person has control over
his/her care. It is a place which allows him to care for himself as much as he is.capable of or
wants to, and gives him the freedom to hire (and fire) his own attendants who do the rest.
In this environment he can come or go as he pleases. A pre-independent environment is one
in which the primary care for a person rests with others. Parents' home, a hospital, or a
home run by a hired staff are defined as pre-independent.
Independent living also presumes the existence of role-models. Role-models are other
disabled people who are living independently. They are highly important. In the course of a
single day, disabled people are bombarded with stereotypes. If these are all negative, it is
difficult to maintain a healthy self view. At times it is vital to have people around who have
been through it to remind you who you are and what you can be. Other disabled people can
best demonstrate how to better one's psychological perspective, as well as one's physical
environment.
The stereotypes I'm speaking of are the assumptions made of the disabled by the public, and
by disabled people themselves. Consider the following statement taken from an article
written by a psychologist:
1
State of the Art / Jacobson / 2
Sexual maturity brings and symbolizes independence-to have sexual relations and
intercourse and to produce children of one's own. But the severely physically
handicapped can never be independent, they will always depend on others.
The same author goes on to state
sex education [for the disabled]
...
for what?" In an
era where the sexual attitudes of the majority are slowly changing, and at a time when
people are presumably becoming more sensitive to the needs of the physically disabled, it is
amazing to find statements such as these. It is frankly alarming to encounter article upon
article insinuating that the disabled are sick, unhealthy, and broken facsimiles of a human
being.
We still hear of parents telling disabled children that they are odd, disgusting, or ugly-or
psychologists recommending to clients that they should sublimate their sexual drive, stop
hoping for mates, forget marriage, children, or a "normal life." We are being made aware of
institutions that punish patients for accommodating their sexuality. Patients have been
placed in solitary confinement for masturbating or petting in a dark corner of the hospital.
Some recommend the sterilization of physically disabled persons. Medical doctors have told
some of their disabled clients that they are sterile when the truth is that nothing is wrong
with their reproductive organs.
Such misinformation may be alleviated some day through the hard work and persistence of
disabled people. But there are subtler stereotypes which are much more difficult to combat.
Can we change the mass media's representation of beauty? By depicting Mr. America as the
muscled he-man, and Ms. America as the tall, beautiful walkie, we not only exclude the
wheelchair-bound person, but we imply by comparison that there is something wrong with
him/her. The national passion for young athletic-looking people running hand-in-hand into
the forest at sunset may be depressing to those who fall short of that description. It can be
devastating to the blind or disabled person who comes to feel that sex can never be a reality.
Sex, this beautiful, far out thing, isn't to be enjoyed by those who aren't "beautiful."
It is too often inferred that sex for the disabled can only be a head trip. There are
counselors who tell a client that since his/her body is non-functional (a subjective point of
view), he/she may imagine what sex can be like and be content with that. Again, from the
previously quoted article: Sex in the head titillates without fulfilling. But to the
handicapped person, the body is scarcely something that gives pleasure
It, is the rare
and unusual person who can appreciate sex solely through the imagination. Sex includes the
body as well as the mind, and if you are uncomfortable with your body, sex will probably
provide little pleasure.
Other stereotypes center around the disabled as a group. Some assume that all disabled
people have tactile problems. Others assume that all disabled people lack sensation in their
genital areas, or have problems with their reproductive organs. In reality, with 10% of the
population classified as disabled, it is impossible to draw any definite conclusions about the
disabled on the whole. Still, an insidious pattern of "encouragement" emerges whereby the
disabled individual is never allowed to accept himself.
For example, Cerebral Palsied people are told that being disabled is all right, but that they
should work towards looking as straight as the spinal cord injured quad, while the quad is
told to copy the example of the paraplegic, who is in turn made to envy the movements of a
post-polio, etc. etc. This twisted hierarchy can lead to many misconceptions, and is as
State of the Art / Jacobson / 3
counterproductive as the stereotypes held by the public. Favoritism based on this hierarchy
is common in institutions, where the higher up one is on the scale of acceptability, the
better care one can expect to receive. The person on the lower end of this scale is faced with
more prejudice, and it becomes more difficult to achieve a good body-image and the
ultimate goal of independence.
Assuming that a person does have a low body-image, it is likely that he is less concerned
with his body's wellbeing. There is less to motivate the person to be well-groomed, well-fed,
healthy, and otherwise well-cared for. Why worry about the possibility of bed sores, bladder
or kidney infections? Who cares about getting out of bed, making money, going places? The
sexually active individual does care. Just knowing that someone thinks you are attractive.
Knowing that someone wants to be with you and hold you and love you-gives you a reason
to get out of bed. The rest follows, for an individual is going to have to strive for
independence to be with that other person. The selection of an attendant becomes
important because someone else is looking at you. Mastering other skills enabling a person
to get out and around and ultimately rely less on others, becomes important to the sexually
active person. This situation can even stimulate the desire for a vocation and financial
security, since the individual is living not only for himself, but for those who love him as
well.
At this point, we are confronted with an ironic development. On one hand, the disabled
person is hit by stereotypes which generally label him weird and asexual. These stereotypes
indicate that his sexual desires are incompatible with his "situation," something subjectively
defined by the public. On the other hand, sex may prove the inspiration behind his desire to
live independently, by giving him a reason to care for his body and his needs. The disabled
person comes to think better of himself, and so do others. I would like to discuss, then,
several paths which lead to sexual activity and independent living.
An important step lies in sex education. One of the major obstacles to sexual activity is
simply not knowing how to go about it. For the congenitally disabled, sex education is
often completely ignored. Whereas the non-disabled can learn about sex from their peers,
disabled people who are unable to get out are not exposed to this information. It is
extremely important that sex education be available to the disabled. Apart from specific
questions relating to the nature of one's own disability, and its effects or special
considerations, sex education need differ little from that offered to the non-disabled. For
instance, a Cerebral Palsied person may want to know what to do to reduce spasms, or what
positions would be better suited than the classic missionary which might be difficult to
maneuver. For these reasons, other disabled people are valuable because of their personal
experience. This leads back to role-models.
For the spinal cord injured and other disabilities where the physiology might change, a
special kind of sex education is in order. For those who have grown up in a society
non-disabled until later in life, myriad stereotypes might be broken. Take, for example, the
stereotype of Mr. and Ms. America-Beautiful, the restriction to genital sex, and the idea that
sex is goal-oriented with the winner attaining the big O in the sky. Although all of these
sentiments have an adverse effect on the populace as a whole, the need to disprove them is
magnified for the newly disabled.
State of the Art / Jacobson / 4
Similarly, limiting one's goal to the satisfaction of one's partner is another misconception.
Just as we learn that there is no Santa Claus, we learn in sex that it is not just enough to
give, but you need to know how to receive as well. We want to pleasure our partner, and our
partner will generally want to pleasure us. So, what makes our body feel good? What are our
erogenous zones? They include more than just our genitals. Both partners deserve to attain
peak satisfaction, whatever that might be. With the newly disabled, as with the congenitally
disabled, role-models are called for. It's one thing for a non-disabled doctor to tell a spinal
cord injured person not to concern himself with the lack of sensation in the genital area, it is
another thing for a disabled person to explain how he/she experiences the same orgasmic
feeling from stimulation of non-genital areas as he/she experienced before his/her accident.
Sex education must also give accurate information. The era of telling women that they need
only lie there is over. The era of telling disabled men and women that they are sterile
because of their disability (when it isn't true) is over, and so is the denial of one's own
sexuality. Imagine the doctor who tells spinal cord injured patients that the feelings of
orgasm which they experience are "phantom orgasms." One must question whether if the
phantom orgasm exists, why more people don't go around "phantomizing" their orgasms.
The word phantom does little more than belittle the pleasure that one can achieve.
Before the disabled person can become sexually active, he must gain social confidence. This
is crucial, as it is necessary to know how to approach a potential partner. For many
congenitally disabled, because they have been raised in isolation, the opportunities for
learning social skills are limited. Growing up in this manner, a person tends to find that they
have little in common with their peers. Not being in the streets with other children, disabled
people may not know the accepted means of meeting other people. Some disabled people
are so afraid of being rejected, that they take no risks and remain isolated. Still others, who
may really believe that they are inferior, take unnecessary risks. When they are refused, they
view the refusal as rejection, or a denial, and in turn re-enforce the negative self-image that
keeps them isolated. By talking to other disabled people, one can learn from the experience
of others what may or may not be appropriate behavior. During one-to-one encounters, two
people can share and learn from each other. Group counseling has also proven itself in
teaching socialization skills.
There still remains the phenomenon of understanding intellectually the procedures in sex
and socialization, and not being able to put them into practice. It's the old saw about
knowing what to do, but finding that it is something else to do it.
Masturbation can be the first step in this problem. As was aforementioned, if you don't
know what makes you feel good, no one else will. Masturbation and the exploration of a
person's own body, without the pressure of performing, may lead one to really discover that
his body does feel good. For the first time, a person may be receiving pleasure from his
body instead of seeing it as an object that others are always throwing around and working
on. Masturbation is sometimes felt by an individual to be the most pleasurable act in sex,
even when other avenues are available. If sex is for pleasure, then there is no reason to
separate masturbation from the rest and deny one's self this form of pleasure.
Another way of bridging the gap between talking about sex and taking part in it, is via the
use of surrogates. For many people, disabled or not, the fear of performance breakdown is
intense. Surrogates may provide that form of confidence needed before one pursues a
State of the Art / Jacobson / 5
relationship. As was indicated before, disabled people may want to experiment with
different forms of sex, positions, etc. Surrogates who may be experienced with disabled
people can offer new ideas and actually give the man or woman suggestions as to how to
maneuver. In this society, where sex is talked about so much, it is common for disabled
people to develop grandiose ideas about what sex actually is. If these ideas grow further out
of proportion, he/she may not be able to find a partner or be satisfied working under such
misconceptions. Surrogates can be utilized here to put sex back into its proper perspective
while showing that pleasure is indeed possible. Surrogates can be used to garner feedback on
certain socialization skills as well. Although it is only one person reacting to another, it is
important to receive immediate recognition of one's efforts. It is highly recommended that
surrogates be used in conjunction with counseling. This assures that practical knowledge is
accompanied by cognitive knowledge.
Disabled people may also learn from homosexual and bisexual individuals who have also had
the courage to call society at its game. If sex is not merely a baby-producing function, with
this paper presuming that it is not, then we must consider it an ignorant societal more which
prohibits men from loving men and women from loving women. It is more important for
people to pursue those feelings that reenforce their sense of well-being than it is for them to
succumb to the same sorts of stereotypes that we have been and are continuing to fight.
It must be said that no one is advocating that all disabled people engage in any or all of the
aforementioned situations with respect to sexual experiences. To feel pressured into
situations where one is not comfortable (homosexuality, oral sex, etc.) merely replaces one
restriction with another. Just as there are stereotypes relating to disability, a disabled person
must be aware of the stereotypes relating to sex-that sex is a straightforward, missionary,
heterosexual experience. The simple point is, one should not limit oneself to what others
expect, either in terms of ability or sexuality.
Another avenue to sexual activity can be found in counseling. I have alluded to counseling
earlier, but would like to speak of three major approaches. The predominant form of
counseling available to the disabled today is that of peer-counseling, which brings us back to
the use of role-models. Once again, it is my firm belief that most disabled people do not
have the debilitating problems affixed to them by society, but rather lack the confidence
and the simple know-how that enables them to become sexually active. A peer is the most
effective and logical choice for providing the confidence and information based on accurate
experience rather than second-hand stereotyped subjectivity. Of course, all sexually active
disabled people are not necessarily good peer counselors. In fact, it is common that the
disabled individual who has "made it" may lack the necessary empathy to make him an
effective counselor. I also believe that non-disabled persons can learn to be peer counselors
(insofar as age is concerned) and do a fine job as well. Groups led by one or more individuals
have proven their worth. Some people feel better in situations where they can share
common experiences with others. Group counseling often assures the individual that his
experiences are neither as unique nor as horrifying as he may have felt. In addition, group
counseling may provide the positive feedback of several people, which might prove more
reassuring than the feedback from a single person. Finally, professional counseling, whether
it is psychotherapeutic or behavioralist, has been valuable to some disabled people. But once
again, as past attitudes have shown us on the part of professionals, there is a need for more
disabled people in the professional realm.
State of the Art / Jacobson / 6
Not all disabled people either need or benefit from counseling. Some people need time alone
to figure things out for themselves, while others do need a peer counselor. Others may need
the catharsis of a group in order to benefit, while still others feel most secure in the
treatment of a professional. All three should be made available, even if none need be used.
The belief that positive attitudes need no reenforcement is naive. The person in the
institution who is punished for sucking his finger, or the individual placed in solitary
confinement, or the couple who find themselves without dinner when caught petting, may
find themselves unable to sustain any positive feeling towards themselves and their
sexuality. The person locked in his parents' home who is disallowed a wheelchair will very
likely forget those social skills he may have learned. If a disabled person has no place or
opportunity to practice what he has learned, it tends to follow that he will forget or lose his
confidence in his prior ability. It is crucial that an effort be mounted to educate the
professionals and the parents of the disabled.
The disabled themselves are well-suited to do just that. In the process of educating these two
groups, the three major forms of counseling once again prove worthwhile. One-to-one peer
counseling, group endeavors, and professionals (speaking to either parents or other
professionals) can all be used. The disabled should expand their role in this area, and
although programs have begun, more are needed.
In any discussion of sex, marriage and divorce can be topics of consideration. Just as
marriage can be an asset to the sexually active, it can also be a hindrance. Many disabled
people have married and are leading happy lives. Their sexuality is reported to be
satisfactory, and each strives to give and receive. With marriage it is once again not necessary
to follow the rules predetermined by society. Marriages following the stereotype of
man-as-breadwinner and woman-as-housewife-and-child-bearer are probably in for rough
times when disability is introduced into the picture.
When one of the spouses becomes disabled during the course of a marriage, one of the most
important factors in determining the continued future of that marriage lies in the pre-existent
conditions. Those families who have weathered crises together, have shared responsibilities,
react to the introduction of disability in a more calm and realistic fashion. Reports have
demonstrated that it was the couple's ability to share responsibility and the stress of crises,
not the severity of disability, the lack of mobility, the lack of sensation, the inability to
work, that proved most instrumental in sustaining the marriage. It was further found that
just as the disabled individual needs accurate information concerning his/her sexuality, so
the spouse of that person required the same information. It is important that the
non-disabled marriage partner not be relegated to an attendant. I am not implying that the
spouse not do any attendant-type work, but rather that a distinction be made between
attendant and lover, and that the non-disabled spouse's feelings in that area be respected. A
newly disabled individual can become in some respects a different person. His body may
function differently, his ideas and beliefs may be altered, and his aspirations, interests, and
experiences may change as a result of this change. Spouses may or may not be able to go
along with these changes in the disabled lover, and divorce might (and does) occur.
The social mores that accompany divorce affect disabled people in much the same way.
Divorce tends to be viewed as a failure, and one to be avoided at all costs. In some cases,
divorce is the best answer, allowing for greater independence and happiness for both
State of the Art / Jacobson / 7
partners. No one advocates divorce as a means toward independence. However, any obstacle
to happiness or independence must be examined, whether it is being confined to an
institution, a parent's home, a spouse's home, or whatever, less it lead to inactivity and
loneliness.
Some disabled people sublimate their sexuality, and put their energy into unrelated
activities. They might, for instance, become so extremely hard-working that they have
neither the time nor the energy to pursue a social life. In one way, such a situation may
serve to relax certain fears. Sometimes the knowledge that he/she is involved with work and
doesn't have time for sex can enable a person to relax barriers and it becomes easier to meet
people since there is no implied sexual desire. The mere coming into contact with other
people may lead a person into sexual activity. Still, such a result of sublimating sex drives
and turning to work occurs in but a minority of cases. For most, this denial of sexuality is
only a self-imposed rationalization (I'm too busy) rather than an indirect approach to sexual
realization.
People must definitely progress at their own rate, and for some, a period of sublimation
might be needed even if it creates frustration. Everyone reserves the right to go at his own
rate, and accomplish things at his own rate in his own way. What has preceded merely points
out different avenues towards a certain goal-that of sexual activity.
Having discussed several ways in which disabled people approach the problem of sexual
activity, and after having shown how sexuality can affect independent living (and
vice-versa), there is only one conclusion to be drawn. Disabled individuals can and are
becoming independent and are taking control over their own lives. Furthermore, disabled
individuals can be sexually active, gaining pleasure from their bodies and giving pleasure to
others. When we see this happening all around us, the question of how, why, where, and for
what becomes secondary.
Neil Jacobson
Instructor/Administrator
Computer Programmer Training
Center for Independent Living
2539 Telegraph Ave.
Berkeley, Calif.
CENTER FOR INDEPENDENT LIVING IN NEW YORK
A RESIDENTIAL CENTER FOR THE ELDERLY BLIND
Douglas Inkster
The New York Infirmary and the Society for the Relief of the Destitute Blind in the City of
New York started the Center for Independent Living, a residential center where the elderly
visually impaired individual can learn the skills necessary to live independently in the
community. It opened in May of 1973 and since then, more than 100 students have received
instruction and supportive services in areas such as mobility, nutrition, health, etc., which
have enabled them to lead more active and independent lives in the community. The Center
offers counseling in the following areas:
Aging and Blindness Counseling
Social workers at CIL provide professional help as students work through problems
associated with their advancing age and loss of vision. This individual supportive therapy
contributes to the student's ability to overcome depression and attitudes of self-
deprecation, to affirm his/her right to be different, and to plan his/her future. At CIL there
is also a group discussion program in which students compare experiences and problems and
learn to appreciate their ability to help others and themselves.
Financial Counseling
Most of the CIL students were employed before they lost their vision. Yet now they are
dealing with federal, state and local bureaucracies in order to secure financial support,
housing and medical care. The Community Coordinator and a volunteer attorney provide
help to the students as they deal with this strange, new and often frustrating circumstance.
They are also developing a financial manual for the students to use as a guide through the
policies and procedures of the various agencies with which they must deal and it is planned
that this will serve as the basis for an education program in the use of community resources.
Medical Counseling
Most of the students referred to the Center for Independent Living have health problems in
addition to their visual loss. The student may even be receiving treatment for three or four
different ailments from two or three different physicians or specialists. They are rarely
aware of the implications of their total medical and physical condition. Because of this
situation, CIL provides counseling for students on their present physical conditions and
expectations for the future. Students learn why they have dietary, physical and medical
and they are taught what to do if they experience symptoms that might signal a change in
their condition. Students need this kind of awareness of their medical status in order to
prepare for independent living.
1
State of the Art / Inkster / 2
Volunteer Services
Any totally blind individual living alone requires a supporting group of volunteers or paid
readers and attendants. They help shop for food and clothing, read the mail, provide
emergency transportation, and they also informally monitor the individual's housekeeping
and personal management skills. Most recently visually impaired individuals find this sudden
dependency a problem. They are used to being self-reliant and are now reluctant to request
the support services that they need and they feel that they are imposing on others.
Recognizing this need, the Center for Independent Living provides counseling and an
educational program to expose the students to the problems of recruiting, selecting,
educating and using such assistants and companions.
Educational Services
Nutrition: Ninety percent of all students referred to the Center for service have dietary
restrictions placed on them by their physicians. While students may be aware of the reasons
for their special diets, they often do not know how to apply these dietary restrictions to
their everyday living. Because of this special need, CIL offers a course in nutrition which
helps students cope with dietary limitations both in planning meals at home and eating out.
Physical Conditioning: The average age of the students who are referred to the Center for
Independent Living is between sixty-eight and seventy. A good number of the students have
been blind for a period of five years or more. Consequently, they have been living rather
sedentary lives. When they start the Center program, they find themselves in a relatively
exhausting situation of attending six classes per day, five days per week. A number of
students have had to adjust their schedule to alternate periods to allow their bodies to
become accustomed to this new and higher level of activity. CIL has developed' a
prescriptive physical conditioning program to enhance the highest and best use of a
student's time in training at the Center.
Sensory Development: All but one of CIL's students began having trouble with their vision
late in life. The average time between onset of a visual problem and referral to the Center is
five years. The fact that these individuals have had vision for the major portion of their lives
means that they have a well-developed concept of the world around them. After losing their
sight, it becomes extremely important to better utilize their remaining senses for
interpreting what is happening in the surrounding environment. CIL offers a course in
sensory development to help students to more accurately and rapidly interpret the
environment through the use of sound, smell, taste and touch.
Communications: The Center for Independent Living program provides instruction in four
different communications skills: Braille, typing, script and the use of electronic equipment.
Orientation and Mobility: CIL provides instruction in orientation and mobility skills, which
are vital to independent living.
In order to improve the quality of instructional programs at CIL, teachers have been
encouraged to clearly define educational objectives and behavioral criteria which can be
used to assess each student's progress in learning course material.
State of the Art / Inkster / 3
These services and educational programs have given students the tools they need in order to
live independently in the community. Because of the success of our residential program and
also because of its limitations, we have engaged in other activities to contribute toward a
future of independent living for the elderly visually impaired population. We have helped to
establish and conduct training and internship programs for professionals and
paraprofessionals working with the visually impaired and/or the elderly.
We have also started to develop a self-study rehabilitation curriculum for use in the home.
Self-Study Rehabilitation Program: Approximately 70% of those referred to CIL either
could not or would not leave their homes to come to a rehabilitation center. According to a
brief assessment, CIL students have an average I.Q. of about 120. These early findings may
indicate that the Center for Independent Living is attracting those individuals who are more
capable and who have less fear of facing new situations and new environments. If this is the
case, a large portion of the older visually impaired population will not benefit from the CIL
program because of their reluctance to come to the Center either for personal or physical
reasons.
For this reason, CIL has prepared home study course materials on cassette tapes with
companion large print transcripts that can be used by visually impaired individuals who will
not or cannot leave their homes. The students can use the lessons on tape to learn the habit
changes and new techniques required to perform adequately without vision. The large print
companion manual can be used by a spouse, a volunteer, a friend or neighbor to monitor the
progress of the student in learning these skills.
One such self-study course was developed by CIL and used by eleven agencies in the New
England States in both metropolitan and rural areas. An evaluation of the results showed the
value of this method for teaching individuals who are newly blinded.
On the basis of this early experience, the Center for Independent Living developed a
self-study course in housekeeping skills which is available on a national basis. Other
self-study courses will be developed in communications and mobility.
Douglas Inkster
Director
Center for Independent Living-New York
Altschul Pavilion
310 East 15th Street
New York, New York 10003
SYSTEMS APPROACH AND THE "PHYSICALLY UNABLE"
Wallace Motloch
In this technological society we are constantly dealing with systems, e.g., political system,
telephone system, digestive system, highway system, etc. The dictionary defines this word as
"to combine" or "an assemblage of interdependent group of items to form a unified
whole." Oh! how wonderful it would be if we could utilize the systems approach when
dealing with the problems of physically impaired. For example, if faced with a mobility
impairment the question would be, what set of aids would be suitable to eliminate the
mobility difficulty?
When we speak of eliminating mobility difficulties for the "physically unable" we are
always faced with the natural comparison to the physically able. Therefore, we must always
be aware of the immense freedom of mobility that the ablebodied possess. Humans can
traverse rough terrain, climb stairs, hills, even mountains; go through lots of snow, ice,
change speeds, stand, walk, run, jump, swim, change positions in space, squat, kneel, sit,
stand, lie, reach over and underneath, exert forces, carry things, turn knobs, ski, skate, ride
bicycles, manipulate environment at close range, inspect, investigate, feel, touch, sense
temperature, texture, shape, all in all basically bringing our senses, eyes, ears, hands, etc.,
into close proximity to the object to be dealt with. All of the above and more is what we
think of when we mean mobility. Therefore, it is an extremely tall order to fill when
considering severely disabled people. Most of the severely impaired need not only a wheeled
transporter but a way to get in and out of a seat. They need a working surface like a lap tray
and accessible utility box for their possessions. To be able to reach down to the floor, up to
the shelf, a way to summon help, have their life support systems serviced
the list goes on
and on, including endless amounts of customizing, adapting and personalizing their systems
and surroundings to make their life more livable. To make their life more livable, more
dignified and independent is one of the greatest challenges that face our society. We can
send people to the moon and beyond, but the best we can offer to our handicapped is an
ancient chair on wheels. Society has fallen behind badly in recognizing the extreme
hardships and difficulty that our handicapped face.
In making life more livable we employ many tools and social structures-scientists and
technology to name a few. The technology is a natural one when we speak of physically
impaired. The Webster Dictionary says it so well, "Technology-the totality of means
employed to provide objects necessary for human sustenance and comfort."
At the Rehabilitation Engineering Center at Children's Hospital at Stanford, we specialize in
the severely disabled child and young adult. We offer our services under four categories: 1)
unusual limb prosthetics, 2) unusual orthotics, 3) communication for non-oral and, 4)
mobility. We pride ourselves on the fact that we provide systems to accomplish a specific
task, i.e., communication system, mobility system. When a wheeled mobility system is
1
State of the Art / Motloch / 2
considered we look not only at the chair itself, but the tissue trauma management,
positioning, seating, controls, trays, reachers, transfers, as well as defining a lifestyle that is
consistent with the developmental needs of a child.
Developmental Aids for an Infant
In preparing a severely disabled infant to go home, the first developmental aid would
probably be a carrying or "holding device." This papoose-like aid would hold and contain
the anesthetic limbs, protect the back and head while enabling the family to handle the
child. A spina bifida infant is often brought home from the hospital and placed in a crib face
down so as not to aggravate his/her newly operated back. Relatives and friends are usually
very reluctant to touch him/her and their feelings of apprehensio.n transmit to the child. The
feelings of excitement, picking-up, passing him/her from one member to another, playing
with him/her, cuddling and holding him/her without fear of injury are important and
stimulate the child to develop and learn in a normal way. "There are too many dimensions
of normal behavior to sacrifice development of any part. Therefore, if the patient can be
normalized during any period, by use of orthotic appliances, their application is justified."
As the child's visual field becomes important, the need for assistance in holding up the trunk
and head develops. The use of a carry seat to prop the child into a semi-reclining position is
a safe, enjoyable, and developmentally beneficial activity.
We cannot emphasize enough the importance of "sitting, hands free." At this later stage (8
to 14 months) the floor is the child's world, and hands are the pedicles connecting the brain
to the exciting new environment of taste, texture, shapes, and spaces. However, many spina
bifida children do not have sufficient trunk balance to sit unsupported. Since they use their
hands to stabilize their upper body, the interaction with environment is thereby limited to
an onlooker's role-a passive observer. This child can be given a sitting jacket to enable
him/her to explore his/her world, be it the floor, bathtub, or front lawn.
As we progress to the next developmental milestone we move from stationary exploration
to some mobility. Crawling allows discoveries beyond the immediate visual field, around the
corner, inside the cupboards. The intriguing mysteries of kitchen cupboards, the wonderful
sounds of pots and pans, oh, the tastes on the floors! Do the present wheelchairs fit this
need? Of course not. They're too big, too complex, and too high. When a spina bifida child
loses a toy, it's gone forever; the floor is too low to reach and the tables are too high to see.
We need to think more along the lines of the caster cart or similar devices close to the floor,
patient-propelled, small/maneuverable, with protection for back, seat, and legs. This kind of
tool allows the child to retrieve playthings from the floor with hands-free exploration, and
manipulation of the environment at the child's own pace, scale, and level.
Another goal for orthotics and device design is "crutchless standing," for children 14
months and older. When we stop to consider the limitation of exploration that crutches
impose on our little people, we can better appreciate the need for a "hands-free standing
experience." The conventional bracing systems that tie up the hands with crutches for
ambulating as well as standing are defeating the most common cause of ambulating from
one point to another. That is to say, the most common purpose for going somewhere is to
get there and then use one's hands to touch, pick up, or manipulate. The joy of having one's
hands free for activities of play or discovery can easily be observed with the younger folk.
State of the Art / Motloch / 3
Developmental Aids for the Older Child and Young Adult
As we move out of the first decade of life where most Orthotic Aids could be looked upon
as developmental aids, we enter a period of transition. This is a very difficult period for
most patients and families, as many patients experience periods of depression. The upright
ambulation in known devices is less and less attractive, spines are collapsing, pressure sores
are developing and obesity compounds the problem of adjustment. On top of all these is the
final realization that the best our society can offer is a frame on two big wheels. Our society
has been able to solve some extremely complex technological problems and yet our disabled
are left to fend for themselves. We seem to be saying that this is sufficient, this is all right;
but it is not all right. The human frame was not meant to be placed in one position for 10
hours a day; there are physiological and functional reasons for stretching, moving, standing,
and reclining. Imagine yourself being confined to an automobile seat for 10 hours a day, day
after day.
We know that the devices we provide limit posture to a sitting position without regard to
pressure on tissues, positional deformities, and a life-style which eliminates manipulation of
the environment at close range (over, under, beneath, and behind). At best we consider two
positions-standing and sitting-but without regard to how to get from one to the other,
attendant free. We have to begin thinking about a better future for our paraplegics with a
more livable life-style, including a family of their own, holding a job, running a household,
being able to move into a variety of positions and undertaking a wide range of activities.
Perhaps we can borrow parts from the armamentarium for traumatic adult paraplegics and
adapt it for our younger patients who have shorter stature, bigger shoulders and other
peculiar problems. We have to think of individual life styles, systems approach to
ambulation, urine collection, emergency handling, etc. We must not overlook the fact that,
in addition to our other concerns, we soon have to address ourselves to the problems of
aging with its host of new challenges. Since it will take a long time to develop, test and make
available new mobility aids, it is imperative to start immediately.
Let's consider one case: a typical 16 year old young woman, obese, slow, friendly, and
prone to pressure sores. It is unrealistic to expect her to push-up regularly to change her
sitting position; history shows this method did not work for her. It is also unrealistic to ask
her to frequently transfer from her wheelchair onto the sofa-she can barely lift herself. The
work at Rancho Los Amigos clearly demonstrates that the two most important factors in
tissue trauma management is magnitude of pressure and duration of time. The formula
shows that if there is a great amount of pressure, the tissues can tolerate it for a short time,
and we can measure this now. We can predict the length of time that a person can sit on
particular areas of tissue without permanent tissue damage. In the case of this young
woman, the only way to accomplish an eight hour day was to alternate the weight-bearing
areas; in standing, the feet take most of the weight, in sitting the ischial tuberosities, but as
we lean forward, the center of gravity line moves anterially and the weight bearing area is
more forward, as we recline, the weight moves to the back. This is essentially a time sharing
technique that enables us to get more ambulatory time as well as more functional positions.
Now let us consider a sample ambulation system for paraplegics. The transportation system
is made up of many purpose-designed modules, These modules can be equipped with
efficient patient-operated connectors which allow them to be arranged into a custom-
designed system.
State of the Art / Motloch / 4
Module I - Short Range
Short range ambulation is most profoundly affected by spinal cord impairment. The
impairment limits the person's ability to maneuver within a confined space. The fine
movements which are required to locate oneself within the reach of the target, be it low,
high or obstructed, are often impossible. Our concept of Module I is a crutchless standing
orthosis, with a pivot-walker. Arrangement of this type allows the patient to maneuver in
confined areas, narrow passageways and reaching/seeing from a standing person's level.
While pivot-walking without crutches is possible in spaces like bathrooms or kitchen, on
rougher terrain and longer distances it is not practical. This type of Module I is versatile in
short range and offers a wide choice of connecting options, i.e., it should be possible to
remove oneself from a wheeled transporter (Module II), place the transporter in the trunk of
a car, and then ambulate to the seat of the car.
This kind of freedom of interconnecting to different components in the transportation
system is utilized by the able-bodied all the time. We walk to our car (short range), drive the
car to the airport's parking lot (long range), then walk again to the airport shuttle bus (short
range). The bus moves us across the interim distance so that we end up within a walking
distance of the ticket counter.
The ambulatory units should receive the human not as a static frame but as a living organism
with many physiological, psychological and biological needs. The person and his/her
machines should be arranged into a dynamic mobility system which facilitates such changes
as alternating weight-bearing areas, exercising and just general changes in posture. This sort
of consideration would play a great part in maintaining a good physical state and mental
attitude.
Module II - Interim Range
The intermediate range of transport involves bridging the gap between the short and
"public" transport systems. Most often Module II consists of a wheeled transporter
(wheelchair, cart, scooter, etc.). Whether externally powered or not will depend on the
distance/terrain to be covered. This usually limits the range to several city blocks. The
barriers most often encountered are curbs, steps, narrow passages and rough terrain. The
interesting point to Module II is the fact that while the distance and time to travel is
relatively short, the patient often uses this module as a base from which to work or rest.
Therefore, this means that he/she spends a lot of time in it and the ambulation time
represents only a small portion of the actual usage time.
Module III - Long Range
Generally, it may be said that ambulation of a long range type will be by Module III (car,
boat, plane, etc.) and along the existing routes of "public" transport (highways, railroads,
airways). It may be necessary to standardize or even modify in some instances both
"public" transport and the handicapped system to ensure their compatibility. Devising
methods of connecting to able-bodied systems is of great importance; it would certainly
remove many barriers to independence.
State of the Art / Motloch / 5
Summary
When considering physical disabilities we could render a much better service if a systems
approach were used.
Also, it is my opinion that today's technology could eliminate many of the physical
problems facing our disabled. It behooves us to find a way to make it available to them.
Wallace Motloch, C.O.
Chief Orthotist, Rehabilitation
Engineering Center
Children's Hospital at Stanford
Palo Alto, California
References
1. Contribution by Ned Sharples in "The Child with an Orthopaedic Disability, His Orthotic Needs and
How to Meet Them," National Academy of Sciences 1973.
2. Contribution by W. Motloch at the "Mobility for Spinal-Cord Impaired People," Workshop Report,
February, 1974.
3. "Wardrobe of Devices" by W. Motloch, Inter-Clinic Information Bulletin, January 1974.
4. "A New Item for the Spina Bifida Program" by W. Motloch, Inter-Clinic Bulletin, July 1970.
5. "PARAPODIUM-An Orthotic Device for Neuromuscular Disorders," Artificial Limbs, by W. Motloch,
Autumn 1971.
6. Annual Reports, Ontario Crippled Children's Centre, from 1968 to 1974.
7. Personal Communication-E. Hamilton, I. Otter, N. Carroll, and many wonderful friends at O.C.C.C.
8. Prast Research Annual Report, 1973, 1974.
9. Rancho Los Amigos Hospital, Annual Report, 1973, John Rogers Section
10. Vehicles for the Severely Disabled, by Peter Bray and Don M. Cunningham.
11. "Crutchless Standing," W. Motloch, Canadian Ortho-Pros, 1973.
THE IMPACT OF LITIGATION ON DE-INSTITUTIONALIZATION:
A MOVEMENT TOWARD INDEPENDENT LIVING FOR THE MENTALLY DISABLED
Kathleen Ursin
The National Center for Law and the Handicapped was established in 1972 to insure or
secure the constitutional and statutory rights of all disabled citizens. In working towards
this goal, NCLH engages in activities which include legal assistance, research, and promoting
public education and professional awareness. The broad, general areas in which NCLH
activities have been concentrated are as follows: Right to equal educational opportunity;
right to treatment in the least restrictive alternative; right to transportation and freedom
from architectural barriers; right to equal employment opportunities; and right to equal
access to medical services.
The "civil rights movement" for the disabled is a relatively new phenomenon in our society.
The 1970's have been years of ever increasing organization among groups of disabled
persons who refuse to remain any longer a silent minority within our society. In seeking
equal treatment and the same basic rights as other citizens, disabled persons have
increasingly turned to the courts to obtain the guarantees which will enhance their ability to
achieve appropriate status in society. The emergence of NCLH and numerous other legal
advocacy groups across the country is evidence of this growing trend. To date, a majority of
litigation in this area has been brought by groups and individuals representing the mentally
disabled. This is not so much a factor of greatest need among these persons, although the
need is great, but a result of two other important considerations: a high degree of
organization among groups representing particularly the mentally retarded; and the
historical roots of the development of law in this area. Although it may seem too obvious to
mention, it is important to remember that lawyers represent clients. The long and often
difficult struggle to achieve equal rights through the court system will succeed only if
disabled persons themselves demonstrate their willingness to become actively involved with
legal advocates.
The issue of right to treatment was one of the first articulated in the courts in the legal
rights for the disabled movement. NCLH, as well as numerous other legal advocacy groups
such as the Mental Health Law Project, The U.S. Justice Department, The Center for Law
and Social Policy, The National Legal Aid and Defenders Association, The American Civil
Liberties Union and numerous statewide advocacy agencies and private counsel has
participated in bringing this issue to the attention of the courts. This paper will describe
briefly the history of litigation in this area as well as outlining the results of some of the
court action, and pointing out future areas for consideration.
1
State of the Art / Ursin / 2
The concept of a "right to treatment" was originally formulated in 1960 by Dr. Morton
Birnbaum, an attorney and physician, in an article written for the American Bar Association
Journal. Dr. Birnbaum advocated in his article
the recognition and enforcement of the
legal right of a mentally ill inmate of a public mental institution to adequate medical
treatment for his illness." Although he recognized that the law had not established this
legal right, Dr. Birnbaum felt our society had and did recognize a moral right to treatment.
In his article he proposed that
the courts, under their traditional powers to protect the
constitutional rights of our citizens begin to consider the problems of whether or not a
person who has been institutionalized solely because he is sufficiently mentally ill to require
institutionalization for care and treatment actually does receive adequate medical treatment
so that he may. regain his health, and therefore his liberty, as soon as possible; that the
courts do this by means of recognizing and enforcing the right to treatment; and, that the
courts do this independent of any action by any legislature, as a necessary and overdue
development of our present concept of due process of law."² (Emphasis added)
During the next ten years, the concept of right to treatment gained acceptance within the
legal community and was given added attention within the larger society as a result of two
reform concepts. 3 These forces were: 1) the growing move to secure mental patient's rights
as part of the "rights revolution," and 2) a movement towards care in the community for
the mentally ill and the mentally retarded. This second factor had as its basis the growing
belief that community health care was possible and desirable for the mentally disabled.
Under the Kennedy administration this concept achieved credibility and the force of law.
For the mentally ill, the advent of psychoactive drugs and the skyrocketing costs of
maintaining large institutional programs convinced state legislators that community care was
possible and feasible. 4 With the passage of the Mental Retardation Facilities and Community
Health Centers Construction Act of 1963, the Federal Government gave its stamp of
approval to this movement and provided a share of construction and staffing money for
these facilities. For the mentally retarded, the advent of the concept of normalization, as
described by Wolfensberger,5 was significant in establishing that the mentally retarded could
and should become a viable part of the larger community. Another concept emerging at this
time which gave impetus to de-institutionalization was the developmental model of
disability. This idea of the potential for growth throughout a person's lifetime, coupled with
the principle of normalization, set forth constructs that could be applied to the integration
of other disabled persons into the community as well.
These two principles have provided a sound basis for the development of legal theories to
protect the rights of the disabled. The developmental model emphasizes the ability of all
disabled persons as capable of growth, learning and development. Further, it is the
interaction between the individual and his environment, rather than the attributes of any
specific impairment, which produce development. It serves to undercut many of the
assumptions upon which statutes and common law, which restrict the rights of handicapped
persons, are based. Viewed with the normalization principle which calls for the provision of
services to the handicapped in as normal an environment as is possible, these principles give
a socio-psychological basis for the establishment of a legal right to treatment in the least
restrictive alternative.
State of the Art / Ursin / 3
The constitutional provisions on which the right to treatment arguments are based are
founded in the equal protection and due process clauses of the Fourteenth Amendment of
the U.S. Constitution. This amendment establishes the obligations of the state to its citizens
if fundamental rights are to be denied or curtailed. In addition to the Fourteenth
Amendment, Eighth Amendment guarantees which prohibit cruel and unusual punishment
and Thirteenth Amendment guarantees which prohibit involuntary servitude have been used
as the basis for establishing the arguments in right to treatment litigation.
The importance of the constitutional principles involved in right to treatment litigation
cannot be denied. The need for litigation to insure that these rights are protected takes on
more compelling proportions when the number of disabled people potentially affected is
considered. The latest figures available indicate that as of 30 June 1974, 215,573 persons
were committed to institutions for the mentally ill in the United States.⁷ For the mentally
retarded, the January 1975 statistics indicate that 168,300 persons were committed to
public state residential institution programs and 150,000 were in private programs. Mental
or emotional disability and its attendant handicaps can and does affect all ages and all
classes of persons. It has been estimated that 20% of all Americans will, during their
lifetime, require professional treatment for mental or emotional ailments.⁹
Right to treatment litigation revolves around two central issues: 1) that "when the state
decides to provide a service for its citizens it must do so under conditions which are as
minimally restrictive to personal liberty as possible."¹ This is the concept of the least
restrictive alternative and requires state officials to examine all possible alternatives before
the one most severely restrictive of personal liberty is chosen. The second component of the
right states, " when the state restricts a person's liberty for the declared purpose of
providing a service, then it is constitutionally required to actually provide the service." 11 In
the paragraphs below the cases which establish these principles are described briefly.
Initially, litigation focused on the nature and quality of treatment which a patient received
once institutionalized. However, as litigation has developed in this area, the need to protect
and insure the rights of mentally ill and mentally retarded persons during the entire
institutionalization process have been recognized. Basically, suits have addressed issues
surrounding three different phases of this process: 1) "Getting in": the commitment process
itself; 2) "Treatment": what happens to a person once he is in an institutional facility and
the process by which he is prepared to leave that facility; and 3) "Getting out": the
complex area of community services and the appropriateness and availability of them. Each
of these areas must be addressed, and adequate safeguards established, if the mentally
disabled are to receive appropriate treatment and services under conditions which protect
and insure their legal rights.
The commitment process itself, the process by which the mentally disabled are involuntarily
confined to institutions, raises substantial questions of procedural due process safeguards.
The question has been dealt with most fully in the decision in Lessard V. Schmidt, 349 F.
Supp. 1078 (E.D. Wis. 1972). Although this very extensive case and its holdings go beyond
the issue of involuntary commitment, it does address this particular issue in a most
substantial way. Essentially, the decision in this case established that "no significant
deprivations of liberty can be justified without prior hearing on necessity of detention.
There must be adequate notice, fair hearing, right to jury trial, and the person detained must
State of the Art / Ursin / 4
be informed of the basis of detention, the standard on which one may be detained, names of
examining physicians, etc. The standard of commitment set was an overt act of danger to
others as proven beyond a reasonable doubt." In another significant case in this area, which
was only recently decided, a Federal Court in Pennsylvania found that the practice of
commitment to residential institutions of minors by their parents without due process
safeguards was unconstitutional. This case is Bartley V. Kremens, CA No. 72-2272 (E.D. Pa.
filed Nov. 1972). These two cases establish precedent for the adequate protection against
involuntary commitment for individuals in similar circumstances.
It is important to note at this point that the articulation of a right does not necessarily
guarantee its implementation. Furthermore, the recognition of a right and its affirmation in
one particular locale, does not insure that other localities will necessarily implement or
recognize similar rights. However, the establishment of sound precedents is particularly
necessary in the area of rights for the disabled. The building of good case law enables
attorneys to deal more efficiently and, hopefully, successfully with similar cases in future
actions.
The protection of patient's rights once institutionalized, and the assurance of adequate
treatment so that continued confinement is no longer necessary have been dealt with most
extensively. In a case of Wyatt V. Harden, (formerly Wyatt V. Stickney and Wyatt V.
Aderholt) the Alabama District Court's decision that institutionalized mentally ill and
mentally retarded persons have a Constitutional right to treatment was affirmed, in part, by
a Circuit Court of Appeals in November, 1974. In a series of orders relating to Wyatt, the
Court established for the first time minimum constitutional standards for adequate care and
treatment. The court held that such a right to treatment necessitates the following: 1) an
individualized treatment program; 2) a humane physical and psychological environment; 3)
an adequate and qualified staff; and 4) programs provided in the least restrictive manner
possible. 12 Implementing this wide ranging decision in Alabama has posed considerable
problems, however. The Court established standards on the basis of evidence from experts in
national organizations concerned with the quality of mental health services. Although the
standards established are valid, it is still questionable whether they can be implemented
successfully in Alabama. The Court in Wyatt, disallowed the argument on the part of the
State that available financial resources were inadequate to implement the standards set. The
conflict has still not been resolved. Assuming the court has the ability to mandate changes in
the staffing and the allocation of resources, the question still remains as to whether such
standards can be reasonably interpreted and monitored, what their long term effects on
minimal policy and practices are likely to be, and their bearing on the patient who wishes to
refuse treatment. 13
The court's role in establishing treatment standards is still unclear. Although the
Constitutional right to treatment established in the Wyatt decision was upheld by the U.S.
Fifth Circuit Court, a similar Fifth Circuit Court finding in the Donaldson case was
vacated 14 by the Supreme Court in June of 1975. O'Connor V. Donaldson 95 S.Ct. 2486
(1975) was the first case in the area of right to treatment, and in the area of rights of
disabled generally, to reach the U.S. Supreme Court. It was hoped that the Supreme Court
would rule in the case on the Constitutional basis for the right to treatment. Instead, the
Court decided the case very narrowly on the facts and although the principle which they
State of the Art / Ursin / 5
affirmed in their decision was an important one, it left many questions unanswered.
Basically, the Supreme Court held in O'Connor that a state could not involuntarily confine
to an institution a person who is not mentally ill or a danger to himself or others. This
reaffirmation of the basic right to liberty was indeed significant and could, potentially,
affect a great number of institutionalized persons. However, its potential affects could be
devastating if patients were released without adequate planning for community living.
Institutions have been characterized in the past as societal dumping grounds. It would
indeed be a gross misrepresentation of the intent of the law if recent court decisions were
used to sanction state administrative programs which seek to reduce hospital population and
thereby reduce state expenditures.
There is growing controversy in our society around the issue of "warehousing V. dumping,"
institutionalization V. de-institutionalization. To characterize the issues in "either/or" terms
produces fruitless debate and is a misrepresentation of what constitutes an acceptable
solution to the problems raised. Recent litigation has stressed not only the need for
adequate short-term training or treatment for the mentally disabled once institutionalized
but also the need to develop appropriate community alternatives to which formerly
institutionalized patients may return. In addition to the development of adequate facilities,
however, additional problems presented by de-institutionalization are the need for
budgeting for reallocation of public resources and a coordinated tracking system which will
provide accountability for continuity for services. A recent consent decree in New York
State Association for Retarded Children, et al. V. Carey, the Willowbrook case, 393 F. Supp.
715 (E.D.N.Y. 1975), 357 F. Supp. 752 (E.D.N.Y. 1973) and a recently signed settlement
agreement in the Horacek V. Exon, No. 72-L-299 (D. Neb.) suit both provide for the states
involved to develop adequate community services systems. These suits have been brought on
behalf of retarded citizens in institutions and a parallel suit, requiring the development of
such community alternatives for the mentally ill is being brought in the District of Columbia
in Dixon V. Weinberger, Civ. Act. No. 74-285 (D.D.C., filed February 14, 1974). Continued
pressure from the courts to move in this direction can provide the impetus for the
development of innovative, creative and decent living and treatment facilities for the
mentally ill and the mentally retarded both in the institution and in the community.
De-institutionalization has been articulated as National policy, and the Federal Government
has made some strides in providing the necessary funding of adequate hospital programs and
development of community programs. The Social Security Act, particularly title 16, which
provides for supplemental security income, title 19, which provides funding for intermediate
care facilities, and title 20, which provides for the development of community services, have
been reflections of this policy. Some states, Michigan being a prime example, have
responded to the growing trend in court decisions in this area and have substantially revised
their mental health codes to conform with legally and programmatically sound practice. The
response, however, has not been adequate to meet the needs of the majority of mentally
disabled people for treatment or services. Although the litigation process is often a long and
State of the Art / Ursin / 6
arduous one, the courts can provide the necessary pressure on both Federal and State
Governments to develop more viable systems for the treatment and rehabilitation of its
mentally disabled.
Kathleen Ursin
National Center for Law
and the Handicapped
1235 North Eddy St.
South Bend, Indiana 46617
State of the Art / Ursin / 7
Footnotes
1. M. Birnbaum, "The Right to Treatment," 46 Am. Bar Assn Journal, p. 499.
2. Ibid., p. 499.
3. H. Santiestevan, Out of Their Beds and into the Streets, American Federation of State, County &
Municipal Employees, p. 10.
4. D. Mechanic, The Right to Treatment, unpublished document, p. 8.
5. Wolf Wolfensberger and Bengt Nirge [et al.], The Principle of Normalization in Human Services, Natl.
Institute on Mental Retardation, Toronto, 1972.
6. F. Laski, "Civil Rights Victories for the Handicapped-11," The Social and Rehabilitation Record, June
1974, p. 29.
7. N.I.M.H. Statistical #114.
8. National Association of Co-ordinators of State Programs for the Mentally Retarded and National
Association of Superintendents of Private Residential Facilities for the Mentally Retarded.
9. Santiestevan, supra, p. 11.
10. National Center for Law and Handicapped, The Legal Rights of the Mentally Handicapped,
unpublished manuscript, p. 2.
11. Ibid., p. 2.
12. Wyatt V. Stickney, 325 F. Supp. 781 (M.D. Ala. 1971), 344 F. Supp. 1341 (M.D. Ala. 1972), aff'd in
part, modified in part sub nom. Wyatt V. Aderholt, 503 F.2d 1305 (5th Cir. 1974).
13. Mechanic, supra, p. 23.
14. A decision by the Appellate Court that the opinion of lower court is of no effect and has no
precedential value.
Bibliography
Hoffman, P. Browning and Robert C. Dunn. "Beyond Rouse and Wyatt: An Administrative-Law Model for
Expanding and Implementing the Mental Patient's Right to Treatment," 61 Va. Law Rev. 297
(1975).
Laski, Frank. "Civil Rights Victories for the Handicapped-II," The Social and Rehabilitation Record., June
1974, pp. 25-32.
Mechanic, David. The Right to Treatment: Judicial Action and Social Change, unpublished manuscript
prepared for "Conference on Rights of Mentally Disabled," Wausau, Wisconsin, September 25-26,
1973.
Mental Health Law Project. Basic Rights of the Mentally Handicapped, Washington, D.C., 1973.
National Center for Law and the Handicapped. The Legal Rights of the Handicapped Persons, unpublished
manuscript, 1974.
President's Committee on Mental Retardation. Compendium of Law Suits Establishing the Legal Rights of
Mentally Retarded Citizens, DHEW Publication No. (OHD) 75-21007, Washington, D.C., October
1974.
Santiestevan, Henry. Out of their Beds and into the Streets, American Federation of State, County and
Municipal Employees, Washington, D.C., February 1975.
Wald, Patricia M. "Warehousing vs. Dumping-An Absurd Debate," The Mental Health Law Project:
Summary of Activities, Washington, D.C., June 1975.
PRIVATE INDUSTRY AND THE VOCATIONAL REHABILITATION PROCESS
Richard J. Randles
A Role for Industry?
Does private industry have a role in the vocational rehabilitation process and in the
handicapped person's quest for independent living? Although most people from both the
business community and the rehabilitation community would undoubtedly answer "yes,"
with varying degrees of enthusiasm and conviction, there would be no clear consensus on
what the role could or should be. It is not the intent of this paper to define a precise role
but, rather, to present a conceptual relationship between business and rehabilitation that
merits the consideration of both.
The traditional role of private industry is that of an employer of qualified handicapped
people. The Rehabilitation Act of 1973 implicitly recognizes and furthers that role by
requiring firms doing more than $2500 worth of business annually with the federal
government to establish an Affirmative Action Program for employment and advancement
of the handicapped.
A second major role or form of involvement in which industry frequently takes part is that
of a provider of resources in support of a specific program or need. The resources may take
any of various forms, such as loaned equipment, facilities or instructors; personnel to serve
on Government committees; and sometimes money. In addition to assuming a corporate
responsibility for such types of support, many of the larger firms also have programs that
encourage and facilitate individual employees' participation in community projects.
A list of the various means through which industry might participate would be practically
limitless. For example, it could establish, underwrite, support, provide or operate training
programs, transportation systems or housing programs. Useful and necessary as such support
may be, it is too frequently addressed to a single need, without sufficient regard to its place
in the total process or in the rehabilitation/industry relationship. These customary roles
provide little opportunity for rehabilitation and industry to understand each other's
problems or to combine their unique skills and experiences to their mutual benefit and to
the benefit of the handicapped. There is, however, a potential role for industry as an active
participant in, and advisor to, the vocational rehabilitation process that will open lines of
communication and create a cooperative environment in which each can capitalize on the
unique strengths and abilities of the other. A successful model of such a partnership exists in
the Computer Training Project conducted by the California Department of Rehabilitation
and the Center for Independent Living (CIL) with the support and participation of an
Advisory Committee of Bay Area businessmen. Similar models have been or are being
established in Virginia and Chicago.
1
State of the Art / Randles / 2
The Models
In early 1973, IBM suggested to the Virginia Department of Vocational Rehabilitation
(DVR), and more specifically the Woodrow Wilson Rehabilitation Center (WWRC), that we
jointly undertake a project to train and place homebound handicapped people in data
processing jobs as computer programmers. Shortly thereafter, the project was initiated with
the DVR and WWRC assuming lead roles and project responsibility. The IBM group
committed itself to providing assistance in those areas in which their unique abilities and
experience would be most relevant. Because establishment of an enduring program was
desired, the IBM assistance initially focused on areas in which DVR needed to develop new
capabilities such as computer programmer training. Job development, placement, and
project organization were areas in which assistance was also needed and provided. The types
of assistance provided included:
Participation in the development of course modules
Provision of training courses for the WWRC instructors to refresh and/or augment
their skills
Provision field of training for counselors and others to orient them to the data processing
Identification of potential employers and assistance to counselors on employer calls.
The DVR and WWRC were responsible for the actual performance of the major functions of
the project such as client identification and screening, training, and placement. The IBM
assistance was aimed at enhancing their abilities to perform those functions, although, in
some instances such as placement, it was necessary to participate as "doers" more than was
anticipated.
The project has been successful in that it has trained and placed 14 handicapped persons to
date and has established a new capability in the Virginia DVR. Three of the clients placed
are working in their homes. The project also provided insight into some of the needs of
rehabilitation and suggested ways in which industry might aid in meeting those needs.
Based largely on the experience acquired during the Virginia project, a project was started in
the San Francisco/Oakland Bay Area in October, 1974. The formative stages were
completed by February, 1975, and on February 10 a class of 13 students started a
nine-month computer programming training course at the Center for Independent Living
(CIL) in Berkeley. As in Virginia, the Department of Rehabilitation was responsible, for
project formation and performance, with assistance from IBM. CIL assumed responsibility
for conducting the training program. In this case, however, it was decided to attempt at the
start to form an advisory committee representing major local business firms to assist in the
project and form the nucleus for addressing related needs, some of which had been observed
during the Virginia project. (These needs are discussed later in this paper.) A committee
composed of representatives from approximately 15 business firms, the Department of
Rehabilitation, the CIL, and the handicapped community was established. The committee
actively participates in the project rather than playing a purely advisory role. Industrial
members come primarily from the Data Processing, business operations, personnel, and
training departments of the participating firms. The committee, through its three
sub-committees, Technical, Business, and Placement, provides assistance and guidance in a
number of areas. It:
State of the Art / Randles / 3
Defines the skills and abilities a graduate of the program should possess
Assists in developing the course to produce such a graduate
Assists in acquainting the student with the business environment and in developing job
seeking skills
Provides a form of course accreditation by participating in the development of the
program and conducting a review board of the graduates
Assists in obtaining placements for class graduates
This is by no means an exhaustive list, but rather an identification of some of the major
functions of the committee. The industrial members also provide guest lecturers and some
training materials and participate in a variety of ways. It should be noted, however, that
although the firms involved also fill traditional roles of providing resources and jobs, they do
so as part of a coordinated effort with the rehabilitation community. The committee has
also assumed certain responsibilites directed toward the continuation of the project in the
Bay Area and to its expansion throughout the state, not only in the area of continued
functioning, but also in recruiting new industrial members for its own and other as yet
unformed committees.
A similar project has been started in Chicago. The nucleus of an Advisory Committee has
been formed which has developed a description of the course content necessary to train a
productive entry-level programmer. There is to be a continuing, coordinated effort between
the committee and community colleges (which will conduct the training) to tailor a course
to satisfy that description. The committee is also to perform other guidance and assistance
functions in concert with the Illinois Division of Vocational Rehabilitation, as is being done
in the Bay Area project.
Obstacles to Placement
A major objective of vocational rehabilitation is to place handicapped people in
employment commensurate with their interests and abilities. Achieving that objective has
become more difficult and challenging with the increased emphasis on providing services to
the severely handicapped; the demands of a changing business world; and a constantly
increasing case load. Before discussing the virtues of the advisory group concept as a means
of supporting the attainment of that objective, it is worthwhile to examine the more
significant factors that bear on its achievement.
Occupations for the handicapped have become stereotyped, and job opportunities tend to
be sought in a fixed and relatively narrow spectrum of possible vocational paths. Many of
the occupations targeted in years past are no longer in demand and many are not suitable
for the severely handicapped. Opportunities for the severely handicapped are extremely
difficult to identify for those reasons and because of client physical limitations,
transportation and facility barriers, employer reluctance and a myriad of other factors.
Business changes and technological advances have created a mixed blessing. Those
occurrences have created new job opportunities, such as computer programming, that do
not require great physical strength, mobility or dexterity but instead have a major
intellectual component that may make them particularly suitable for the severely physically
handicapped. They have also made it increasingly difficult to develop and maintain the
understanding of the job market and job requirements needed to establish meaningful and
achievable client placement objectives.
State of the Art / Randles / 4
Present training programs frequently lack credibility both to the potential employer and to
the potential student. Many firms contacted during the previously described projects felt
that most college trained new employees were not adequately prepared to become
productive programmers without additional training. In general, present training programs
lack orientation to the practical aspects of the vocation, fail to include the techniques of the
field felt by industry to be essential to preparing an individual for competitive employment,
and do not provide orientation to business operation and the work environment, or training
in job seeking skills.
Employers tend to view jobs in terms of established requirements and do not spontaneously
consider possible task modifications that can make the difference between successful
placement and no placement. There is also much misunderstanding, misinformation, and
lack of information regarding the need for architectural changes, physical accommodations,
and the productivity and absenteeism of the handicapped worker.
Many younger handicapped people lack the self-confidence and assertiveness required to
obtain employment on their own. They may have little or no experience or acquired skills in
job seeking and often have very limited knowledge of the occupation or job requirements.
They must also contend with a disincentive to employment created by the potential loss of
disability benefits, especially medical, when they take a job at a level of earned income
insufficient to offset the loss.
A Rehabilitation/Industrial Alliance
There are a number of actions necessary to cope with that formidable array of barriers to
employment for the handicapped. The technological advances in industry must be exploited
to identify new occupational opportunities and job demand must be determined. Job
descriptions must be developed and training and experience requirements defined. Existing
training programs must be updated and new ones established, if necessary, to reflect current
occupational demands and to include job-seeking skills and orientation to the work
environment and to the actual work to be performed. The placement process must provide
for active participation by the counselors on behalf of their clients and for. exploring the
concepts of job modification and rehabilitation engineering to augment client abilities.
Means for effectively addressing the employers' concerns regarding such issues as
productivity, absenteeism, and insurance rates must be developed. Above all, comprehensive
client plans should be established and carried out to integrate and coordinate the required
services from referral to closure, whether or not job placement is the rehabilitation objective
for a given client.
To accomplish those actions and achieve the placement objective requires a wide range of
skills and knowledge. Rehabilitation's special knowledge of the handicapped, and their
competency and experience in humanitarian services, comprise one category of required
skills. In addition, there is a need for knowledge and experience in business fields such as job
market analysis, job analysis and definition, task modification, vocational training, business
organization and structure, project management, and salesmanship. It has been observed
that few if any counselors possess all or even most of those business oriented skills. Nor does
it seem reasonable to expect counselors whose education and preparation has emphasized
the social, psychological and humanitarian aspects of rehabilitation to possess, in addition,
the skills normally associated with industry.
State of the Art / Randles / 5
In theory, training programs could be established to provide counselors with the
opportunity to acquire the necessary skills. Practically, however, there are a number of
factors that mitigate against that concept on other than a limited basis. The number of
counselors to be trained, number of disciplines involved, counselor absence from his or her
caseload and similar considerations make the success of such an undertaking problematic. A
more effective method of acquiring the required skills would be to enlist industry as a
working partner to assist rehabilitation in its pursuit of improved job development, training,
placement, and other vocationally oriented services. Both rehabilitation and industry would,
as an adjunct to working together, acquire new skills and insight into each other's domain.
Unlike present committees for employment of the handicapped, sponsored by various levels
of government, the proposed alliance would be an active working group that would jointly
plan and conduct projects utilizing the unique skills and knowledge of each member. The
alliance would be similar to the Bay Area Advisory Committee in both composition and
function. It would include representatives from industry, the rehabilitation community, the
handicapped community, and the training or educational community, and would function
under the direction of a project leader. The combination of special skills and insight brought
to such an alliance by each member group could foster innovative and relevant projects for,
and approaches to, the training, employment, and independent living of the handicapped
and benefit all by providing:
Business with a new source of employees who possess needed skills
Rehabilitation with assistance in orienting their vocational services to current and
projected business needs
The handicapped with new employment opportunities and enhanced services to
exploit those opportunities.
The precise manner in which the alliances would function and the specific issues they would
pursue would be determined by the groups themselves based on the attributes of the
members and the more critical needs in their community. The general nature of the
functions to be performed by the alliance and the roles of the various members are
illustrated by the following brief discussion of the process as it would occur in addressing
major aspects of job development.
The need for a job development effort, described above, includes a requirement for
identifying and defining job opportunities that can be filled by the handicapped, and the
skills and training required. To satisfy that need, a working group would seek to define
occupations in demand that are suitable for the severely handicapped; the job requirements
in terms of tasks, training needed, physical and intellectual requirements; and, if possible
and desirable, categories of disability that are not handicapping for given occupations. Each
member would contribute to such an effort based on his specific capabilities and strengths.
Members from industry would be responsible for defining the demand for specific
occupations in their community and defining job requirements. Members from the
rehabilitation and handicapped communities would assess the applicability of the various
occupations, the availability of qualified clients and support needs. The availability of the
necessary training, or the effort required for its development, would be addressed by
members from the educational community. The functioning of the working groups would
be similar for other issues including those not necessarily related directly to employment
such as architectural barriers, transportation, housing, and education. Representation from
State of the Art / Randles / 6
agencies and organizations in addition to those mentioned should, of course, be sought as
appropriate to the need.
Forming the Alliance
How would the alliance between rehabilitation and industry be formed to address needs
such as those described? Although a specific detailed method has not been developed, there
are a number of possible actions that might bring about the desired liaison. First, a national
meeting of top executives from a number of leading industrial firms and leading members of
the rehabilitation community, perhaps the Council of State Administrators of Vocational
Rehabilitation, could be held to explore ways in which the liaison could be established, and
to achieve the necessary support and pledges of participation.
A next logical step, and one to be discussed at the first meeting(s), would be a workshop
attended by appropriate designates of industry and the state and federal rehabilitation
community. Subgroups could address major subjects (e.g., Training, Job Development) of
the program with a responsibility for developing a plan, position, and objective by the end
of the workshop. Each group would address the broad factors, such as objectives and
constraints, of its specific subject and the basic questions of how, when, where and who.
The establishment of organizational measures necessary to create a continuing relationship
and to create and conduct projects specific to the local environment and need would be a
major objective of initial meetings.
The projects conducted to date provide a basis for optimism about the chances of
successfully forming such a liaison. In particular, the Bay Area project has demonstrated
that a partnership can be formed by industry, rehabilitation and the handicapped at the
local level that is extremely effective in dealing with obstacles to the common objective.
Furthermore, studies in other geographic locations regarding their ability to support similar
projects revealed that a majority of the business firms contacted were receptive to
participating in such projects. The experience in Virginia, Chicago, and Oakland/San
Francisco indicates that receptivity to the concept may extend to active participation when
the concept is implemented. It now remains to exploit the interest of rehabilitation agencies
and industry in such projects in the interest of an improved quality of life for the
handicapped.
Richard J. Randles
Federal Systems Division
IBM Corporation
Gaithersburg, Maryland
INDEPENDENT LIVING AND THE STATE AGENCY FOR THE BLIND
Joseph Kohn
Organizational systems lend themselves readily to being perfected and made more efficient
as a process of growth. Feedback from staff, community, leadership and new legislation all
provide cues to needed change. Unfortunately, there are no equally responsive signs or
signals that the organization is out of touch with its purpose. As a result some organizations
continue to do well that which they have done for many years without regard to continuing
necessity, appropriateness, or the needs of those unserved and waiting "in the wings." An
evaluation system, therefore, becomes a necessity.
At the turn of the century, state agencies for the blind were legislated into existence to serve
the blind and ameliorate their condition. Intially, this took the form of friendly visitation,
later to grow into home teaching, handwork training, and recreation. As federal legislation
expanded, service programs and agencies became participants in the federal grant-in-aid
process for developing vocational rehabilitation opportunities for the blind. This federal
infusion of funds into the states obviously stimulated vocational rehabilitation programs so
that they became more and more potent and in time the dominant services provided by the
state agency for the blind. Yet, at its most optimistic only 30 percent to 35 percent of the
blind can be considered employable. Another 10 percent to 15 percent are children which
leaves at least another 50 percent who are elderly and whose needs differ greatly from the
children and the employable group. While in recent years a number of writers have called
attention to the paucity of services to the elderly, very little exact study and definition of
needs for this group has been made. In New Jersey, a study¹ of 800 older blind people
indicated that older blind people have four major areas of need.
1. Isolation-about 25 percent of the group live alone and frequently even those in
family or congregate living are actually cut off from many personal and social
contacts by the social attitudes around them.
2. Lack of Information-information systems and counseling, "a person to turn to,"
are considered an essential need because of the high degree of detachment from
family and community prevailing among this elderly population.
3. Increased Medical Needs-the incidence of one or more chronic health problems is
very evident.
Among this population the following was identified:
20 percent have Diabetes.
20 percent have heart conditions.
23 percent need dental care.
26 percent have abnormal blood pressure.
34 percent have foot problems.
34 percent have hearing problems.
1
State of the Art / Kohn / 2
Happily, 80 percent of the group reported that they are under the care of a
physician. However, one out of five do not have needed transportation, necessary
funds, or someone to care for them at home if ill.
4. Financial Needs-New Jersey is a highly industrialized state and it is, therefore, not
surprising that nearly four out of five individuals sampled have some kind of Social
Security coverage. 22 percent receive Public Welfare and 5 percent employment
income. However, 25 percent of the group feel their income is inadequate to meet
basic living needs. A considerable number, 30 percent, do not know how to get
information about income-maintenance programs and have not checked potential
sources.
Twenty-five percent said that even if they did need financial help they would not be
willing to apply for public welfare because this is considered a stigma and charity.
Some are willing to endure severe hardship in order to shield legally responsible
relatives against routine investigation. Pride prompts others to forgo public assis-
tance in order to cling to an insurance policy which will assure a "decent burial.'
Some feel strongly that being blind should not be equated or associated with
welfare.
Obviously not everyone who is blind should be automatically considered a candidate for
service by a social agency. Like any other citizen group they need to have the right of choice
and particularly at critical times. But if services are not available, can there be any choice?
This brings us then to the thesis that:
I. State agencies for the blind need to be comprehensive agencies serving all blind
people-not merely those designated as employable and in a manner consistent with
current needs.
The government needs to expand its concept of vocational rehabilitation to just
rehabilitation so that every blind citizen who can profit from retraining and life
adjustment services is given the opportunity. We see no problem in having a separate
title under the present rehabilitation act to make this a reality. If a fixed sum were
appropriated by the Congress for this purpose the grant-in-aid system would soon
stimulate study and improvements in every state to meet such a new charge without
interfering with the present vocationally oriented system. We do not consider one
the adversary of the other. Both are essential. Ten million dollars appropriated the
first year and building up to 30 million dollars in later years would adequately
provide for this program nationally.
What are some of the issues confronting this need?
1) Comprehensive Services and the Private Agency.
The objective of having state agencies provide comprehensive services does not
contemplate reinventing the wheel. The state agency must have a basic and residual
interest in state-wide needs. Where services do not exist, the state agency must
develop them. Where there are satisfactory private agencies, services can be provided
or purchased on a fee for service basis. But most important the needs of all segments
of the blind population need to be considered in this process.
State of the Art / Kohn / 3
2) General Services VS. Specialized.
It would seem rather obvious that a social security system of payments at age 62 or
65 to retired workers would work equally well for the blind individual as it does for
the general population. The same is true for Medicare or Medicaid or general hospital
services. A blind person's appendix when removed is not likely to be different from
anyone else's.
On the other hand sending a blind person to a rehabilitation center serving other
physically handicapped groups can be a disaster unless specialized personnel
knowledgeable in serving blind people are available. The purpose of the specialized
rehabilitation center or training center for the blind should be to give blind clients
those personal and social tools they require to move freely within their capacities in
their environment.
All of this assumes adequate planning on a state-wide basis, clarity in objectives and
goals and adequate evaluation of results.
3) The Changing Character of the Blind Population and the Social System.
Social time lags are well-known. Perhaps the most conspicuous in work for the blind
and in the social attitudes toward blindness of the general public in this country is
the assumption that every blind person should be taught the accoutrements and
symbols of blindness, as for example braille-this despite the fact that only about 25
percent of the blind children attending public schools or residential schools in this
country are braille readers or need to be. Blind children and adults are rightly being
taught to read print whenever possible. Low vision aids and ordinary refractions are
making this possible because more and more of the blind population have residual
vision undoubtedly due to better ophthalmological care, medical advances and
effective control of a variety of inflammatory and acute eye conditions.
More and more agencies for the blind need to be involved with health problems of
the blind population since it is clear that at least 50 percent of the blind are likely to
have other serious or multiple handicaps. This has important overtones for program
planning, service delivery systems, and is relevant to the thrust of the congressional
mandate in the Rehabilitation Act of 1973 to concentrate on the service needs of
the severely disabled.
It means, also, that new techniques for employment placement need to be
considered since many will not be able to be placed competitively because of the
severity of their handicap. In a country as committed as we are to transfers of
income through such devices as Social Security, SSI, Unemployment Compensation,
Medicare, Medicaid, and possible negative income tax laws in the future, it would
appear to be "small potatoes" indeed to provide subsidies for employing multi-
handicapped blind people as inducement to employers and to clients under
controlled conditions. A system that provides millions of dollars to disadvantaged
countries can surely find and support a nominal cost of this kind for its own
disadvantaged. I would estimate this cost at less than 10 million dollars a year
nationally. Yet it would be a remarkable investment in reducing dependency costs
and an essential ingredient in giving multiply-handicapped blind people equal
employment opportunities.
State of the Art / Kohn / 4
In addition to the personal adjustment skills, the handwork, communications and
aids to daily living, agencies for the blind need to concentrate on the personal and
social problems confronting blind people in our society today. They need to see to it
that wherever possible blind people are not isolated and detached; that adequate
needed information is reaching them; that the community organizations are
including them in activities; that social attitudes which "stigmatize" blindness are
brought out in the open and corrected and that staff are assigned specifically to
work with these needs so that they are not ignored or forgotten.
So far we have spoken about independent living for those blind people who live in
their own home, with family or by themselves. The thrust of independent living
services should be made in this setting, in the home of the client and as early as
possible in order to re-enforce the ability of blind people to be a part of their home
and community. Organizations of the blind have properly indicated how badly
advocacy programs are needed to overcome stereotypes and prejudices against blind
people. And we all know of individual situations in which blind people are refused
certain types of careers or plane rides, or housing, etc.
However, numbers of blind people are living in congregate centers, state and private
institutions, nursing. homes and the like. This raises a second thesis which we
support, namely, that:
II. Blind people should have the right to live in accommodations of their selection. For
many individuals this is fine but there are a number of issues.
1) What if they cannot make selections?
People, including blind people, may be so ill as to be unable to do things for
themselves. Blindness deprives some who live alone of the ability to look for a new
apartment. What of individuals who are psychologically dependent and have no
family? What of the many deaf-blind Rubella adults?
2) What of those who do require Institutions?
Irving R. Dickman, Author of Public Affairs Pamphlet #522-"Independent Living:
New Goal for Disabled Persons," writes, "Institutions were not originally established
for the sake of their residents. The first asylums were created in the Middle Ages to
house blind beggars, not so much to provide care for them, historians now agree, as
to remove them from the sight of society.
"Institutional segregation of the handicapped took hold in the United States
between 1870 and 1880, supposedly because the blind (or the retarded, or the
severely disabled) are happiest with their own kind. If this was ever true most
handicapped people no longer feel that way. On the contrary, many feel that if their
differentness leads to their segregation, then their segregation increases their
differentness."
Pick up a newspaper in any state having an article on the status of state mental
institutions, and one is soon impressed by overwhelming conclusions that many
institutions continue their original purpose of segregating unfortunate individuals
away from the view of society. It is fortunate that there is a ground swell of public
feeling to make institutions into treatment centers rather than warehouses for
humans, or to close them.
State of the Art / Kohn / 5
3) What of the severity of the handicap?
Obviously there is a tremendous variation in severity among blind or handicapped
individuals. The bedridden, the quadriplegic, the deaf-blind, the individual out of
touch with reality are at a further point on the scale of disability than the
ambulatory, active, blind youth. No one system can speak for all. Parents by
over-indulgence may condition their blind children to dependency, frequently taking
the attitude that their child will never go into an institution "as long as I live" but
also seeking agency help to provide a protective, safe environment for their adult
children after they die. Mr. Irving Dickman calls this "conditioned helplessness."
To quote him again: "Not all handicapped people, perhaps not even the majority,
can or will ever want to live independently. But a growing number of severely-
disabled young adults and teenagers are hoping, asking, planning to live not in
institutions, not in homes of their parents but like other young people-in homes of
their own. And new methods of government funding, new concepts of supportive or
standby services by community and voluntary agencies, and new social attitudes,
which accept the right of each individual to choose his own life style are stimulating
increasing numbers of disabled people to ask, 'Why not me too?' "
It seems to this writer that the majority of the blind wish to live independently.
They may need access to state and local agencies that can be supportive and provide
standby services when needed without interfering with the individual's right of
selection.
Alternatives to custodial care or independent living have taken a number of
interesting paths. State institutions are being decentralized; group homes and
halfway houses are in use; there are private apartments with two or more
handicapped persons living in them. Small group living units are being tried. And of
course there are senior citizen housing projects, the nursing homes and congregate
homes for the aged. No perfect answer is at hand. Most people lose sight of the fact
that older people are no more static than younger people. Somehow once past a
certain age we tend to write off the individual and assume no growth or change.
Actually older blind people, like their sighted friends, do change. Social and health
hazards can become greater or less and changes in living arrangements may become
necessary.
Much supportive work by agencies and families can be organized to keep older
people, including older blind people, away from institutional settings. But ways
must be found for compensating for lost ability to participate in community and
social activities. Most of all the blind person should have the right of choice and the
chance to succeed or fail at being independent.
Joseph Kohn
Executive Director
New Jersey State Commission f/t Blind
and Visually Impaired
1100 Raymond Boulevard
Newark, New Jersey 07102
1. "Blindness and the Vintage Years," New Jersey Commission f/t Blind and Visually Impaired, 1972.
THE DISABLED STUDENTS IN THE COLLEGE AND UNIVERSITY SETTING
Kent Kloepping, Ed.D.
The intent of this paper is threefold: first, to describe current issues in the education of the
physically disabled; second, to outline a model support-service program in a post-secondary
educational institution; and third, to attempt to identify some key issues which will need to
be addressed in the continuing development of the disabled student program.
A kind of revolution has suddenly and swiftly swept through college and university systems
across this country. Those who have spearheaded this sometimes spectacular movement have
opened the way, in many cases, to much greater social change in the larger social systems.
The development of disabled students programs is a movement in which disabled people
themselves have experienced the need, attacked the problem, and led the fight in
establishing equal educational rights and opportunities for the disabled individual. This
element of self-leadership distinguishes the new programs at post-secondary level from those
in primary and secondary schools, and from most services for the disabled.
At the elementary and secondary levels, significant change is also occurring, however,
perhaps partly as a result of the post-secondary movement. The tradition of "Special
Education" has come increasingly under fire. In a recent article of ICD News, Dr. Salvatore
G. DiMichael succinctly described the historical dilemma of segregated classes for the
handicapped. He notes:
First, society has regarded the handicapped as different from non-handicapped people
in a way that perpetuated a sense of inferiority in them; at the same time, we said, and
many studies showed that the achievements of the handicapped in school and later in
adult life are not inferior.
Second, we built many specialized schools and facilities and organized classrooms that
are essentially segregated; at the same time we said that the handicapped students had
to learn to cope with the everyday problems of the "normal" world. This cultivated a
sense of exclusivism justified in idealistic terms, i.e., that we were doing good for
misfortunate people, and that we worked with the handicapped, understood them
while other people did not.
Third, we acted to unduly shield them from the problems of living while we said that
the last thing we would do is to overprotect them.
"Special Education" for the handicapped has flourished at the elementary and secondary
levels. But, fortunately, few, if any, public institutions at the post-secondary level have
provided this type of separate educational programming. The disabled individual was
fortunate to have a "non-system" at the post-secondary level rather than to have a separate
1
State of the Art / Kloepping / 2
"special" system since, once entrenched, such a system might have taken years to uproot.
Now that services are coming into existence at the higher education level, there is the
opportunity to avoid mistakes exhibited in the past by many of the "Special Education"
programs.
The Right to Education
A simplistic sounding statement is that all people should have an equal opportunity for
education. The recent past, however, demonstrates that equal opportunity for education has
not existed for the physically disabled individual at the post-secondary level. Not until the
past five or six years has there been any significant recognition of the need for, and
subsequent growth in, post-secondary educational institutions serving the physically dis-
abled individual.
A major cause of this change is that courts have recently handed down decisions establishing
the right to education for the physically disabled. The "Philadelphia Case" (1971), holding
that education of the handicapped child is not an act of philanthropy, but a constitutional
right; and the "Washington, D.C. Case" (1972), holding that absence of money is not a valid
excuse for failure to guarantee rights to disabled people, including the right to education,
were key points in the movement to provide equal educational opportunities for the
disabled person.
Deterrents to Higher Education
Today, however, there still exist substantial barriers for the physically disabled individual in
attempting to enter an institution of higher education. In a recent unpublished paper, Dr.
Ray Jones, Director of the Center on Deafness, California State University, Northridge,
California, wrote the following:
Dr. Ray Barsch, a nationally recognized authority in the field of special education, has
identified the following as major barriers which tend to limit the number of
handicapped students entering higher education.
(1) Attitudinal barriers of paternalism and low expectations.
(2) Financial barriers-These are often erected by "professionals" who think that
education of handicapped students can only be successful when carried out in a
special school with unlimited funding and full complement of highly specialized
personnel. Too often they discourage efforts to serve handicapped students in
regular education settings.
(3) Architectural barriers-These are very real and exist on almost every campus in
America today. The situation is improving as new architectural standards now
require that all public buildings be accessible to the physically disabled
individual. However, it will be many years before all college and university
buildings will be fully accessible to handicapped students.
A fourth barrier of "being educationally disadvantaged" has been identified by Leonard
Eato, Poster Boy for Cerebral Palsy in 1950 who made the following statement:
State of the Art / Kloepping / 3
It is obvious that in giving the handicapped student separate and unequal treatment,
society is saddling him with an educational disability to add to his physical one-much
of the argument which led to the outlawing of racial segregation in the school could be
applied in the case of the handicapped.
In addition to the four barriers listed above, another equally significant barrier bars access,
or predetermines failure, for the physically handicapped in higher education.
(5) Lack of services and resources: The 1973 Vocational Rehabilitation Act mandates
an emphasis on services for the severely handicapped. Many people assume that, as a
result, there has been a dramatic increase in services to the severely physically
handicapped, including programs of post-secondary education. That, unfortunately,
is not the case. Nationwide vocational rehabilitation funding was not increased for
fiscal year 1974/75 over fiscal year 1973/74. The net effect has been a reduction in
client services due to spiraling costs. To illustrate, in Arizona, from fiscal year
1972/73 to 1973/74 to 1974/75, the average cost per client served has jumped from
$1,400 to $1,800 to $2,100. The program is severely pressed to meet basic training,
educational and other support services required for its present clientele. To expect
the agency to fully fund all programs of post-secondary education for the severely
physically handicapped is unrealistic.
In addition, there are a number of very specific problems related to the dependence of the
student on Vocational Rehabilitation agency support. Dr. Jones identifies a number of these
barriers:
(1) The requirement that handicapped students must have an assurance of being
employed in their chosen field before a program of studies will be authorized.
(2) Requiring that the client must carry a full academic load each semester and
complete his training in four years.
(3) Requiring handicapped students to obtain counselor approval before dropping
courses or changing their academic objectives.
(4) Withdrawal of agency support if passing grades are not maintained.
(5) Requiring grade and attendance reports from clients.
(6) Denying clients the opportunity of attending summer school or extension classes by
withholding agency support.
(7) Agency regulations which discourage students from accepting summer employment,
work-study experience, or taking off a semester or two to get meaningful work
experience.
The Costs of Education and Funding Sources
Since the education of handicapped clients at the university level may extend over four to
six years, the total costs for all clients who could profit from higher education far exceed
the funds available to the Department of Rehabilitation. The inevitable result is rationing of
resources by accepting only the most promising clients (approximately one out of ten) to
receive college support.
State of the Art / Kloepping / 4
At the post-secondary level, the responsibility for meeting the excess costs of education for
the severely disabled has too often been left to the vocational rehabilitation system. Jones
(1974) advocates that colleges and universities be reimbursed for the excess costs of
educationally-related or life-support services required by disabled students. If the states are
unwilling to assume this role, then programs such as the Special Student Services Program,
funded by the U.S. Office of Education, should continue to play a major role in funding
programs which provide the "excess cost" services. State welfare programs and federally
supported programs such as S.S.I. and vocational rehabilitation could then provide the basic
maintenance support.
Staffing of Disabled Students Programs
A disturbing trend has begun to emerge in colleges and universities across the U.S. within
the past two to three years: the establishment of a single counselor or coordinator
designated to provide services to all handicapped students on a campus. Such a "program"
and, hence, services to the student, are predestined to failure. Evidently, it is assumed that a
single individual can develop and provide a comprehensive program of quality services to
meet student needs. This is doubtful even under the best of circumstances, and too often
the position carries no administrative clout and is low paying, and hence attracts unqualified
or minimally qualified persons.
One can advance the argument that a program staff of one is better than none, and this is
often said honestly, albeit naively. That point of view can be labelled "tokenism." A single
counselor or coordinator of "handicapped services" will often be part of the traditional
student services office. Many of the more successful programs that serve physically disabled
students have been administered independently apart from the often tradition-bound
"office of student affairs." In addition, many of the most effective program leaders are
themselves disabled.
To sum up, in order to be effective, disabled students programs should (a) have adequate
staffs and resources; (b) be independent agencies within the campus bureaucracy; and (c) be
directed by people who themselves are closely familiar with the experience of being
disabled.
Level of Education
The need for all severely physically handicapped people who are able to attain post-
secondary education, including masters and doctoral level training is critical. The lifelong
excessive costs of survival mean that incomes must be at a high level for the individual to be
capable of self-support. If every non-handicapped member of our society were suddenly
confronted with costs of $3,000 to $6,000 per year (which represents the cost of survival
before the basics of food, clothing, and shelter) a greater awareness of the plight of the
severely handicapped would probably result. Higher education for the severely handicapped
is an avenue of escape from a life-long sentence to mere existence on welfare rolls or
dependency on the "charitable" whims of the more affluent society.
State of the Art / Kloepping / 5
Education for What Purpose?
An extremely sensitive current issue concerns the reasons why a disabled individual attends
an institution of higher learning. The sponsoring agency almost inevitably will hang the
specific vocational objective as a guillotine over the head of its client. Without the pursuit of
"substantial gainful employment," support is not forthcoming. Probably the majority of all
first year non-disabled students in post-secondary education programs have no set vocational
objective. In order to provide truly equal opportunity to education, the disabled individual
should also be able to enter the system with the sole objective of "higher learning" if he or
she so chooses. Nondependence on the vocational rehabilitation system (in its present form)
is a major first step for that individual who chooses not to be vocationally directed.
A Model Service Program in a Post-Secondary Setting
The following conceptual program model was developed as the primary objective of a U.S.
Office of Education, Region IX Task Force. A number of institutions in Region IX have
programs approximating this model, or have a significant number of its components
operative in their programs. A number of antecedent conditions are assumed for the
effective implementation and administration of a program based on the model:
(1) Support from the top administrative officials of the University is required.
(2) Involvement through all levels of the University administration is essential to
develop services and to effect positive change.
(3) A basic attitudinal approach and objective of the institution should be to provide
basic educational opportunities to handicapped students.
(4) services. A sufficient number of trained staff are required to insure a program of quality
(5) The program director must be in a position to work within the University structure
at all administrative levels to effectively develop and direct program activities.
The model program description is divided into two sections: (1) Program Objectives, and
(2) Evaluation Criteria.
(1) Program Objectives-Objectives of a model program involve providing supportive
services to disabled students from pre-admission to post-graduation, both within and
beyond the walls of the institution, ranging in kind from the provision of materials
to counseling and financial support. Specifically, some key objectives are:
To provide special orientation and assistance in registration.
To provide classroom assistants such as notetakers, readers, interpreters;
To provide adequate medical care and facilities;
To make available accessible housing, parking, and transportation, both on and
off the campus;
To eliminate architectural barriers;
To provide and coordinate general and special financial assistance;
State of the Art / Kloepping / 6
To make available regular and emergency attendant care;
To provide adaptive physical education;
To establish a mobility center for maintenance of equipment and emergency
service;
To purchase special equipment needed by particular disability groups (e.g.,
swimming pool lifts, rapid braille reproduction system);
To schedule leisure time events and resources;
To provide a resource center and services such as mobility training for blind
students;
To collect adequate follow-up data on students involved in the program;
To employ disabled peers in the program, providing them with in-service
training;
To affect the attitudinal climate of the institution in a positive direction.
(2) Evaluation Criteria-Basically, the "evaluation criteria," which describe elements of
a quality service, set forth key details to be included in implementing the above
objectives. For example, with respect to the attendant care objective, there should
be a systematic program to recruit attendants, including screening and in-service
training for employer and attendant, as well as knowledge of funding sources and
establishment of an emergency back-up service.
In addition, the evaluation criteria includes certain quantifiable goals, such as
meeting all requests for notetakers and interpreters, students' successful completion
of the semester, and post-graduation employment. Also included is the more
subjective (though not necessarily nonquantifiable) goal, movement from dependent
to independent living status, defined as autonomous management of one's own
affairs.
THE FUTURE
Personal Commitment
A first consideration concerning the future of higher education for the disabled seems to me
to be the kind of personal commitment that those disabled people who are involved must
make to continue the movement for full participation in society for all disabled individuals.
I think we can all agree that the past five years have shown great positive change for the
disabled individual in our society. Many new avenues of participation have been opened, and
many of those involved have had exhilarating personal experiences.
Society will praise those who have participated, especially those who have emerged as
leaders. But, the corollary of "you've made it" can be, "now you are surely satisfied."
Social change is a process, a continuing process. That concept needs to be reiterated as often
as necessary.
State of the Art / Kloepping / 7
Building on Present Programs
The Model Service Program outlined in the previous section must not be viewed as a static
framework, but as a dynamic working outline which will require continuing re-evaluation
and change as new needs become apparent. For example, it should be changed to include an
"outreach" services component for reaching the unknown numbers of physically disabled
individuals who could benefit from post-secondary education but have not become involved.
Outreach services would appear to be particularly critical in reaching the physically
disabled/ethnic minority individual. Those should become a high priority since the problems
experienced by this person have been, and continue to be, overlooked.
The Program Director-An "Educational Statesman"
Strong leadership of disabled students programs is needed in order to establish their
credibility within and beyond the college or university. The power structure will usually
respond positively to a spokesman who represents a program perceived as being worthwhile.
In order to so represent the program, the director must have full knowledge of all of its
aspects. (S)he must also have a good working relationship with program staff and students in
order to adequately represent their needs and in order to make and keep the program a high
quality one, deserving of support.
Program Support
Financial support of education programs for disabled individuals is, of course, a primary
consideration. Groups of disabled consumers and involved professionals need to develop
on-going relationships with state and federal funding agencies and with key congress people
and legislators to insure continuing support of disabled students programs and to provide for
future expansion as court-ordered and legislatively mandated changes in education at the
primary and secondary levels bring about a dramatic increase in the numbers of disabled
students seeking higher education. An effective way to do this at the national level would be
to develop strong ties with national professional organizations, such as the National
Rehabilitation Association.
The Role of Vocational Rehabilitation Agencies
Vocational rehabilitation agencies will continue to play major roles in providing support
services to physically disabled students in the post-secondary setting. A basic principle in
providing these services is that clients should be provided training and services to enable
them to reach the highest level of their potential. However, present priorities and statistics
collecting methods of VR agencies do not encourage such attainment. Indeed, the emphasis
on "successfully closing" cases tends to put a premium on finding the placement which
requires the least effort and expense on the part of the agency. Changing this situation
should be a primary objective of consumers and concerned professionals.
Attitudinal Considerations
The attitudes of individuals and of society toward the physically disabled have played a
prominent role in the existence and life styles of disabled people. Negative attitudes or
attitudinal misconceptions (by the non-disabled) may be the single most devastating factor
for a disabled person. Six years after the establishment of the disabled program at the
University of Arizona, we still hear the familiar phrases, "your programs" and "your
State of the Art / Kloepping / 8
students," as if programs serving physically disabled students were not part of the total
educational institution. It is clear, therefore, that simply establishing a disabled students
program and integrating students at the university level does not bring about basic attitude
change. Because attitudinal change is usually extremely difficult to effect, the issue of
educating or reeducating the public is one of the toughest but most important social issues
for the future.
Potential Effects of Model Post-Secondary Programs
The disabled student programs, in my view, could assume a major role in providing
reeducation for elementary and secondary school systems. Existing program components
will, in many instances, be directly applicable to programming at those levels. Without
meaning to be unkind, I believe special emphasis in reeducating the educator should often
be given to the "Special Educator." The disabled student in the post-secondary setting can
also serve as a role model for the younger disabled child.
References
DiMichael, Salvatore G., Mainstreaming or Bystreaming Handicapped Youth, ICD News, Volume IX,
Number 2, 1974.
Jones, Ray L., The Role of the Public Institution of Higher Education in Providing Continuing Education
for Students Including Those Who Have One or More Handicaps, Unpublished paper, California State
University, Northridge, 1974.
Kloepping, Kent B., The Need for Special Services in Post-Secondary Education Programs for Physically
Handicapped Students. For the U.S. Office of Education National Task Force on the Disadvantaged
and Post-Secondary Education. December, 1974.
Kent Kloepping, Ed.D.
Special Services Office
College of Education
University of Arizona
LEGAL SERVICES BY THE DISABLED FOR THE DISABLED
Debby Kaplan
In most communities a disabled person has very limited access to the legal system. To
illustrate the problem, take the case of Ms. X, a paraplegic who has been the victim of
housing discrimination. She has been looking for a place to live and has found an accessible
apartment, but the landlord wants a damage deposit that is three times as high as the normal
deposit. He freely admits that the extra cost is because Ms. X is in a wheelchair.
In most cases, the disabled person does not know what his or her legal rights are. In this
case, Ms. X feels that this special deposit is unfair, but she does not know if it is illegal or
not. Some disabled people, used to second-class treatment, would simply pay the extra
charge even though they don't like it. Accessible housing is difficult to find, and it can be a
very frightening prospect to try and buck a system that has been imposing oppressive rules
and practices for as long as one can remember. It is always difficult to do things alone, and
to overcome the social conditioning, "you should be happy with what you get; don't cause
trouble," that most disabled people have received.
Ms. X decides to go to a lawyer. What type of lawyer should she go to? Where does she find
one? If she were to call the local Bar Association Referral Service asking for a lawyer who
specializes in disability problems, she would most likely get no help or maybe the name of a
lawyer who specializes in medical malpractice. That's the only type of disability-related
problem the legal profession seems to be aware of. There may be a few lawyers in the
community who are interested in civil rights for the disabled, but it usually is not their
specialty and the Bar most likely doesn't know about it.
Ms. X decides to go to a lawyer who was recommended to her by a friend because he's the
uncle of another friend. If his office is any distance from where Ms. X is staying, she's going
to have trouble getting there unless she has a car. Mass transportation in most cities is
inaccessible to the disabled. She does have a car, however, so she drives to his office. Unless
she has called first and asked whether there are stairs at the office entrance, she may not be
able to get in to see the lawyer. Even if she did call first, the secretary may have told her
that the office does have a level entrance, forgetting the fact that there are two steps to get
to the elevator. Unless a person is aware of architectural barriers and the problems they pose
for disabled people, such details can be easily overlooked.
Assuming this lawyer has an accessible office, Ms. X next has to deal with any discomfort
her presence may cause in the reception room. Her problem would be much worse if she had
1
State of the Art / Kaplan / 2
any type of speech impediment. It's not comfortable to be stared at or treated with
condescending helpfulness. The same problem exists when she goes in to see the lawyer;
unless he's comfortable with a disabled person, his feelings of discomfort will be obvious, no
matter how he tries to hide them, if he does. His own fears of disability or pain may
influence him to the extent that he really pays no attention to Ms. X's legal problem, but
concentrates only on how to get rid of her as fast as he can. If that were to happen, Ms. X
would probably leave with the impression that she has no legal claim and will have to pay
the lawyer for her waste of time.
If the lawyer is able to deal with Ms. X's presence, he may still have absolutely no idea what
legal solutions are available. After listening to her story, he may decide that in his estimation
the landlord is justified in asking for a higher damage deposit, and as far as he knows there's
nothing to be done about it. If he doesn't know whether there's a statute dealing with
housing discrimination against the disabled in rentals, he may not bother to find out. Most
lawyers don't know that in many states such legislation exists.
If this lawyer does know about such a statute, or if he decides to research the problem to
find out, then he has to decide whether Ms. X has a viable cause of action against her
landlord. In California, the statute provides that physically disabled persons "shall be
entitled to full and equal access, as other members of the general public," to housing accom-
modations offered for rent. (Calif. Civil Code $54.1[b]) It doesn't specifically say anything
about damage deposits; therefore it's up to the judge to interpret whether such conduct fits
into the language of the statute. If the attorney isn't willing to gamble that it does, then he
might not want to take the case, or else will charge a large fee whether she wins or not.
If Ms. X were to go to a legal aid office, she would probably encounter the same lack of
comfort and expertise in dealing with the disabled on the part of the staff. In this specific
case, if she wanted to sue the landlord for damages, she would also be turned away, since
legal aid offices are restricted from taking on any cases that could bring in any fees to the
attorneys handling the case.
In order to protect her civil rights in this case, Ms. X has several obstacles to overcome. First
she must know if she has a legal remedy; then she has to find a lawyer with an accessible
office (or who will come to her), who knows how to deal with a disability-related problem.
Another problem she might face is isolation. If she isn't around other disabled people, she
has no way of knowing what problems are common to disabled people in general. She
doesn't have the chance to find out common and simple solutions to what appear like very
complex problems. She also lacks the experience of knowing other disabled people who are
used to handling common problems and can act as positive role models to encourage her to
take action to enforce her rights.
The Disabled People's Legal Resource Center (D.P.L.R.C.) deals with these problems by
providing an intermediary between an individual disabled person and the legal system. It is a
non-profit corporation that has several functions: providing paralegal counseling, training
disabled people as paralegal counselors, educating the disabled in their civil rights and giving
general legal information, educating lawyers in the legal aid social problems of the disabled,
and researching disability law problems.
State of the Art / Kaplan / 3
Going back to the hypothetical case this article began with, Ms. X could come to DPLRC
and find out whether she has a real legal issue. Then, after finding out from a disabled
paralegal counselor what the law says about housing discrimination against the disabled, she
would have her case handed over to a lawyer with expertise in the area and an interest in
working with disability law. The preliminary work of the case would have already been done
for the lawyer (fact-finding and basic research) so he could proceed with the case faster. The
DPLRC staff worker would keep track of the case progress to check on Ms. X's satisfaction
with the results and to learn more about that aspect of the law.
Currently DPLRC is still in its organizational stage and dealing with finding funding sources.
We managed to get some free space at the local law school to temporarily operate, but will
have to vacate it soon. With no funds, space is hard to find. Members have been recruited
from the local disabled community. They include law students, pre-law students, and people
with a general interest in the law. We are attempting to make our services available to the
general Bay Area.
Major policy decisions regarding scope of services include a limitation on client population
to the physically disabled, visually impaired and deaf. This is because we have fears of
spreading ourselves too thin, and the legal needs of the mentally retarded are currently being
addressed by other groups. We also decided to deal only with legal problems that directly
relate to the disability. Other types of problems are referred directly to attorneys or legal
services that deal with that type of problem. An example of this would be referral of a
divorce case where the disability of the person involved is not at issue. Another important
decision is to provide services to people in their homes when necessary. Our projected
budget includes a fairly generous amount for transportation. We feel that one way to give
people the impetus to become more independent is to provide them with a feeling of having
more control over their own lives. Being able to fight back legally or to overcome a problem
that seems very complicated is one way to gain that control; we don't want to limit this to
only those people who can make their way to us.
A case is generally started with an initial interview, in person or on the phone, that is
conducted by a volunteer staff person. Then research is conducted by that person. It may
include phone calls to people involved in the case (landlord, welfare worker), finding
applicable statutes or cases, and talking to attorneys who have indicated a willingness to
provide information and suggestions for further research.
Then the paralegal counselor talks about the case at weekly staff meetings and receives
suggestions from the rest of the staff on where to go next. In many cases, we anticipate that
either giving information or making initial contacts with persons or agencies involved in the
case may bring about satisfactory results. It is not our goal to bring every case to court;
going to court is not usually an expedient solution nor a pleasant experience.
If the case needs a lawyer's further attention, the paralegal will look through DPLRC's list
of resource attorneys for one specializing in an appropriate area of law. Then he/she will
prepare a summary of the facts and research done on the case for the attorney. A
conference with the attorney, the client, and the paralegal worker will follow, with
follow-up by the paralegal as the case progresses.
State of the Art / Kaplan / 4
Training of the staff consists of weekly panels, conferences on specific problems, and
on-the-job training. The weekly panels are presented by lawyers and others who have
appropriate experience on a particular topic of interest to the disabled (i.e., housing or job
discrimination, legal research, constitutional issues). They are open to the community.
Conferences are occasionally held with interested attorneys and community members to
deal with the specific problems of an individual case. The purpose of the conference is to get
all the facts relating to the issue, to educate all present on that area of the law, to locate
areas where research is needed, and to decide what action to take. These are usually
problems that involve many people. Finally, on-the-job training is an efficient way to learn
paralegal skills. Work is supervised by law students and interested attorneys. We try to make
a point of informing clients that we are not lawyers and still learning ourselves.
An organization like DPLRC is an important tool for disabled people to use to gain
independence. It makes it easier for an individual to receive legal information and to get
referral to an attorney who can handle a disability-related legal problem with competence.
This gives the individual more power over his/her life and it can provide more civil rights for
disabled people as a class through successful litigation. Any civil rights movement needs a
legal arm to provide legal solutions to problems that the legislature will not remedy.
DPLRC directly affects independent living because it is run by disabled people and trains
disabled people in a very important skill, paralegal counseling. This training can lead to
future employment and is excellent preparation for law school.
Legal battles also make good headlines. If the public sees disabled people vindicating their
legal rights in court, it will quickly become aware of the specific problems facing the
disabled. This kind of publicity also works to change public stereotypes about the disabled;
it's an aggressive act to take a case to court, and implies a certain degree of control over
one's life. If disabled people are seen as actively looking out for themselves, perhaps some of
the pity people now feel for us will change to genuine respect and admiration.
It is our hope to eventually see a new area of the law develop dealing specifically with the
problems of the disabled. By developing more case law and legal precedents, we can draw
the attention of lawyers and law students to these problems. A major reason that these
people don't now recognize such problems is that they've never been exposed to them,
personally or professionally. If lawyers were familiar with the social and legal problems of
the disabled, there wouldn't be as much of a need for DPLRC. It should also be noted that
there is a great need for attorneys who are disabled. Hopefully DPLRC is helping to meet
this need also.
A NEW KID IN TOWN
Philip H. Hatlen
There is definitely no shortage of public and private agencies serving the blind in the United
States. If a blind person and his family wish to avail themselves of professional services there
are programs specifically designed for blind persons from infancy through old age. At this
time, as the blind person grows older, the intensity of available services decreases. But even
this is being corrected by efforts in recent years to provide more professional services to the
geriatric blind. The blindness system truly is a cradle-to-grave problem.
The availability of these services does not mean that all persons take advantage of them; but
the fact is, they do exist. This complex, sometimes overlapping, bureaucratic array of
services is awesome and impressive, particularly when one considers the fact that the
population of blind persons in this country is a relatively identifiable, finite number of
people, many of whom need no services from professional agencies.
Into this array came the Living Skills Center for the Visually Handicapped (formerly the
Blind Adolescent Life Skills Center), in July 1972. We are just beginning our fourth year of
service and are considered by ourselves and other agencies as The New Kid in Town. Why
does this center exist and what service can it possibly provide that is not a duplication of
existing programs of the long standing and solid professional status? This question can only
be answered by devoting some time to a brief look at the development of educational
services to the blind in past years.
Historical Perspective
There are two primary reasons why the Living Skills Center for the Visually Handicapped
was founded. First, the past and present priorities in educational services preclude emphasis
on the development of basic independent living skills. Second, existing rehabilitation
services for the adult blind have not been able to establish curricula appropriate for a very
heterogeneous population of congenitally visually handicapped children.
Let's examine these two points further. No population of handicapped children has so
significantly affected educational services as that of the generation of retrolental fibropolasis
blinded children. There is much in the literature devoted to the affect of literally thousands
of congenitally blind children coming of school age in the late 1950's and early 1960's.
Concurrently with and partly due to this population, there was a dramatic shift from
residential schools to the local day school programs. This shift is certainly one of the most
significant events in the history of educational services to the blind. Its merits will
undoubtedly be debated for many generations to come. There developed a strong
commitment among professional educators and parents of blind children to the
development of day school programs and the "mainstreaming" of blind children.
1
State of the Art / Hatlen / 2
The emphasis of these day school programs was and continues to be the placement of blind
children in regular classrooms for as much of each school day as possible. Children are
provided specialized instruction from resource or itinerant teachers primarily for those
services which will enhance the child's performance in the regular classroom. If asked to
define their positions most resource and itinerant teachers would state that their primary
purpose is to facilitate the integration of blind children into regular classrooms. This they
accomplish by making certain that the child has the appropriate materials and equipment to
function academically. The special teacher may also take direct responsibility for instruction
in some beginning braille reading skills, typing skills, use of slate and stylus, etc. All other
subject matter is expected to be taught in the regular classroom.
Areas of special need for blind children such as concept development, spatial orientation,
experiential opportunities, motor development, education, education in human sexuality,
development of listening skills, instruction in basic living skills, socialization skills, and
mobility are, for the most part, either assumed to be the responsibility of parents, or, worse
yet, are not recognized as basic developmental needs of blind children.
In the early 1960's a major breakthrough regarding the recognition of special needs of blind
children occurred, largely through the efforts of Georgie Lee Abel, then with the American
Foundation for the Blind. This was in the area of instruction in orientation and mobility.
Gradually professional educators of the blind began to understand that the need for
orientation to one's environment and independent travel skills were critical and required
specialized instruction. For blind children a new profession was born. Orientation and
mobility specialists began to emerge from undergraduate and graduate programs in several
university settings throughout the country. Resource teachers, itinerant teachers, and
teachers in residential schools began to see that there was justification for a child and
adolescent to spend some time during his school day on a skill (orientation and mobility)
which was not required of their sighted classmates. This constituted a significant re-
definition of resource and itinerant programs.
However, other non-academic skills which logic would suggest demand specialized
instruction have yet to gain status in educational programs for visually handicapped
children. Blind youth are graduating from high school, residential, and day-school programs
with few skills in certain areas which are crucial for successful adult living. This fact might
not be critical if adult services for the blind were prepared to deal effectively with the entire
population of visually handicapped young adults.
When retrolental fibroplasia blinded youth began graduating from high school in large
numbers, they soon became a major concern for rehabilitation counselors, social workers,
and others involved in services to the adult blind. These young people were different from
the newly blinded adults who until that time constituted the major caseload of
rehabilitation personnel. For those blinded as adults, it is often possible, after a period of
orientation to blindness, for the individual to return to his/her community, family, and a
vocational similar to that which he/she had prior to losing his/her vision.
It is necessary to consider the problems related to habilitation of congenitally blind youth as
compared to rehabilitation of newly blinded adults as two different and distinct
responsibilities.
State of the Art / Hatlen / 3
It has become apparent to rehabilitation counselors and agencies serving the adult blind that
there are some rather large and serious gaps present in the educational development of many
congenitally blind youth. While they were in school these young people functioned within a
well-established educational and family social structure. As young adults in the community,
the same social structure did not exist, and many blind youth who had benefitted from 12
years of integrated public school education found themselves facing serious difficulties in
assimilation into the community. Further, many were seriously lacking with respect to
development in skills of recreational and social behavior, independent travel, personal
communication, vocational awareness, and many aspects of daily living.
One theory as to why growth and development has not occurred in these areas is that
sighted children and youth learn countless concepts through visual observation which
blinded students do not have the opportunity to visually observe and are not systematically
taught.
The difficulty which rehabilitation services have faced in dealing with this population
appears to be created by two situations. One, the level at which many young blind adults are
functioning necessitates redesigning curricula for much more basic learning. The traditional
curriculum of rehabilitation agencies is often not appropriate. Second, the population of
retrolental fibroplasis blinded persons is a very heterogeneous one, necessitating an
individualized approach which can be flexible enough to meet each person's needs at the
level at which (s)he is functioning. In addition, working with these young people requires an
acceptance of the fact that some may never be entirely independent and may require a
certain degree of attendant care and workshop level employment.
Blind young people whose probable future is a dependent living situation with the
possibility of sheltered workshop employment are no less worthy of or entitled to post
secondary services than the blind young person who is functioning at a higher level and has
the potential ability to be placed in competitive employment. What seemed to be needed a
few years ago and still appears to be needed is a habilitative service for blind young adults
which does not have a set curriculum for all its participants and which can provide services
at a variety of levels, including the more severely impaired young people.
I fear that there is some truth to what some rehabilitation counselors have said to me, that
public school programs are not preparing blind children and youth for adult life. This author
has had many personal experiences with blind young people who have obviously been
passed through school from grade to grade regardless of their academic and developmental
level. If this were not true, why are there blind young people who have had several years of
high school mathematics and cannot make change for a dollar? Why are there many blind
young people who have extremely limited spatial awareness about their immediate
geographic area, yet possess expansive verbal knowledge about world geography?
It is not my intent to be highly critical of either educational or rehabilitative services.
Schools are providing the best educational services which they know how to provide. Also,
there has been continual, sometimes dramatic, improvement in vocational rehabilitation
services for blind and the quality of rehabilitation counselors continues to increase. I am
suggesting that educators of the visually handicapped must take an immediate serious look
at their priorities in education for those children whom they serve.
State of the Art / Hatlen / 4
Just What We Need is Another New Agency
The Living Skills Center for the Visually Handicapped was born out of the frustration of
teachers, rehabilitation counselors, and social workers serving the blind. It came into
existence because too many blind adults were continuing to live at home after high school
graduation with no plans for their adult life with respect to social, recreational, educational,
or vocational objectives and activities. It was born out of the recognition that existing
rehabilitation agencies were doing an outstanding job with newly blinded adults but were
having difficulty adjusting their services to the developmental needs of the congenitally
visually handicapped persons. It was not born to compete with any other existing agency or
replace any existing service. It came intó being as an alternative to existing services,
particularly for congenitally visually handicapped young adults. The Living Skills Center for
the Visually Handicapped has attempted some courageous high-risk approaches to the
habilitation of blind youth.
The Setting
As new schools for the blind and new rehabilitation centers have been constructed over the
past 15-20 years, it has continually amazed me that dormitories remain the accepted living
accommodations for residential students and clients. If housing accommodations are a
necessity, then why not attempt to replicate, as nearly as possible, normal living
accommodations in the community? The Living Skills Center houses its participants in their
own apartments in a large apartment complex. Participants occupy eight two bedroom
apartments which are scattered throughout the 70 apartment complex. Two participants live
in each apartment and have their own private bedrooms, and share bathroom, living room,
and kitchen. They have their own address, their own mailbox, they pay their own rent to
the apartment manager, they arrange for their own utilities and learn apartment living skills
in their own place of residence.
The participants are encouraged to recognize that their apartment is their private living
quarters although teachers do have access for instructional purposes. Only in the case of an
emergency would a staff member enter a participant's apartment without permission. For
many of these blinded young people this is the first opportunity for autonomy and privacy.
The objective in establishing this physical setting is to provide opportunities for learning and
growth in a situation which closely parallels the setting which they may live in at the
conclusion of the program,
The Instructional Program
Occasionally participants receive independent living skills instruction in small groups, but
primarily instruction is on an individual basis, usually within the participant's own
apartment or in the surrounding community. Areas of instructional need are determined by
both teachers and participants, and the curriculum is developed with the active participation
of each blind young person. Sometimes it is necessary for a teacher to help a participant
recognize certain needs of which he is not aware. But usually participants and teachers agree
on instructional goals.
State of the Art / Hatlen / 5
The clusters of areas of learning which are used as a general guideline are basically no
different from what one might find in any rehabilitation agency. There is nothing new in
providing orientation and mobility instruction, communication skills, social skills, and
recreation, or instruction in personal hygiene, financial management, care of clothing,
apartment cleaning, shopping and cooking. It is the manner in which the instruction is
provided which makes the Living Skills Center for the Visually Handicapped somewhat
different from other programs.
Individualized instruction which occurs in the participant's own living quarters, mobility
instruction directly related to the social and recreational needs of participants, active
student participation in the selection and objectives of goals in instruction are some of the
ways in which this Center has departed from traditional approaches to teaching.
The Staff
Working at the Living Skills Center for the Visually Handicapped requires very special
professional people. I have never observed a more intensive, intimate teacher-student
relationship than that which occurs at the Living Skills Center. Because most instruction is
individualized and because of the mutual planning of the curriculum between student and
teacher, there is a shared enthusiasm and motivation for learning that adds another unique
dimension to this program.
Three living skills teachers, two orientation and mobility instructors, two vocational
specialists, three teacher assistants, and a director comprise the team of professionals who,
at any given time, are serving up to 20 blind young adults. All major decisions regarding
admission, curriculum, structure, termination, etc. are democratically made by the entire
staff. Planning daily programs for each participant requires close mutual cooperation and
teamwork. Yet this staff is comprised of a group of individuals who are not hesitant to
disagree with one another and to discuss openly difficult topics which go far beyond the
simple topics of curriculum and instruction.
Living Skills teachers are primarily responsible for teaching participants in a wide, almost
endless variety of areas. Personal hygiene, care of clothing, financial management, dresser
and cupboard organization, counter cleaning, cooking, dishwashing, shopping, and countless
other skills learned by sighted youth through observation are taught by these instructors.
They have arranged their instructional areas of responsibility in a sequential hierarchy so
that no participant is expected to learn tasks that are far beyond his present functional level.
From the moment a participant is admitted, orientation and mobility instructors orient him
to his apartment, the entire complex, hallways, the office, mailbox, etc. Thorough
orientation to the immediate environment is followed by learning survival routes to the
grocery store, the bank, local restaurants, doctor's offices, the local community college, etc.
When mobility routes within the immediate neighborhood are learned well, then mobility
instructors and participants take advantage of recreational and social opportunities
throughout the bay area, using these opportunities to learn more sophisticated and
generalizable orientation and mobility skills.
State of the Art / Hatlen / 6
Our two vocational specialists are new to the staff as of July 1, 1975. One is a former
mobility instructor who is now responsible for coordination with the Contra Costa County
Regional Occupational Program. We are attempting this year to provide vocational training
to a large number of participants through existing programs. Our second vocational
specialist is a new staff member whose primary reponsibility is to explore with participants
current knowledge of the work world and provide opportunities for job exploration through
on-sight observation. We believe that the concept of providing congenitally blind young
adults with opportunities to spend one or more days literally sitting next to someone
performing a job in order to learn what work is like and what that specific job requires is
another unique idea. The fact that blind young people have no opportunities to observe the
work world, hence have extremely limited information regarding choices of vocations, and.
the positive and negative aspects of various jobs, is something that is often overlooked in
their rehabilitation. We hope that we can demonstrate that comprehensive job exposure will
better prepare the blind young person to make his own decisions about vocations.
Teacher assistants perform two extremely important tasks. First, they are on call to
instructors in following-up previously taught lessons and monitoring participants in some
activities under a teacher's direction. Second, they provide coverage when teachers are off
duty. Because the Living Skills Center is a residential program, it is necessary to have 24
hour emergency coverage. Teacher assistants provide coverage for emergencies and in many
cases enhance the program with recreational activities when teachers are not on duty.
These staff members are supervised by a sensitive and talented director who provides an
atmosphere for cohesion and open exchange between teachers and participants.
The Participants
As of September, 1975 the Living Skills Center has served over 50 young people in its three
year history. The length of stay for any participant is determined by need. It is possible for
someone to be admitted and leave within a few months. It is also possible that some may
need to stay for more than a year. There is no minimum or maximum time requirement in
this program. Most participants come from Northern California, with a small number from
the southern part of the state, and currently there are three participants from Illinois.
These young people have ranged in age from 16 to 27 and come from a wide variety of
backgrounds. There has been an approximate equal number of participants from both day
school programs and residential schools. It may be significant to note that very little
difference in independent living ability has been noted between participants who have come
from various educational settings. There seems to be no correlation between entry level
skills and parental involvement in the educational process.
Since the Center has never involved itself in recruitment and accepts applications only from
participants who themselves indicate a need for the program, no one has been admitted who
has not wanted the services provided by the Living Skills Center. This does not mean that
we have experienced uniformly high motivation in all participants. Indeed, some of our
young people, after an initial period of enthusiasm, appear to consider placement at the
Center as primarily filling a need to live somewhere. When this happens, a certain amount of
gentle persuasion usually rekindles some level of motivation and enthusiasm.
State of the Art / Hatlen / 7
When we began, we established as one criterion for admission that the applicant be
functionally blind. The term functional blindness is defined in several ways. Our definition
is that functional blindness implies the need to learn primarily through auditory and tactual
senses. Our rationale for not initially accepting participants who have usable vision was that
they have had opportunities to observe the tasks which we were teaching, hence would not
need individualized instruction in order to learn. This assumption is one of the mistakes we
made as a New Kid in Town. Rehabilitation counselors gently pointed out to us that many
low-vision young adults do indeed need the service which we were providing, and that the
integration of visual and auditory and/or tactual senses can be as difficult as utilization of
only one sensory mode. Therefore, we are now willing to consider any visually handicapped
applicant whose visual loss requires an instructional program.
The population has always been heterogeneous. Some participants need very little other
than encouragement in order to meet their objectives, while others might never attain a level
of understanding and development of skills which would allow them to be entirely
independent. Whether a "graduate" leaves the Center to establish residence in his own
apartment with solid potential for employment or to reside in a board and care home with
the prospect of sheltered workshop employment does not reflect on the success of the
instructional program offered at the Center. If progress is made in the attainment of skills,
the strengthening of self-concept, the development of autonomy, who is to say which
participants we have been most successful with?
The Future
Nothing would please the Living Skills Center staff more than to be needed no longer by the
population it serves. It was thought that by demonstrating the necessity of the skills taught
at the Center, elementary and secondary teachers would be led to revise their programs and
begin to teach visually handicapped children at a very young age some of the specialized
skills they will need as adults. Thus far, this has not happened; what has been learned at the
Living Skills Center is not to any great degree reflected in changes of priorities in school
programs.
It would appear that throughout the country residential schools have responded to the need
to teach these skills much more than day school programs have. The tragedy of this is that
there are many more visually handicapped children and youth in day school programs than
in residential schools. So it would seem that the need for the Living Skills Center may
continue for some time.
Additionally, we have learned that there are certain independent living skills which are
probably best taught and best learned when they are most needed. Certain skills in financial
management, apartment maintenance, cooking, etc. may not be taught effectively while
students are still in elementary and high school. When they are on the brink of living on
their own, blind young people are the most motivated to learn some of the skills required to
live independently.
State of the Art / Hatlen / 8
It is my feeling that, therefore, the Living Skills Center must continue to serve as a model, as
an alternative service delivery system. How long it will continue in operation is difficult to
determine. Funding continues to be on a year-to-year basis. If demonstrating new
approaches to habilitation of blind young adults does not affect present educational and
rehabilitation programs, we may be around long enough to no longer be considered "The
New Kid in Town."
Philip H. Hatlen
Living Skills Center for
the Visually Handicapped
San Pablo
AN ON-SITE TRAINING PROGRAM FOR PROFESSIONALS
WORKING WITH PEOPLE WHO HAVE SEVERE DISABILITIES
Peter Leech, M.S.W.
C.I.L. On-Site Training Program for Professionals
The purpose of this paper is to describe a training program for professionals developed by
the Center for Independent Living. This training program was funded by Federal Training
Grant No. 44-P-45443/9-01. The focus of the training grant was to provide Vocational
Rehabilitation Counselors with the knowledge and skill necessary to work more effectively
with persons with severe physical disabilities.
It is not the purpose of this paper to debate the assumptions, but to describe our
experiences of the training process based on these assumptions.
The assumptions fall loosely into two major categories, the generalized societal attitudes
toward persons with physical disabilities, and the ways the usual form of professional
education deals with the subject of physical disability.
With regard to the general societal attitudes, we all know what they are, and very likely
would refute their validity if they were voiced openly. Unfortunately they most often
operate outside of the individual's awareness and affect the relationship of counselor to
client in a negative way without the counselor (and often both counselor and client).
knowing why. Again, it often happens that the client becomes angry, or resistive to the
counselor's efforts, and the counselor ends up believing s/he has encountered another
"angry disabled person."
Some of these attitudes, and the activities that follow out of them, include the following:
A person with a disability is a totally dependent person. It follows then, that the
counselor may begin to manage the client's life and activities. These can range from
grabbing client's wheelchair and pushing the client into the counselor's office with the
verbal explanation being to "save the client's energy," or to "assist through these narrow
halls or doorways," to deciding what might be best for a specific client and describing
the client as resistant if the client doesn't agree.
People with disabilities are "different" in all ways, therefore: there's something strange
about a person with a disability desiring to be out on the street, do their own shopping,
pursuing friendships and romantic relationships, wanting to drive, wanting to own a
home, etc.
People with disabilities don't want to be reminded of their limitations so a counselor
must not talk about matters that would touch on these matters, such as walking out on
the street, looking at or seeing things such as movies, asking the person to repeat
1
State of the Art / Leech / 2
something the listener couldn't understand, as well as going shopping, pursuing
friendships and romantic relationships, driving, owning a home, etc.
With regard to the deficiencies in professional education, let me say that I don't know of
any professional education that adequately prepares a person to relate to the disabled
experience. This includes education in medicine, nursing, the various therapies, social work
as well as rehabilitation counseling. I believe that one major reason for this is that
professional educators have the same societal base as everyone else, have not become aware
of their attitudes, are not usually themselves physically disabled and therefore transmit the
societal attitudes in the fiber of their educational process. What follows out of this is a focus
on the imaginary barriers to independent functioning, rather than the real barriers, an
emphasis on better physical restoration, classier assistive devices, rather than restructuring
societal attitudes, reducing architectural and transportation barriers, and promoting full
participation in life for persons with disabilities.
CIL's training process involves five major components which combine to provide the set and
the setting within which an attitude changing awareness of the disabled experience can
occur. These include the expectation that each trainee assume a disabled role; consciousness
raising sessions; the experience of living with a person with a disability in the community;
more traditional instruction dealing with various facets of the disabled experience; and the
predominant use of faculty members who are disabled.
We begin by developing the disabled role for each training. I ask that they select out of their
own life experience one of the times when they narrowly missed becoming disabled. I then
ask that each trainee in turn describe what happened and the impact of the experience at
the time. After they all have described an experience, they are asked to assume that the
experience left them disabled, that they couldn't move because they had sustained a lower
extremity paralysis. We talk a little about what this means, including that they'll be
confined to wheelchairs, and then bring out the wheelchairs they'll use for the rest of the
week and instruct them in transfer techniques from the chairs they're sitting in to their
wheelchairs. In other words, we begin immediately to incorporate their "disability" into
their life experience. We spend the next hour or so assisting the trainees in getting
acquainted with the wheelchair, its use, and starting exercises useful in maintaining the role
of disability while also avoiding unnecessary risks to safety and health; we use our
wheelchair repair service to adjust the wheelchairs to fit each trainee as closely as possible;
we instruct in manual wheelchair operation: pushing, turning, transfers to chair, toilet, car
and bed, pushing up ramps and hills, jumping over bumps; we instruct in toilet activities (an
immediate concern) and general bathroom and dressing techniques for the subsequent
mornings; we also instruct the trainees in an exercise program to follow at least every
evening in order to avoid knee flexion contractures (hamstring tightness) and ankle
edema-both of which ensue very quickly when a person begins to use a wheelchair for all
ambulation. Following this period of instruction we all go out to lunch in the community
generally splitting up into pairs. This is the trainee's first excursion into the community in
the disabled role, and always provides more than enough material for our first consciousness
raising session (or reaction time) which is scheduled right after lunch.
State of the Art / Leech / 3
The consciousness raising sessions are scheduled regularly throughout the training week, first
thing in the morning and right after lunch. These sessions are patterned after the
consciousness raising groups provided in the CIL peer counseling program and provide a
specific time and place for the trainees to meet with each other and to share experiences,
solutions to problems, their feeling responses to their experiences and problems so that they
can begin to develop their own understanding of what living with a disability is
like-including the reality obstacles, such as architectural barriers and public attitudes, as
well as the common emotional responses to these.
Toward the end of the first day, the trainees are introduced to their housemates-the people
with disabilities with whom they will live during the rest of their stay in the community.
The housemates are selected on the basis of severity of disability, a willingness to verbalize
their own experiences and responses to being disabled and demonstrate (or tolerate being
observed) as they utilize assistive devices or attendants to manage their physical care, and
pursue their individual lives, socialize, etc. The function of the housemate is not to
"entertain" the trainee except as that flows out of their usual activities; nor is it to "help"
except to give pointers about the accomplishment of activities of daily living. It is to provide
a view into the daily life of a person with a severe disability who is living independently and
effectively in the community.
The more traditional part of the instruction provides lectures and demonstration of assistive
devices and equipment, independent living skills, wheelchair design and repair, modified
transportation, barrier free design, legislative impact, emotional reactions to becoming
disabled, sexuality and disability. This mode is "traditional" in the sense that it utilizes
lectures, audio-visual aids and field trips as do most training programs. It is different in that
the persons being trained are much more receptive to the knowledge because of their "set"
as persons with disabilities eager to learn as much as possible about how to function more
effectively. The setting, too, contributes to the total immersion in the training experience in
that this agency's primary function is to provide services to severely disabled clients and
that over two-thirds of the staff are persons with severe physical disabilities and are the
people who serve as faculty for the training program. Those faculty members who are not
severely disabled, have long experience in working with the disabled community, and are
deeply aware of the disabled experience. The faculty contributes in several ways, each of
which adds to the totality of the experience. One contribution is in the direct presentation
of anecdotes about that person's experience with disability and the personal, familial and
societal attitudes that he or she has encountered. Another contribution comes in the form
of sharing specific knowledge of her or his own type of disability and the techniques used to
maintain independent living. A third contribution develops around the use of the faculty
member as small discussion group leader; the participants receive what may be the first
opportunity of their lives to develop a close, sharing relationship with a person with a severe
physical disability. The dialogue that develops within this format has been described by
previous trainees as invaluable and combined with the assumption of the disabled role and
living with a person with a disability, perhaps the most meaningful part of the training
program. The overall contribution flows out of the realization that these faculty members
and housemates are not particularly exceptional, and that most persons with severe physical
disabilities retain the potential to be dynamic, interesting, attractive, independent
individuals.
State of the Art / Leech / 4
The most important question about any training program is whether or not it has been
effective. I'd like to describe the results of this training program from two perspectives, my
own, and the trainees.
From my own point of view, this approach to training has been the most gratifying in my
experience in that I'm convinced that the trainees have really been able to "get it." No
amount of the "talking at" or "reading about" forms of training can convey the perspective
on disability and real understanding that assuming the role of disability has provided for
these trainees. My expectation was that the experience would be important in conveying
some of the lesser known but invaluable facets of the disabled experience. I had not
previously anticipated the form of some of the results. One severe criticism of the format
was that the assumption of the role of disability would have little value because the trainees
might get "turned off" or would always know that at the end of the week they could get up
and walk away, or see again, if their role was blindness. I, too, had some intellectual
reservations, but decided to trust my intuition that the experience would be valuable and
did not omit or shorten the role-playing experience. A second criticism, less prevalent than
the first was that the counselors might not want to live with a person with a disability-that
they might rather stay with a friend or family-not wanting to spend all their time in the
training experience. I don't like to be in the position of making somebody do something
they don't want to. I therefore decided to leave it up to the counselors to assume
responsibility for opting out of any part of the experience at any time they wanted to,
explaining at the same time that my position was a belief that they'd miss something if they
did. I believe it's a tribute to the counselor's commitment to getting everything out of the
training they could that they very seldom "blew their cover" as we called it.
One result which I observed was that the assumption of the disabled role very closely
paralleled the phases of reaction to a real disabling illness or injury. If each day is compared
to a two-to-three-month period following becoming disabled, we can see the parallel:
The first day after assuming the role was very difficult, they found themselves confined
to wheelchairs, seriously limited in their activity and mobility, running into curbs,
walls, people, each other, being in the way, feeling embarrassed, slow, clumsy, angry at
Peter Leech and the CIL Training Program and ready to quit, give it up, and not sure
they'd make it through the week. They ended the first day with some diversion and
encouragement from their housemates, but mostly exhausted, sore, and for some,
depressed.
The trainees awakened the second day with the same general set, finding it hard to
imagine they'd be able to make it through the week; some hating the sight of the
wheelchair; this was heightened by the slowness of their getting up, bathed, dressed
and ready to go. During the second day they began to be able to manage the
wheelchairs a little and the beginning function here sparked some hope that they'd be
able to last through the week.
The third day, beginning to feel comfortable in the wheelchair in public and really
manage to get around fairly well. Ended the day with heightened hope and enthusiasm.
Looking forward to more activities.
State of the Art / Leech / 5
Fourth day, really have incorporated wheelchair into their image; one describes anxiety
when transferred onto couch and someone took wheelchair away. Feeling real pride in
having managed to learn how to function again and anger when people on the street
come up and take that function away by starting to "help" when they don't need help.
On the fifth day almost all of the trainees expressed disappointment that the
experience was ending, real pride in having managed the experience through some
difficult times. When I began to work them out of the role and encourage their
standing up, most were reluctant, felt strange standing, and chose to continue to sit in
the wheelchair, rather than in "uncomfortable" straight chairs.
Another facet of the "disabled experience" which became apparent to the trainees were
public attitudes of condescension, etc. The trainees were especially able to perceive these for
what they were because they are able-bodied and the only difference between this week and
their regular lives in public is the kind of chair they were using.
One part of our post-course questionnaire asks the trainees to list the degree of usefulness
they experienced for each component with the range of response limited to low/moderate/
high/very high. Rated "very high" consistently were: Assuming the role of disability; Living
with a disabled housemate; Self-care techniques/preventive health care skills; and Outings in
the community. Rated as "very high" by over half of the trainees were: The development of
CIL; Transportation and Mobility; Communication Skills with the speech disabled; Impact
on local government; Client advocacy; Sexuality; and time for reactions to what has been
happening in terms of the trainees' emotional reactions.
The following is a letter by one of our Arizona trainees which was written as a report on the
training and directed to the counselor's supervisors.
Peter Leech, M.S.W.
Director of Counseling
Center for Independent Living
Berkeley, California
THOUGHTS ON MY WEEK AT THE CENTER FOR INDEPENDENT LIVING
Mary Jane Weil - 5/24/75
When I first heard that I might be going to Berkeley, my reaction was "Great, when do I
leave?" I didn't pay too much attention to what I'd have to do in Berkeley when I got there;
I was too caught up in the idea of having an all-expense paid trip to California. No one knew
exactly what would take place during the week, although, from a tentative agenda, it
sounded like they would be "giving" us a disability to live with while we were there. I can
remember even laughing a little when it said that the training was to be a "once in a lifetime
experience." Sure.
Finally the departure day arrived and I found myself actually on a plane headed for
Oakland. The trip was uneventful and I even found Jerry Jerome (the other counselor from
Arizona) with no trouble at all. There was one slight hitch when the bus that was supposed
to take us to our hotel was not running, but we found a taxi and arrived in style at the
Durant Hotel. By this time, when I realized that the training was going to be starting for
real, I was having a few doubts about the whole thing. I even had qualms about the premise
behind the week-that of gaining better insight into what it's like to be disabled by
role-playing a disability. I felt that a week, knowing that I was just acting, wasn't going to
tell me much I didn't know already. I assumed, from the agenda, that our days would be
fairly structured and that even the "evenings on the town" would be well-planned in
advance. I also had some misgivings about my qualifications for being there. Would they
expect me to be one of the two best counselors in the state? I'd been told to be ready to
discuss some of my cases. What would they think if they found out that my caseload
numbered in the 40's instead of being in the hundreds? By early Monday morning, I'd
decided that I didn't belong there and wished I'd said "NO" when the trip was first
suggested.
My first of a long list of surprises came at 8:30 a.m. on Monday. Jerry and I were in the lobby
waiting for Peter Leech to show up to take us to CIL, per our instructions in the letter. I
was well-equipped as a conscientious counselor, with notebook in hand. I was a little
surprised to find that the lobby was relatively empty. Where were all the other counselors
who were going to be involved? We didn't know what Peter Leech would look like, but I
was keeping my eyes open for a "professional" looking man. Finally, Jerry and I went
outside, where a "Non-professional" looking man with a beard waved at us and said, "Hi,
I'm Peter Leech. Are you looking for me?" Instead of the "professional" looking van I
expected, Pete was driving a ratty old Corvair convertible. I had thought he was being rude
in not getting out of the car, but then I noticed the wheelchair in the back seat and realized
that he was disabled himself. I hadn't expected the coordinator of the week to be in a
wheelchair.
1
State of the Art / Weil / 2
I rode over to CIL with Jean. I never learned her exact title, but soon learned that she did
whatever needed to be done. On the way, she told me that she was something of a rarity at
CIL, in that she wasn't disabled. I was surprised to find out that CIL was run by disabled
people to help other disabled people. I think I'd been expecting a residential, occupational
therapy type set-up, and it's not. I'd also expected to be taken to an impersonal conference
room full of other counselors. Another fallacy. We went up to the 4th floor of an old office.
building in downtown Berkeley, to a small room. We started out with introductions. There
were only 4 counselors there, and I soon found out that there were only going to be 4
counselors involved. The other three included Jerry Jerome, from Arizona with a small rural
caseload very similar to mine, Sandy Petta, a counselor from Las Vegas who had a SSDI/SSI
caseload, and Jay Scully, from Reno who also had a SSDI/SSI caseload. We learned that
Peter Leech, who was in a wheelchair as a result of polio, had an MSW and his official title
was "counselor." We also found out that CIL (Center for Independent Living) was a
consumer movement to help disabled people (especially those who had "fallen through the
cracks" of other programs such as VR) learn to live independently. It had begun a few years
ago as an off-shoot of the Physically Disabled Students Program at UC Berkeley.
After an hour or so of getting acquainted, we were given our wheel chairs. I still didn't quite
take the whole thing seriously. My chair needed to have the foot pedals' adjusted so Pete
showed me where wheelchair repair was located. I was taken back when the wheelchair
repairman started asking questions about how I wanted my chair fixed and it became
obvious that he thought I was the real thing. He even picked up my legs like they were
paralyzed. Pete was with me, but he didn't let on that I was really a counselor in disguise. I
couldn't believe that someone thought I was a paraplegic when I felt so normal. It was
scary! Although I was in a chair and for all intents and purposes a paraplegic, my mind was
the same and I felt the same-I began to realize that the people who really had to be in a
wheelchair were mentally O.K., but just had problems with the body. That doesn't sound
profound. It sounds like something the average man on the street would agree with. But,
there is a big difference between knowing it intellectually and knowing it emotionally. On
paper it doesn't sound like an important moment, but it was the first of many insights I got
into the disabled.
Back in the meeting room, I learned that many people even at CIL wouldn't know that we
were phony and that we were supposed to act like the "real thing" and not let on that we
were counselors. It was then almost lunchtime, but before we went to lunch (our first time
in the outside world) we had a lesson in one of the problems of a person in a
wheelchair-bathroom training. Susan (a real paraplegic) took Sandy and I down to the
accessible bathroom on the 2nd floor and for half an hour we tried to learn how to transfer
from our chairs. It's harder than it sounds.
Lunchtime was terrible. I was new to the business of navigating a wheelchair and I had
trouble going through doorways and had to try 3 or 4 times before I could get into the
elevator. Sandy, Susan and I were going to a restaurant about two blocks away, which
sounds like it would be very uneventful. I barely made it. My arms were killing me by the
end of the first block. When we crossed a street, I rolled back into the traffic and a little old
lady had to help me to the other side. The restaurant itself was worse. We went to a
carry-out restaurant (I'll never forget "Top Dog") which was small and crowded. It seemed
State of the Art / Weil / 3
even smaller and more crowded because I took up so much space. I rationalized that I was
probably feeling more conspicuous than I was, until the waitress told me to move because I
was in the way. She even had the cook hurry up my order so I'd get out of there. I was
embarrassed and angry, and was made even angrier by a man in a business suit who wanted
to be helpful and handed me my order, napkins, mustard, and everything else in sight. I
knew he was trying to help, so I gritted my teeth and very sweetly said, "Thank you,"
although inside I felt like telling him that I was perfectly able to do it myself. Now I can
understand why a disabled person doesn't want to have everything done for him.
After lunch, we talked with Don Berry about Client Services and with Jeff Moyer about
Blind Services. Client Services involves:
1. Attendant care: Most of the severely disabled need an attendant at least for a short time
each day, since there are things they can't and will never be able to do. CIL has a roster
of attendants and match clients with attendants. A very important service.
2. Advocacy: Greg Sanders of the CIL staff has spent a lot of time studying the regulations
of the various state, county, and federal programs and is very successful in helping
people get all the benefits they are entitled to.
3. Wheelchair repair: Trying to get a wheelchair repaired can be quite an ordeal for
someone who depends on it, so CIL offers low cost, quick wheelchair repair.
4. Housing assistance: CIL helps people locate accessible housing so that they can live
independently.
5. Transportation: CIL has a modified van which can accommodate wheelchairs and
provide emergency transportation.
6. Counseling: Especially for the newly disabled, but also for anyone else who needs it.
7. Referral to other agencies: If CIL doesn't provide what the client needs, they are
knowledgeable of other sources and are able to refer clients to the appropriate agency.
By this time, it was getting close to the end of the afternoon and the time we were supposed
to meet our roommates. I'd been dreading meeting and living with someone (and a disabled
someone!) who I didn't even know. Pete paired us up and put Jerry with Don Berry (a
quad), Jay with Neil Jacobsen (cerebral palsy), Sandy with Jan (blind) and Charlie
(muscular dystrophy), and me with Kathy Caulfield (quadriplegic). I found out that my
fears about a roommate were groundless. I liked Kathy from the very beginning. She was
about my age and really a lot like me. Someone decided that Kathy and I would go over to
Don and Jerry's apartment for dinner. I was able to get a ride in Charlie's van, which was
equipped with a lift. The evening went well. Kathy did most of the cooking, dinner was
good, everyone was relaxed, and I think that we all enjoyed ourselves. By the end of the
evening I'd stopped thinking of these people in terms of their disabilities and just looked on
them as people. That's another statement that sounds simple; one that wouldn't take a week
at Berkeley to discover, but again, just saying it is different than feeling it. Even though I
was a rehab counselor and therefore an enlightened person, I learned that there had been a
certain amount of feeling sorry for my clients and talking down to them. I'd been focusing
on the disability rather than the ability. After being around Kathy, Don, Pete, and the other
CIL folk, I realized that pity didn't even enter into my feelings toward them, even though,
physically, they are a great deal more severely disabled than the majority of clients I see.
State of the Art / Weil / 4
Kathy had given me some salve on Monday night because she said I might be sore in the
morning. She was right-my arms were killing me. I'd never considered pushing a wheelchair
to be a very physical activity until I had to do it. By Tuesday I also realized that blue jeans
are much more practical for a novice in a chair than double-knits. Tuesday morning we met
Edna Brean, a very articulate nurse. She talked primarily about spinal cord injuries (how
they occur, different levels of injury, and capabilities at the various levels), self-care and
attendants. With Pete, we also talked about the psychological effects of a severe injury on a
person and how to deal with the various stages a patient goes through. On Tuesday
afternoon, we spent part of the time at the computer training project, which is taught by
Scott Leubking and Neil Jacobsen, both severely disabled. Neil, who had the counselor from
Reno staying with him, had cerebral palsy and so had little muscular control. Until I got to
know him better, I could not understand his speech. Neil, however, has a master's degree
from Berkeley and was instrumental in setting up the computer program. Besides just
training the handicapped, they also have established good relations with area employers and
have placement opportunities at many banks and large companies.
The highlight of Wednesday was talking with Greg Sanders, Hale Zukas, and Ed Roberts.
Again, they were all severely disabled, and mentioned that at one time they'd all been rehab
clients who were closed as unfeasible. Greg is "the Advocate." He knows an amazing
amount about SSI and welfare regulations, and all the loopholes that exist. He has also been
one of the forces behind the legislative success that CIL has had. Berkeley is probably one of
the most accessible cities in the country (all the corners are ramped for wheelchairs) and
Hale is one of those responsible. Ed Roberts is the director of CIL and is a charismatic,
articulate spokesman for the disabled. All three of them are highly motivated doers-people
who get what they want.
On Wednesday evening, I went into San Francisco with Don, Jerry, Neil, Jay, and a
"walkie" named Norm who drove the van. We had dinner at a small restaurant within
pushing distance of Fisherman's Wharf. I had expected to cause a little stir, because, after
all, you don't usually see 5 people in wheelchairs going out to dinner, but I hadn't expected
the reaction we got. A middle-aged woman, who obviously had been drinking, came over to
our table and began by saying, "It's so nice that they let you out once in a while to come
into town." She went on to say, "I know just what it's like, because I do volunteer work
with the mentally retarded at the state hospital." She lapsed into babytalk to ask Neil (who
has a master's degree) if he liked his soup and then patted me on the head and asked how
old I was (still in babytalk). She kept up like that for about 15 minutes and then asked
Norm (who could walk) if we'd be allowed to have a bottle of wine. I was told that though
most people do not behave like this when they see a person in a wheelchair, you learn to
expect a certain amount of very strange behavior from the general public. I know one of my
biggest gripes with the public was the patronizing attitude I'd encounter. I didn't like being
treated like a mentally defective child.
All of the people I met at CIL were very open and honest regarding their disabilities. I felt
that there was no question I couldn't ask them. On Thursday, we swayed from our agenda
to talk about sex and the disabled. Quite often, it is assumed that when a person becomes
paraplegic that he also becomes asexual. The CIL people made sure we knew that this wasn't
State of the Art / Weil / 5
the case, although adjustments had to be made in this area as well as in other areas of their
lives. Thursday afternoon we rode BART to San Francisco. This "most accessible
transportation system in the world" is not without problems. Elevators slammed on us, the
ticket machine was too high, the train doors slammed on us, and we blocked the aisles. It is
better than any other public transportation, but it is far from perfect. Thursday night we
had another get-together at Don Berry's (a farewell party?) and again we had a lot of fun. I
know that by Thursday night I was getting used to being in a chair and caught myself
getting panicky if, for example, I'd transferred to a chair and someone would move my
wheelchair. Even when I was alone I seldom felt like cheating. Before coming to CIL, I
hadn't expected it to be such a total, 24-hour a day experience, or that I'd get into my
disabled role so deeply.
Friday was a hectic day because we were so rushed for time. We discussed what had gone
into setting up the wheelchair repair shop, and also discussed what types of wheelchairs are
needed for what people. Cathy Dugan, an occupational therapist, discussed assistive devices
and how to fit wheelchairs, costs, etc. Then Edna Brean spoke again about health care, bed
sores, catheters, and other related subjects. When it was finally time for me to re-enter the
world of walkies, I had mixed feelings. Part of me didn't want to get up, I'd gotten so used
to being in a chair. I think that Pete had to tell me three times to stand up or I'd miss my
plane. When I try to put what I got out of the week at CIL on paper, it loses something. The
important things weren't the factual ones, like hiring an attendant, setting up a wheelchair
repair shop, or getting curb-cuts at all the intersections. The attitudes I came away with
were the part that is going to stay with me. On the plane trip back, I thought about how my
week was going to affect my work as a rehab counselor. I was reminded of the question that
both Jerry and I had asked-"Sure, you people can be successful, but everyone at CIL is
exceptional. What about the illiterate laborer who doesn't want to go to the city?" The
answer we got was that a person doesn't need to be educated, articulate, or academically
minded to make it in the world and function independently. We were amazed to find out
that the CIL people hadn't always been brilliant and exceptional. Many of them had spent
years in institutions, been closed out by rehab as unfeasible, and really felt that they'd never
be able to do anything with their lives. They were lucky, though, and somewhere along the
line got a chance. I hope I come back from Berkeley less likely to set limits for my clients
and, now that I know what a person with a disability can do, more able to motivate them.
Since the disabled person in Parker has few successful role models, I realize more than ever
the importance of a counselor really believing in his clients and providing them with the
right opportunities. Working with the disabled here is frustrating at times, but from now on,
when I'm faced with an impossible client and I'm about to say that there's nothing he'd be
able to do, I hope that I'll remember the people I met at CIL.
My week at the Center for Independent Living was the most valuable and enlightening
training session I've been to and I hope that every person working in rehab gets a chance to
spend some time there. That "once in a life-time experience" phrase that was on my travel
order pretty well describes my week.